summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
-rw-r--r--.gitattributes3
-rw-r--r--13251-0.txt4490
-rw-r--r--LICENSE.txt11
-rw-r--r--README.md2
-rw-r--r--old/13251.txt4879
-rw-r--r--old/13251.zipbin0 -> 94107 bytes
6 files changed, 9385 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/.gitattributes b/.gitattributes
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6833f05
--- /dev/null
+++ b/.gitattributes
@@ -0,0 +1,3 @@
+* text=auto
+*.txt text
+*.md text
diff --git a/13251-0.txt b/13251-0.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..88fad8b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/13251-0.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,4490 @@
+*** START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK 13251 ***
+
+THE CHUMS OF SCRANTON HIGH
+
+On the Cinder Path
+
+
+
+
+BY
+
+
+DONALD FERGUSON
+
+
+
+
+THE WORLD SYNDICATE PUBLISHING CO.
+
+CLEVELAND, O. NEW YORK, N. Y.
+
+
+
+
+Copyright, MCMXIX
+
+by
+
+THE WORLD SYNDICATE PUBLISHING CO.
+
+
+
+
+
+
+Printed in the United States of America
+
+by
+
+THE COMMERCIAL BOOKBINDING CO,
+
+CLEVELAND, O.
+
+
+
+CONTENTS
+
+CHAPTER
+
+ I. THE FIVE NUT FORAGERS
+ II. ON THE OLD QUARRY ROAD
+ III. TALKING OF GHOSTS
+ IV. IN TRAINING FOR THE GREAT TOURNAMENT
+ V. TREACHERY IN THE AIR
+ VI. THE PROWLER
+ VII. CAUGHT IN THE ACT
+ VIII. LEON PROMISES TO REFORM
+ IX. SCRANTON IN GALA ATTIRE
+ X. WHEN MUSCLES COUNTED
+ XI. THE CRISIS IN CLAUDE'S LIFE
+ XII. STARTLING NEWS FROM THE JUGGINS BOY
+ XIII. TO THE RESCUE OF "K. K."
+ XIV. THE SEARCHING PARTY
+ XV. PROWLING AROUND THE QUARRY
+ XVI. A FRIENDLY "GHOST"
+ XVII. SCRANTON'S "OPEN HOUSE" DAY
+ XVIII. THE GREAT MARATHON RACE
+ XIX. ON THE FINAL MILE OF THE COURSE
+ XX. THE BOY WHO WON--CONCLUSION
+
+
+
+
+THE CHUMS OF SCRANTON HIGH
+
+
+CHAPTER I
+
+THE FIVE NUT FORAGERS
+
+The bright October sun was half-way down the western sky one Saturday
+afternoon. Two-thirds of the Fall month had already gone, and the
+air was becoming fairly crisp in the early mornings.
+
+All around the forest trees were painted various shades of bright
+scarlet, burnt umber brown and vivid gold by the practiced fingers of
+that master artist, the Frost-King. Flocks of robins and blackbirds
+were gathering rather late this year, preparatory to taking their
+annual pilgrimage to the warm Southland. They flew overhead at times
+in vast numbers, making a tremendous chatter.
+
+A noisy bunch of crows cawed unceasingly amidst the treetops as a
+large, lumbering old automobile passed along the country road, the
+same filled with lively boys, and also a number of sacks stuffed to
+their utmost capacity with what appeared to be black walnuts,
+shell-bark hickories, butternuts, and even splendid large chestnuts.
+Apparently, the strange and deadly blight that was attacking the
+chestnut groves all through the East had not yet appeared in the
+highly favored region around the town of Scranton, in which place the
+boys in question lived, and attended the famous high school where Dr.
+Carmack, also supervisor of the entire county schools, held forth.
+
+The five tired lads who formed this nutting party we have met before
+in the pages of previous stories in this series; so that to those who
+have been fortunate enough to possess such books they need no lengthy
+introduction.
+
+First, there was Hugh Morgan, looking as genial and determined as
+ever, and just as frequently consulted by his comrades, because his
+opinion always carried considerable weight. Then came his most
+intimate chum, Thad Stevens, who had played the position of backstop
+so successfully during the summer just passed, and helped to win the
+pennant for Scranton against the other two high schools of the
+country, situated in the towns of Allendale and Belleville.
+
+Besides these two, there was included in the party a tall chap who
+seemed to be acting as chauffeur, from which it might be judged that
+he had supplied the means for taking this nutting trip far afield;
+his name was Kenneth Kinkaid, but among his friends he answered to
+the shorter appellation of "K. K." Then came a fourth boy of shorter
+build, and more sturdy physique, Julius Hobson by name; and last, but
+far from least, Horatio Juggins, a rather comical fellow who often
+assumed a dramatic attitude, and quoted excerpts from some school
+declamation, his favorite, of course, being "Horatio at the Bridge."
+
+It was "K. K." who got up the annual foraging expedition on this
+particular year, and promised that they should go in style in the
+antiquated seven-passenger car belonging to his father, who was a
+commercial traveler, which car "K. K." often used, when he could
+raise the cash to provide sufficient gasolene at twenty-five cents
+per gallon. But on this momentous occasion each fellow had chipped
+in his share pro rata; so that the generous provider of the big, open
+car was not compelled to beg or borrow in order to properly equip the
+expedition.
+
+For ten days and more previously some of the boys had industriously
+interviewed the farmers who stood in the market-place during the early
+mornings, selling the products of their acres. Doubtless numerous
+good mothers wondered what caused such an early exodus from warm beds
+those days, since farmers had a habit of getting rid of their produce
+at dawn, and driving off home while most schoolboys were indulging in
+their last nap.
+
+But, by various means, they had learned just where the nuts grew most
+plentifully that season; and quite a list of available places had
+been tabulated: to the Guernsey Woods for blacks; plenty of
+shagbarks, and some shellbarks to be gathered over at the old Morton
+Place, where no one had lived these seven years now; and they said
+the chestnuts away up in that region miles beyond the mill-pond was
+bearing a record crop this season, as if to make amends for lean
+years a-plenty.
+
+Scranton was one of the few places where the boys still yearned after
+a goodly supply of freshly gathered nuts to carry them through a long
+and severe winter. Somehow they vied with one another in the
+gathering of the harvest of the woods, and often these outings
+yielded considerable sport, besides being profitable to the nutters.
+On one momentous occasion the boys had even discovered the hive of a
+colony of wild bees, cut the tree down, fought the enraged denizens
+by means of smoke and fire, and eventually carried home a wonderful
+stock of dearly earned honey that would make the buckwheat cakes
+taste all the sweeter that winter because of the multitude of
+swellings it cost the proud possessors.
+
+Hugh had been coaxed to join the party; not that he did not fully
+enjoy such enterprises, but he had laid out another programme for
+that afternoon. All through the morning these same lads had been
+hard at work on the open field where Scranton played her baseball
+games, and had such other gatherings as high-school fellows are
+addicted. Here a fine new cinder path had been laid around the
+grounds, forming an oval that measured just an eighth of a mile, to a
+fraction.
+
+All through the livelong day on Saturdays, and in the afternoons
+during weekdays, boys in strange-looking running costumes of various
+designs could be seen diligently practicing at all manner of stunts,
+from sprinting, leaping hurdles, engaging in the high jump, with the
+aid of poles; throwing the hammer; and, in fact, every conceivable
+exercise that would be apt to come under the head of a genuine
+athletic tournament.
+
+For, to tell the secret without any evasion, that was just what
+Scranton designed to have inside of another week--a monster affair
+that included entries from all other schools in the county, and which
+already promised to be one of the greatest and most successful meets
+ever held.
+
+Hugh and his chums were every one of them entered for several events;
+indeed, it would have been like looking for a needle in a haystack to
+try and find a single Scranton boy above the age of ten, and sound of
+wind, who had not taken advantage of the generous invitation to place
+his name on the records, and go in for training along a certain line.
+Those who could not sprint, leap the bars, throw hammer or discus, or
+do any other of the ordinary stunts, might, at least, have some
+chance of winning a prize in the climbing of the greased pole, the
+catching of the greased pig, the running of the obstacle race, or
+testing their ability to hop in the three-legged race, where each
+couple of boys would have a right and left leg bound together, and
+then attempt to cross a given line ahead of all like competitors.
+
+So even when they started out after lunch the whole five were a bit
+tired; and a vast store of nuts, like the one they were fetching
+home, cannot be gathered, no matter however plentiful they may be on
+ground and trees, without considerable muscular effort on the part of
+the ambitious collectors.
+
+Consequently, every fellow was feeling pretty stiff and sore about
+the time we overtake them on the way home. Besides, most of them had
+zigzag scratches on face and hands by which to remember the
+wonderfully successful expedition for several days. Then there was
+Julius Hobson with a soiled handkerchief bound around his left thumb,
+which he solicitously examined every little while. He had, somehow,
+managed to catch a frisky little squirrel, which, wishing to take
+home, he had imprisoned in one of his side pockets that had a flap;
+but, desirous of fondling the furry little object, he had
+incautiously inserted his bare hand once too often; for its long
+teeth, so useful for nut-cracking, went almost through his thumb, and
+gave his such an electric shock that in the confusion the frightened
+animal managed to escape once more to its native wilds.
+
+Hugh, as he went along toward home, was really taking mental notes
+concerning the lay of the land, and with an object in view. He was
+entered for the fifteen-mile Marathon race (an unusually long
+distance for boys to run, by the way, and hardly advisable under
+ordinary conditions), and one of the registering places where every
+contestant had to sign his name to a book kept by a judge so as to
+prove that he had actually reached that particular and important
+corner of the rectangular course, had been the quaint little old road
+tavern just half a mile back of them.
+
+"You're wondering just why I'm so curious about the country up here,
+I can see, fellows," Hugh was saying about the time we meet them;
+"and, as we all belong to the same school, and our dearest wish is to
+see Scranton High win the prize that is offered by the committee in
+the Marathon, I don't mind letting you in. I know something about
+this country up here, and have traced on a surveyor's chart the
+ordinary course a fellow would be apt to take in passing from the
+second tally post, that old tavern back of us, along this road to the
+canal, and from there across the old logging road to Hobson's Pond,
+where there's going to be the last registering place before the dash
+for home. Well, I've figured it out that a fellow would save
+considerable ground if he left this same road half a mile below, and
+cut across by way of the Juniper Swamp trail, striking in again along
+about the Halpin Farm."
+
+His remarks created no end of interest, for there were several others
+among the bunch who had also entered for that long-distance race;
+and, naturally, they began to figure on how they might take advantage
+of Hugh's discovery. It was all for the honor and credit of good old
+Scranton High; so that it really mattered little just which fellow
+crossed the line first, so long as he "saved the bacon."
+
+"It sounds pretty fine to me, Hugh," said Julius, "only I don't like
+one thing."
+
+"What's that, Julius?" demanded the Juggins boy.
+
+"By following that Juniper Swamp trail and the old road Hugh
+mentions, we'd have to pass close to that deserted stone quarry; and
+say, the farmers all vow it's sure haunted."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER II
+
+ON THE OLD QUARRY ROAD
+
+When Julius made this assertion, the other fellows looked at each
+other in what might be said to be a queer way. In fact, they had all
+heard certain absurd stories told in connection with the old quarry
+that had not been worked for so many years that the road leading to
+it across country had grown up in grass and weeds. Some adventurous
+boys who went out there once declared it was a most gruesome place,
+with pools of water covered with green scum lying around, and all
+sorts of holes looking like the cave Robinson Crusoe found on his
+island home to be seen where granite building rocks had been
+excavated from the towering cliffs.
+
+It was K. K. who laughed first, actually laughed scornfully, though
+Julius took it all so seriously. Thad Stevens followed with a
+chuckle, after his peculiar fashion.
+
+"You give me a pain, Julius, you certainly do," ventured K. K.
+
+"To think," added Thad, assuming a lofty air of superior knowledge,
+"of a fellow attending Scranton High believing the ridiculous yarns
+these uneducated tillers of the soil and their hired help pass
+around, about there being some sort of a genuine _ghost_ haunting the
+old quarry--why, it's positively silly of you, Julius, and I don't
+mind telling you so to your face."
+
+"Oh, hold on there, fellows!" expostulated the other boy; "I didn't
+say that I really and truly believed any of those awful stories, did
+I? But so many different persons have told me the same thing that,
+somehow, I came to think there _might_ be some fire where there was
+so much smoke. Of course, it can't be a ghost, but, nevertheless,
+there are queer goings-on about that deserted quarry these
+nights--three different people, and one of them a steady-going woman
+in the bargain, assured me they had glimpsed moving lights there, a
+sort of flare that did all sorts of zigzag stunts, like it was
+cutting signals in the air."
+
+"Hugh, do you think that could be what they call wild-fire, or some
+folks give it the name of will-o'-the-wisp, others say
+jack-o'-lantern?" demanded Horatio Juggins, who had been listening
+intently while all this talk was going on.
+
+"I'd hardly like to say," replied Hugh thoughtfully. "As a general
+thing that odd, moving light is seen in low, damp places. Often it
+is noticed in graveyards in the country, and is believed to be
+induced by a condition of the atmosphere, causing something like
+phosphorescence. You know what a firefly or lightning bug is like,
+don't you, Horatio? Yes, and a glow-worm also? Well, they say that
+there are black-looking pools of stagnant water lying around the old
+quarry; and yes, I think the lights seen might come from just such
+conditions."
+
+"That sounds all very well, Hugh," continued Julius, "but what about
+the terrifying cry that sometimes wells up from that same place?"
+
+"A cry, Julius, do you say?" exclaimed Horatio, his eyes growing
+round now with increasing wonder and thrilling interest, "do you
+really and truly mean that, or are you only joshing?"
+
+"Well," the narrator went on to say soberly, "two fellows told me
+they'd heard that same shriek. One was hunting a stray heifer when
+he found himself near the quarry, and then got a shock that sent him
+on the run all the way home, regardless of trees he banged into, for
+it was night-time, with only a quarter-moon up in the western sky.
+The other had laughed at all such silly stories, and to prove his
+bravery concluded to venture out there one night when the moon was as
+round as a cartwheel. He got close to the deserted workings when he
+too had a chill as he heard the most outlandish cry agoing, three
+times repeated, and----well, he grinned when he confessed that it
+took him just about one-fifth the time to get back home that he'd
+spent in the going."
+
+"Whee! perhaps there may be some sort of wild animal in one of the
+caves they tell about up there?" ventured Horatio. "I'm not a
+believer in ghosts, and I don't consider myself a coward, either; but
+all the same it'd have to be something pretty big to induce me to
+walk out there to that same lonely quarry after nightfall. Now laugh
+if you want to, K. K."
+
+"Well," interrupted Hugh, just then, "we're approaching the place
+right now where that old quarry road I spoke of starts in. I'd like
+ever so much to take a look at that same quarry, by daylight, mind
+you. Is there any objection, fellows, to our testing out that road
+right now? It used to be a pretty fair proposition I've been told,
+so far as a road goes, and I think we could navigate the same in this
+car. K. K. how do you stand on that proposition, for one?"
+
+"Count me in on anything that promises an adventure, Hugh," came the
+prompt reply. "There is plenty of gas in the tank, and if we do get
+a puncture on the sharp stones we've got an extra tube along, with
+lots and lots of muscle lying around loose for changing the same.
+That's my answer, Hugh."
+
+"Thad, how about you?" continued the shrewd Hugh, well knowing that
+by making an individual appeal he would be more apt to receive a
+favorable response, because it goes against the average boy's pride
+to be accounted a weakling, or one addicted to believing old wives'
+fairy stories of goblins, and all such trash.
+
+"Oh, count me in, Hugh," responded the other, with an indifference
+that may possibly have been partly assumed; but then Thad Stevens was
+always ready to back his enterprising chum, no matter what the other
+suggested.
+
+"Horatio, it's up to you now!" Hugh went on remorselessly, as K. K.
+stopped the car at a signal from the other, and faint signs of what
+had once been a road were to be distinguished just on the left.
+
+"Majority rules, you know," said the wise Juggins boy, "and already
+three have given their assent; so it's no back-out for little
+Horatio."
+
+"Course I'll agree, Hugh," quickly added Julius, when he saw that the
+other had turned toward him. "I'm just as curious as the next fellow
+to see that old haunted quarry--in the daytime, of course. Besides,
+everybody knows there isn't any such thing as a ghost. All such
+stories, when they're sifted down, turn out to be humbugs. Sometimes
+the moving spectre is a white donkey browsing alongside the road.
+Then again I've heard of how it was a swing that had a white pillow
+left in it by the children, and the night wind caused it to advance
+and retreat in a _terrible_ way. Hugh, let's investigate this silly
+old business while we're on the spot."
+
+And by these wonderfully brave words Julius hoped to dissipate any
+notion concerning his alleged timidity that may have lodged in the
+brains of his chums.
+
+So K. K. started up again, and by another minute the old car had
+passed in among the trees, with the overgrown brush "swiping" against
+the sides every foot of the way. It was necessary that they proceed
+slowly and cautiously, because none of them had ever been over that
+long disused road before, and all sorts of obstacles might confront
+the bold invaders of the wilds.
+
+Hugh was using his eyes to good advantage, and at his advice the
+others did the same. It was a good thing the car was old, and that
+it mattered nothing how those stiff branches scraped against the
+sides during their forward progress. K. K. knew how to manage, all
+right, and, although the trail was quite rough in places where the
+heavy rains had washed the earth away, and left huge stones
+projecting, he was able to navigate around these obstacles
+successfully.
+
+Twice they came to low places where water ran, and there was some
+danger of the heavy car becoming mired. At such times several of the
+boys would jump out, and after investigating the conditions perhaps
+throw a mass of stones and pieces of wood in, to make what Hugh
+called a sort of a "corduroy road" across the swampy section of
+ground.
+
+It was all very interesting in the bargain, and, for the time being,
+the boys even forgot the fact that they were exceedingly tired.
+
+Then they seemed to be gradually ascending a grade, where the road
+turned out to be somewhat better.
+
+"I imagine we're getting close to the quarry now, fellows," Hugh
+informed them; "if what I was told is true. It will lie over here on
+the right; and only for the dense growth of trees with their foliage
+still hanging on, we might see the cliff forming the background of
+the quarry right now."
+
+Julius and Horatio looked around them with increasing interest, and
+perhaps a slight flutter of unusual vigor in the region of their
+hearts. It was about as gloomy a scene as any of them had ever gazed
+upon. Years had elapsed since work in the stone quarry had been
+abandoned, and Nature, as usual, had done her best to hide the cruel
+gashes made in her breast by man; the trees had grown and spread,
+while bushes and weeds extended their sway so as to almost choke
+everything around. The distant cawing of the crows sounded more
+gruesome than ever amidst such surroundings; but there was no sign of
+bird-life to be seen. It was as though the little feathered
+creatures found this region too lonely even for their nest building.
+Not even a red or gray squirrel frisked around a tree, or boldly
+defied the intruders of his wilderness haunt.
+
+"There, I just had a glimpse of the place through an opening!"
+suddenly announced Hugh; "I calculate that we'll soon come in plain
+sight of the whole business, for this road leads straight across the
+dumps, I was told, and then on again in the direction of Hobson's
+Pond."
+
+The sun was passing behind the first cloud of the whole day just
+then. Somehow the added somber conditions had an effect on all the
+boys; for, with the temporary vanishing of the king of day, the
+shadows around them appeared to grow bolder, and issue forth from
+their secret retreats.
+
+"Ugh! this is certainly a fierce place for a fellow to visit, say
+around midnight," K. K. was forced to admit, for he was the essence
+of candor at all times.
+
+"Wild horses couldn't drag me up here at such a time as that," said
+Horatio, as he looked ahead, and shivered, either with the chill of
+the air, or from some other reason, he hardly knew himself.
+
+"Hugh, would you try it if someone dared you to?" demanded Julius
+suddenly, taking the bull by the horns, so to speak.
+
+"I don't think I would, on a dare," replied the other calmly, yet
+deliberately, as he smiled at the speaker; "but if there was any good
+and sufficient reason for my doing the same, I'd agree to come alone,
+and spend a whole night in the deserted quarry. However, I'm not
+particularly _hankering_ after the experience, so please don't try to
+hatch up any wild scheme looking to that end. If you want to come,
+Julius, you're welcome to the job."
+
+Julius shuddered, and looked a bit pale at the very thought.
+
+"Oh! I wasn't even dreaming of it, Hugh," he hastened to declare.
+"I'd much prefer to being asleep in my own comfy bed at home when
+midnight comes around, and the last thing on earth you'd catch me
+doing would be out hunting spooks."
+
+It was just as Julius finished saying this that they received a
+sudden shock. A loud and thrilling sound, not unlike a human shriek,
+came to their ears, filling each and every boy in the car with a
+sense of unmitigated horror. It was so exceedingly dreadful that K.
+K. involuntarily brought the auto to a full stop, and then turned a
+face filled with mingled curiosity and awe upon his comrades.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER III
+
+TALKING OF GHOSTS
+
+"That was no crow cawing, boys, believe me!" ejaculated K. K.
+
+"Crow! Well, I should say not!" added Horatio instantly. "If you
+asked me right to my face I'd mention a donkey braying. Gee! but it
+was fierce!"
+
+"But what would a donkey be doing away up here at the old quarry,
+where there hasn't been a stroke of work done these many years; tell
+me that?" demanded Julius defiantly.
+
+"I don't believe it was a donkey," said Hugh, shaking his head, as
+though he, too, found himself exceedingly puzzled; "but I'm not in a
+position to explain the thing. That was certainly a queer noise, for
+a fact."
+
+"Extraordinary!" assented Thad Stevens.
+
+"Well, I should call it perfectly awful!" Horatio clipped in.
+
+"Horrible would be a better word to describe it," eagerly followed
+Julius, who, it must be confessed, was trembling all over; of course,
+not with fear, or anything like that, but just because of excitement,
+he assured himself.
+
+"And," continued the sensible Hugh, "if that's the sort of noises
+these farmer folks have been hearing right along, I don't wonder some
+of them have been nearly scared out of their wits. It was bad enough
+in broad daylight, with the sun shining; so what must it have seemed
+like in the moonlight, or when it was pitch dark?"
+
+"Wow! excuse me from coming up here after dusk," muttered Julius.
+"I'm no ghost-hunter, let me tell you. I know my weak points, and
+seeing things in the night-time used to be one of the same. They had
+a great time breaking me of it, too. Even now I sometimes dream of
+queer things when I've got the nightmare, after eating too big a
+Thanksgiving dinner; and when I wake up suddenly I'm all in a sweat,
+and a poor old moth fluttering at the window will give me a start,
+thinking it's the tiger getting in my East Indian bungalow."
+
+"Well, what's the program, Hugh?" asked K. K. "Shall I start up
+again, so we can continue our journey along this tough old road; or
+do you want to get out, and take a hunt around the quarry for the
+thing that gave those yawps?"
+
+"Get out?" repeated Julius, in a sudden panic; "not for Joseph.
+Don't count on _me_ for any such silly business. I came up here to get
+walnuts and such; and I'm meaning to stick close to my engagement.
+Side issues can't tempt me to change my mind. Guess I know when I'm
+well off."
+
+"It's been several minutes since we heard that sound," Hugh went on
+to remark; "and, so far, it hasn't been repeated."
+
+"Oh! it came three times, you remember, Hugh," suggested K. K.; "and,
+like in baseball, I reckon it's three times and out. Whatever it was
+let out those screeches it's certainly quieted down. How about going
+on now, Hugh?"
+
+"If I was alone," mused the other, "I really believe I'd be half
+tempted to take a prowl around, and find out if I could what all the
+row meant. I never like to pass anything up, when my curiosity is
+excited."
+
+"Oh, come back again some other time, Hugh, when you're not booked
+for getting home!" sang out Horatio. "If you put it to a vote I
+don't believe anybody in this bunch would seem wild to back you up
+right now. Fact is, I can hear our supper-bell calling me ever so
+loud. Hey! boys, how about that?"
+
+"Let's get a move on!" Julius hastened to reply, so that there could
+be no mistaking his sentiments, at least.
+
+Julius was followed by K. K., although the latter shrugged his
+shoulders as he added:
+
+"Perhaps it looks timid in us doing what we mean to, but really this
+is none of our business, and we might get in some trouble bothering
+around here. I read about a house that was said to be haunted, which
+story a daring reporter said he'd investigate. He spent a night
+there, and actually captured the ghost, who turned out to be just an
+ordinary man, living on a place adjoining the haunted estate. He
+owned up to being the pallid specter that had been giving the house
+such a bad name; and said he wanted to buy the property in for a
+song, as it would find no other purchaser if it had such an evil
+reputation. Now, maybe somebody wants this quarry for thirty cents,
+and this is his way of scaring other would-be purchasers away. We
+don't want to butt in on any such game, you see."
+
+Hugh and the others laughed at such a clever explanation.
+
+"Whatever the truth may be," said Hugh, "I hardly believe it'll turn
+out anything like that, K. K. But you might as well start on. We're
+only losing time here, and it seems as though the _thing_ doesn't
+mean to give as another sample of that swan song."
+
+"For which, thanks!" sighed Julius. "I know music when I hear it,
+and if that's what they call a song of the dying swan excuse me from
+ever listening to another. I can beat that all hollow through a
+megaphone, and then not half try."
+
+So the chauffeur started up, and they were soon moving along the
+rough road that had once, no doubt, been kept in repair, when the
+heavy wagons carried out the building stone quarried from the
+hillside, but which was now in a pretty bad shape.
+
+Two minutes afterwards and the road took them directly alongside the
+quarry dump, where the excavated earth had been thrown. They could
+now see the cliff rising up alongside. It looked strangely bleak,
+for, of all things, there can hardly be a more desolate sight than an
+abandoned stone-quarry, where the weeds and thistles have grown up,
+and puddles of water abound.
+
+Of course, the boys all stared, as they slowly wound along the road
+in full view of the entire panorama that was being unrolled before
+their eyes. They noted how in places there seemed to be deep
+fissures along the abrupt face of the high cliff. These looked like
+caves, and some of them might be of considerable extent, judging from
+their appearance.
+
+"If this great old place chanced to be nearer town," said K. K.,
+managing to get a quick glimpse, although, as a rule, he needed all
+his attention riveted on the rough road he was trying to follow, "I
+reckon some of the fellows would have high times exploring those same
+holes in the hill."
+
+"It's just as well then it's as far distant as happens to be the
+case," Hugh told him; "because the doctors in Scranton would have
+broken arms and legs galore to practice on. That same old quarry
+would make a dangerous playground."
+
+"Oh!"
+
+That was Julius uttering a startled exclamation. He gripped Horatio
+so severely by the arm that he must have pinched the other. At any
+rate, Horatio gave a jump, and turned white; just as though his
+nerves had all been stretched to a high tension, so that anything
+startled him.
+
+"Hey! what did you do that for?" snapped Horatio, drawing away.
+"Think you're a ghost, Julius, and feel like biting, do you? Well,
+try somebody else's arm, if you please."
+
+"But didn't any of the rest of you see it?" gasped the said Julius,
+not deigning to quarrel over such a trivial thing as a pinch.
+
+"See what?" asked Steve, still staring hard at the quarry, which they
+were by now fairly well past.
+
+"Well, I don't know exactly what it was," frankly admitted the
+disturber of the peace. "But it moved, and beckoned to us to come on
+over. You needn't laugh, Steve Mullane, I tell you I saw it plainly
+right over yonder where that big clump of Canada thistles is growing.
+Course I'm not pretending to say it was a man, or yet a wolf, but it
+was something, and it sure did move!"
+
+Hugh was looking with more or less interest. He knew how things
+appear to an excited imagination, and that those who believe in
+uncanny objects seldom have any trouble about conjuring up specters
+to satisfy their own minds.
+
+So all of them, save, perhaps, the driver, kept their eyes focussed
+on the spot mentioned by Julius until the first clump of trees shut
+out their view of the old stone quarry and its gruesome surroundings.
+
+"I looked as hard as I could," said Horatio, "but never a thing did I
+see move. Guess you've got a return of your old malady, Julius, and
+you were seeing things by daylight, just as you say you used to in
+the dark."
+
+"The only explanation I can give," spoke up Hugh, and, of course,
+every one lent a willing ear, because, as a rule, his opinions
+carried much weight with his chums; "is that while Julius may have
+seen something move, it was only a long, feathery plume of grass,
+nodding and bowing in the wind. I've been fooled by the same sort of
+object many a time. But let it pass, boys. We've turned our back on
+the old quarry now, and are headed for the road again, two miles
+above Hobson's mill-pond. I only hope we find it better going on
+this end of the abandoned trail. This jumping is hard on the springs
+of the car, and also on our bones."
+
+"For one," said Julius, "I hope never to set eyes on the place again."
+
+"Oh! that's silly talk, Julius," commented K. K. "Here's Hugh, who
+means to take a run out this way again as soon as he can, so as to
+time himself, and learn just what he can save by cutting across
+country in the big race. And I wouldn't be surprised if he put
+'Just' Smith up to the dodge, in addition to Horatio here and myself,
+all being entered as contestants in the big Marathon race."
+
+"I certainly feel that way, K. K.," admitted Hugh firmly. "It
+strikes me this is going to be worth trying. If one of our crowd can
+save time by taking this route, while the other fellows go all the
+way around by road, that same thing may give Scranton High the
+clinching of the prize. It's all fair and square, too, for the
+conditions only demand that the runners refuse all sorts of lifts
+while on the road, and register at each and every tally place
+designated. If they can cut a corner they are at liberty to do so."
+
+"Oh! well," said Julius; "I'm not entered in the Marathon, luckily
+enough, so you see there's no need of my prowling around this spooky
+place again. I haven't lost any quarry, that I know of; and Scranton
+is a good enough place for me to do my athletic exercises in. But,
+Hugh, if you should happen to find out about the thing that emitted
+all those frightful squawks, I hope you'll promise to let us know the
+particulars."
+
+"I can promise that easily enough, Julius," the other told him;
+"though, just at present, my only concern is to gain time by this
+cut-off, and so win the big event for our school. Now suppose we
+drop this subject, and return to something pleasant."
+
+They continued to bump along the rocky road with its deep ruts. At
+times K. K. had to make little detours in order to navigate around
+some obstacle which could not be surmounted; for time had not dealt
+lightly with the quarry road, and the rains and wintry frosts had
+played havoc with its surface.
+
+But, eventually, they sighted light ahead. Steve was the first to
+glimpse an opening, and announce that the main highway leading down
+to Scranton must be close at hand. His words turned out to be true,
+and soon afterwards they issued forth from the covert and found
+themselves upon the turnpike, headed for home.
+
+Hugh turned around to mark the spot well in his mind, though he knew
+that it was to be the exit, and not the entrance, to the short-cut,
+in case he concluded to utilize the quarry road when the great race
+was on.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IV
+
+IN TRAINING FOR THE GREAT TOURNAMENT
+
+It was an afternoon on the following week, after school hours, and
+the athletic field bordering the outskirts of the town of Scranton
+afforded a pretty lively spectacle. Indeed, it could be readily seen
+that the approaching tournament had taken a great hold upon the young
+people of the town.
+
+Scores of boys were busily engaged in various exercises, under the
+watchful eye of Mr. Leonard, the assistant principal under Dr.
+Carmack. This determined-looking young fellow was a college
+graduate, and had taken considerable interest in all manner of
+athletics; indeed, it was well known that he had played on one or
+more of the college teams during his course, and won quite an
+enviable reputation for good work, though hardly reckoned a brilliant
+star.
+
+Many who did not expect to participate in any of the numerous events
+had gathered to watch what was going on; and, besides, there were
+clusters of pretty high-school girls on the side lines, chattering
+like magpies, and venting their opinions regarding the chances
+certain favorites among their boy friends appeared to have in the way
+of winning a prize.
+
+Scores were busily engaged in running around the cinder-path, taking
+the high jump, trying the hurdles, so as to perfect themselves
+against the coming Saturday when the wonderful event was to come off;
+sprinting for the short races of fifty, or a hundred yards; throwing
+the discus or the hammer, and numerous other lively doings.
+
+Among these participants there were a number whom the reader of
+previous volumes in this series will readily recognize, and possibly
+gladly meet again. There was Alan Tyree, for instance, whose
+masterly pitching had done so much to land the pennant of the Three
+Town High School League that season for Scranton; Owen Dugdale, the
+efficient shortstop of the local nine; "Just" Smith, whose real name
+it happened was Justin, but who seldom heard it outside of school and
+home. He was a fleet runner, and had ably filled the position of
+left fielder when Scranton carried the school colors to victory over
+Allandale in that last heart-breaking game. Besides these, Joe
+Danvers was on deck, doing all sorts of wonderful stunts at throwing
+the hammer and taking the long jump, for Joe delighted in a variety
+of specialties and did not confine himself to any one particular
+thing; also might be seen one Claude Hastings, a chap who was a
+regular monkey in his way, and who always kept the crowd laughing by
+his antics, such as might be expected of a prize clown at the big
+Barnum and Bailey circus.
+
+Yes, and there was Nick Lang, as big as life, running like the wind
+around the cinder-path and looking as though he might have a pretty
+fair chance to carry off some sort of prize. Nick had for a long
+time been the town bully. He was not a rich man's son; in fact,
+Nick's folks were poor, and some people even thought the big,
+overgrown boy should be at work helping to keep the wolf from the
+door, instead of still attending high school and making himself a
+nuisance to decent folks through his delight in practical jokes and
+his bullying propensities.
+
+But even those who detested Nick Lang the most were willing to admit
+that he was a pretty fair athlete and could even have excelled along
+several lines if only he were able to control that nasty temper of
+his and "play fair."
+
+There were two other fellows, who were cronies of Nick's, and who,
+apparently, had entered for some of the events, because both Leon
+Disney and Tip Slavin were in evidence and hard at work practicing.
+
+Nick secretly hated, even as he also feared, Mr. Leonard, because the
+under-teacher had once cowed him and made him "eat humble pie" before
+the whole class; but, being a wise as well as pugnacious boy, Nick
+managed to keep his feelings under control, and when Mr. Leonard was
+around he usually behaved himself.
+
+Later in the afternoon, when most of the boys out for practice had
+become more or less tired from their exertions, they gathered here
+and there in little bunches to exchange "chaff," and express their
+opinions concerning various matters that had a bearing on the coming
+tournament.
+
+So Hugh Morgan found himself in a cluster that contained several of
+his chums, as well as a sprinkling of other fellows. A trio of
+lively highschool girls hovered near, and occasionally joined in the
+conversation. They were Sue Barnes, whom Hugh usually counted on as
+his partner when any dance was given in the country, or at
+singing-school during the winter evenings; Ivy Middleton, Thad's
+choice for company, because she was both jolly and genial; and pretty
+Peggy Noland, whom Owen Dugdale liked, as had also Nick Lang, though
+the latter had of late been badly snubbed by the scornful Peggy
+because she could not stand for his rowdy ways.
+
+"Mr. Leonard says he's fully satisfied with the way most of the
+fellows are showing up," Joe Danvers was saying, about that time.
+
+"Well, we can't afford to loaf, for a fact," remarked Just Smith,
+soberly. "Let me tell you something, fellows. I was down in Paul
+Kramer's sporting emporium just last evening, when who should walk in
+but Big Ed. Patterson, the Allandale pitcher, who came so near to
+downing us last summer. He looks as fine as silk, and told me
+privately he calculates on carrying off that prize offered for hammer
+throwing, because that is his pet hobby, you see. Yes, and more than
+that, he said they were all crazy up at his 'burg' over the big meet,
+boys being out practicing every sort of stunt, even to road-running
+by moonlight."
+
+"That sounds good to me," Hugh observed, not appearing to show any
+sign of alarm over the stirring news. "It means we'll have a
+wonderfully successful affair. Who carries off the prizes is a
+matter for the different schools to take care of, and those of us who
+believe in clean, honest sport only hope the best fellows win."
+
+"Huh!" grunted Owen Dugdale, "it goes to show that Allandale is all
+worked up over losing the baseball pennant to Scranton, and means to
+get even by carrying off the majority of the prizes our committee has
+offered for the dozen or more events to be contested for."
+
+"But he also informed me," continued the bearer of news, "that over
+in Belleville they were just as much excited as in his town, so that
+every fellow who'd entered for any event, even to climbing the
+greased pole or the sack race, was diligently practicing his
+particular stunt. Oh! it's just going to be the greatest athletic
+tournament ever held in this section of the country, believe me."
+
+Some of the more timid among the boys seemed to think that Scranton
+would come out second-best when the great meet was a thing of the
+past; but others only found themselves more determined than ever to
+win, after learning how their rivals had entered into the affair with
+heart and soul.
+
+Hugh's often-expressed motto that the "best man should win" found an
+echo in the majority of their hearts, and they vied with each other
+in promising to give every ounce of ability to doing Scranton High
+credit.
+
+Mr. Leonard came around to have a few words with his boys. He was a
+great favorite with the majority of the scholars under his charge,
+and to his clever method of coaching they attributed considerable of
+their success on the diamond of recent months. If only his rules
+were strictly adhered to it was possible that Allandale and
+Belleville might be due for another rude surprise when they came
+over, bent on carrying off the majority of the high honors.
+
+"It is going to be no easy sledding for anybody,--remember that,
+fellows," the athletic instructor went on to say, after he had been
+told how both adjoining towns entered in the meet were striving with
+might and main to excel in every sort of event. "No matter who wins
+he'll only get there by doing his level best. That's all Scranton
+High asks of her representatives. Let there be no loafing, and if
+some of our good friends from A and B succeed in carrying away a few
+of the prizes, why, we'll know they earned the right, and are welcome
+to their reward. And now, I'd like to see you runners try one more
+ten-minute sprint, every one of you in a bunch, as a sort of wind-up
+for the day."
+
+Accordingly they ran off to the starting-point and lined up, each
+assuming his particular favorite crouching attitude, which he seemed
+to think best fitted for a speedy "get-away" when the signal was
+given.
+
+They ran like colts, and some displayed amazing speed, considering
+that they had been diligently working out on that same cinder-path
+for over two hours, with little intermissions between for resting.
+
+Those who expected to take part in the Marathon did not attempt to
+compete with those fleet sprinters, though if they were pressed
+doubtless they too could give quite an exhibition of fast running.
+
+But Mr. Leonard had taken great pains to inform them that the
+successful long-distance runners always take things moderately easy
+in the beginning of a race, preserving as much vigor as possible for
+the gruelling finish. The chief idea was to keep just behind the
+pace-maker, and be ready to rush to the front when on the
+home-stretch. The fellow best able to preserve his full powers for
+that last half-mile dash would be the one to carry off the honors.
+
+Nick Lang was there with the rest, watching Hugh out of the tail of
+his eye, as if he considered that in the other he would find his
+chief competitor; possibly he hoped to be able to pick up valuable
+points by keeping watch and ward on Hugh. Hugh had even consulted
+Mr. Leonard with regard to making use of his knowledge concerning
+that "cut-off." In fact, he wanted to lay any doubts that may have
+arisen in his own mind concerning its being perfectly legitimate that
+he should profit by such knowledge.
+
+The athletic instructor assured him he was keeping fully within the
+conditions of the race in so doing.
+
+"It is any competitor's privilege to go over the route as often as he
+pleases," was the way Mr. Leonard put it; "and so long as he conforms
+to the rules, such as keeping on his own feet every yard of the way,
+accepting no lift from wagon or car, and registering faithfully at
+the several stations provided, he has done all that is expected of
+him. If by crossing a field he thinks he can cut off fifty feet or
+more he is at liberty to make the attempt, although it may cost him
+dear, through his meeting with some unexpected obstacle in his
+progress, which would not have occurred had he stayed by the road.
+Some fellows might believe they could do better than trying to cross
+by way of that overgrown quarry road. Yes, you are keeping well
+within the letter of the law in choosing your own way of going, Hugh.
+Have no fears on that score, my boy."
+
+Mr. Leonard liked Hugh Morgan exceedingly; though that was not to be
+wondered at, because Hugh was one of those boys who would never stoop
+to do a tricky thing, no matter what allurements it held out; he
+always "played square," and even won the high regard of his rivals in
+many cases.
+
+When the October sun had reached the horizon the multitude of
+contestants and spectators commenced to string back to town, for it
+would soon be getting near supper time; and no fellow likes to be
+late at the table, especially when he feels as hungry as a bear,
+after exercising so violently for hours.
+
+Hugh was starting off alone, when Thad Stevens called out that he'd
+like the other to "hold up a minute," until he could overtake him;
+because it happened he had something to communicate which he thought
+Hugh ought to know.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER V
+
+TREACHERY IN THE AIR
+
+"Hugh, it looks to me like there's a hen on," was what Thad Stevens
+said, as he joined his chum.
+
+"That's a queer remark for you to make, Thad," the other chuckled;
+"after seeing what's been happening here on our athletic field this
+afternoon, I'd be likely to say there were a good many score of hens
+setting, each hoping to hatch out one of our dandy prizes next
+Saturday."
+
+"Oh! you understand that I mean something crooked going on, Hugh,"
+Thad hastened to add.
+
+"That sounds serious enough. What do you know, Thad? The chances
+are ten to one if anything in the way of trickery is contemplated I
+can put my hand on the fellow who's guilty of the same."
+
+"Sure thing, Hugh, and his name is Nicholas in the bargain. They
+call him Young Nick, to distinguish him from his father who's dead
+and gone; but sometimes people say he's a regular Old Nick when it
+comes to playing mean jokes, and getting into trouble of all kinds."
+
+"What's Nick Lang been up to now, Thad?"
+
+"Oh! just spying on you, for one thing!" exclaimed the other angrily.
+
+"He's welcome to chase around after me as often as he pleases," said
+Hugh; "much good will it do him, I'm thinking. But tell me, why
+should he go to all that bother, when my going-out and coming-in
+don't interfere with his happiness a whit?"
+
+"Hugh, Nick is on to your scheme for making use of that short-cut
+across by way of the old deserted quarry!"
+
+"You don't tell me?" Hugh observed. "Well, I came near speaking to
+him about it myself, Thad. You see, Nick is entered for the
+Marathon, just the same as a number of other Scranton High boys are.
+If K. K., Just Smith, and several other fellows are to have the
+benefit of that cut-off, if they choose to avail themselves of it,
+why shouldn't Nick be included, I've been asking myself? Yes, and
+I'd about concluded it was my duty to let him know; but if, as you
+say, he's found out for himself I'll be saved all the bother of
+telling."
+
+"He followed you across yesterday, Hugh. By a mere accident I heard
+him telling Tip Slavin, and he seemed to think it a good joke,
+because you never once suspected he was spying on you from behind
+trees and bushes. Why, he says he followed you clear across to the
+road again."
+
+Hugh shrugged his shoulders.
+
+"Then I give Nick full credit for carrying out a clever piece of
+business. I never once remember suspecting that anybody was around.
+But, Thad, what's worrying you? There isn't anything about that
+discovery to excite you."
+
+"Hugh, that boy means to do something mean, and it's got a connection
+with the short-cut quarry road in the bargain!"
+
+Hugh turned and looked at the speaker a little gravely.
+
+"I suppose now you've got some good reason for making that
+accusation, Thad?" he ventured.
+
+"Yes, I have," came the quick reply. "I heard him say something to
+that other sneak which I couldn't just catch, but it started Tip
+laughing like everything. He slapped a hand down on his knee, and
+went on to say: 'Fine, Nick, finer than silk! I bet you he'll be as
+mad as hops if he finds himself caught in such a trap, and loses the
+race. You can depend on me every time. My affair comes off right in
+the start, and I can easy get out there on my wheel long before the
+first runner heaves in sight. I'll coach Pete Dudley in his part,
+just as you were saying. It's the greatest trick you ever hatched
+up, Nick, the very greatest!' Now, you can judge for yourself, Hugh,
+whether it's safe for you to try to cross by that same quarry road
+when the big Marathon race is on."
+
+Hugh seemed lost in thought for a brief interval. When he spoke
+again there was a settled look of grim determination on his face that
+Thad could easily understand, knowing the other as well as he did.
+
+"It isn't my way to show the white feather when the first cold wind
+starts to blowing, Thad, and no matter what Nick is planning to do
+I'm not going to give him the first chance to profit by my discovery
+of that short-cut route from road to road."
+
+"That means you decline to be shoved off the path, does it, Hugh?"
+
+"If I start in that race, as I expect to," Hugh told him, "I intend
+to make use of that short-cut, no matter if a dozen Tip Slavins, and
+Pete Dudleys are lying in wait to trip me up. But I'm much obliged
+to you all the same, Thad, for your warning. I'll be on my guard
+from this time on, and they're not going to trap me with my eyes
+blinded, I tell you that."
+
+Thad seemed to be lost in thought himself for a minute or so.
+Possibly he was trying to figure out how he could best serve his
+comrade in such an emergency. The gloomy woods surrounding the old
+quarry did not possess any attraction in the eyes of Thad Stevens.
+Though he had not shown the same degree of alarm as Horatio and
+Julius at the time they heard those remarkable sounds, so like human
+shrieks, nevertheless, Thad felt no hankering after another similar
+experience.
+
+Still he would brave much in order to help the chum whose interests
+were so dear to his own heart. He did not say what was in his mind,
+only looked a bit wise, as he once more turned to Hugh, as though his
+mind had been finally made up.
+
+"Just as you think best, Hugh," he went on to say quietly. "It may
+be that one or more of the other fellows will be taking advantage of
+that same old road, and there's safety in numbers, you know, they say.
+Nick is likely to get his fingers burned if he attempts any of his
+silly tricks. What do you suppose now he could plan to have those
+chaps do? They wouldn't want to really hurt you, because that might
+get them in bad with Captain Wambold, our police head. Can you think
+of any fool play he'd be apt to conjure up, such as might make Tip
+say it was the best and slickest scheme he'd ever heard about?"
+
+"Nick has so many wild ideas that he's likely to attempt nearly
+anything," said Hugh. "If he could find a good place where a runner
+would have to keep to the road I even believe he'd try to dig a deep
+pit, and cover the same over, just as the wild-animal catchers do in
+Africa, when they go out after big game for the menageries and zoos."
+
+"Why, would that work, do you think, Hugh?" cried the startled Thad,
+mentally picturing his chum crashing through a false roadbed, and
+dropping down into a deep hole from which, alone and unaided, he
+could not hope to escape until much time had elapsed, and all hope of
+winning the big Marathon was lost.
+
+"It might have done so if I hadn't chanced to possess a wide-awake
+chum, who gave me due warning, and caused me to keep a sharp lookout.
+As it is, if I glimpse a suspicious spot in my path I'll fight mighty
+shy of the same; or by a big leap give it the go-by. Of course,
+there might be other ways in which they could hope to detain me, such
+as dropping down on my shoulders from a tree, and with their faces
+covered so I couldn't recognize them."
+
+Thad looked grave.
+
+"Yes, they could do that, for a fact," he admitted. "Seems to me
+you'll have to keep one eye aloft all the while, Hugh, while the
+other is watching the ground for treachery. I must say this is a
+fine state of affairs. Not only does Scranton High have to go smack
+up against all the best runners of Allandale and Belleville, but be
+on the lookout for treachery at home besides. I'd give something to
+be one of a bunch of indignant fellows to take Nick Lang and his two
+pals out to the woods some fine night, and give the same a coat of
+tar and feathers, or else ride them on a rail. They're a disgrace to
+the community, and Scranton ought to take them in hand right away.
+That boy will set the town on fire yet I'm thinking, with his
+desperate tricks."
+
+"He will, unless he soon sees a light, and turns over a new leaf,"
+admitted Hugh, who, it seems, had an idea of his own in connection
+with the said Nick, which, perhaps, he might find an opportunity to
+work out one of these days; but which he did not care to confide to
+his chum, because he knew Thad would be apt to consider it
+impossible, perhaps foolish.
+
+"There they go now, Hugh," suddenly remarked Thad in an undertone.
+"You see, he has both Tip and Leon along with him, and they're
+grinning as they look over this way. I warrant you Nick has been
+elaborating on that fine scheme of his; and, in anticipation, they
+can already see you held up in that lonely place, kicking your toes
+at the bottom of a miserable pit, or else tied to a tree."
+
+"Don't scowl so savagely, Thad," warned Hugh. "There's no need of
+letting them understand we're on to their game. The advantage always
+lies in catching the other fellow off his guard. Let's laugh while
+we walk past, as if we'd been figuring out how a certain prize was
+already dangling close to our fingertips."
+
+So Thad managed to "take a brace," profiting by the sage advice of
+his comrade; and, as they passed Nick and his two cronies, Hugh
+remarked as pleasantly as he could:
+
+"I've been watching you run to-day, Nick, and I honestly believe you
+are right up with the top-notchers in the game. There may be some
+surprises next Saturday for those who think they've got it all
+figured out who's going to win the prizes. And Nick, as far as I'm
+concerned, I'd like to see you take the long-distance prize, honestly
+and cleanly, if I can't get it myself. You're a representative of
+Scranton High, Nick, and we're all out to see the old school do
+herself proud."
+
+Nick seemed taken aback by these hearty words on the part of the
+fellow whom he had so long sought an opportunity to injure. He shot
+a hasty glance, accompanied by the uplifting of his heavy eyebrows,
+toward his companions, who, thereupon, catching a sly wink, perhaps,
+both chuckled audibly as though amused.
+
+"Oh! I've already as good as copped that Marathon prize," Nick went
+on to say, at the same time thrusting out his chin in his customary
+aggressive and boastful fashion. "I calculate to give the folks some
+surprise by the ease with which I'll come in away ahead of the next
+competitor. There'll be a wheen of those who also ran, bringing up
+the tail of the procession. Long-distance is my best suit, and I've
+waited a while to show up certain chaps in this town who think they
+are just the thing. Don't worry about me, Morgan; Nick Lang
+generally gets there when he throws his hat into the ring."
+
+At that the other two laughed uproariously, as though they thought
+the joke too good for anything. Possibly they took Nick's reference
+to "those who also ran" to mean Hugh Morgan particularly; and in
+their minds they could see him desperately trying to break his bonds;
+or climb up out of the deep pit into which he had gone crashing when
+the covered mattress, formed of slender twigs and dead leaves, had
+given way under his weight.
+
+Hugh and Thad walked on, the latter fairly boiling with
+illy-suppressed anger.
+
+"That fellow always gives me a pain, Hugh," he was saying, as they
+increased the distance separating them from the still merry trio in
+the rear. "He is really the meanest boy you could find in all the
+towns of this country. But fellows like him sometimes catch a
+Tartar; so, perhaps, it might happen in this case," and Thad, who
+evidently had something on his mind, would not commit himself
+further, as they walked on in company.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VI
+
+THE PROWLER
+
+There had been considerable of a change in connection with the big
+open field where the boys of Scranton were allowed by the town
+council and mayor to play baseball, and also football, since summer
+waned. Somehow the success that attended the work of Scranton High
+in the battles of the Three Town League, as narrated in an earlier
+volume of this series, seemed to have stirred up many of the leading
+citizens. Besides, Mr. Leonard, the efficient under-principal of the
+high school, with a genuine love and sympathy for all boys in his
+heart, had kept things at boiling pitch.
+
+Consequently there was, first of all, a move made to lease that
+splendid field for a long term of years, from the owner, so that the
+young people of Scranton might have some central place to gather for
+all sorts of outdoor games and sports.
+
+So subscriptions were started looking to collect a fund with which
+not only to erect some sort of decent grandstand, but a building that
+would contain a number of conveniences such as most athletic grounds
+and similar institutions can boast.
+
+This building had now been completed, and the boys were in full
+possession. It contained, among other things, a score and more of
+lockers, where the one who paid a small fee could keep his "fighting
+togs," as Thad Stevens was wont to term his baseball clothes, or it
+might be the scanty raiment he wore when exercising on the athletic
+field, running, or boxing, or wrestling.
+
+Each boy who hired such a locker, of course, carried the key to the
+same; and when engaged in practice work rested easy in the belief
+that his street garments were securely taken care of.
+
+There was also a shower-bath and a pool in the building, as well as
+several other conveniences that could be used in the summer time
+during the hot weather. The boys arranged to take turns in shifts
+with regard to keeping the building clean, and thus far the scheme
+had worked very well; for the town did not care to go to the extra
+expense of hiring a custodian.
+
+Besides this, a high fence was ordered to be built around the entire
+grounds, for most other towns had their athletic fields enclosed. It
+would keep the rowdy element from disturbing the players when any
+game was in progress; and, as a small admission fee might often be
+asked, having one or two gates through which admission to the grounds
+could be obtained would facilitate matters greatly.
+
+But this was not all. Scranton had awakened to the fact that Nature
+had been rather unkind to her young people, in that there was no
+large lake, or even so much as a small river close by her borders.
+When the boys and girls of the town felt inclined to skate after a
+sharp freeze along about New Year's Day, they had to walk all the way
+out to Hobson's mill-pond, situated between half and two-thirds of a
+mile away. This was not so bad for some of the sturdy chaps, but
+there were others who disliked taking such long tramps, especially
+after violent exercising for hours, it might be, on the ice.
+
+So, after mature deliberation, and receiving valuable suggestions
+from Mr. Leonard, as well as others who had seen similar things
+successfully carried out in various places, it had been arranged to
+flood the field after winter had fully set in. Then, during the time
+of severe weather, the young folks would have a splendid sheet of ice
+right at their doors, a comfortable retreat into which they could go
+to warm up, or to put on and remove their skates.
+
+Here various games were expected to be indulged in, as the weather
+permitted; and already a fine hockey Seven had been organized, under
+the leadership of Hugh Morgan, with a promise of many exciting games
+against rival teams.
+
+The high board fence was being erected, but would hardly be completed
+before Spring; still, it gave an air of business to the grounds, and
+the boys had already begun to congratulate themselves over the great
+stride forward Scranton had taken in the way of catering to her
+rising population.
+
+Of course, there were those in the town--you can always find a few in
+every community--who seriously objected to so much "good money being
+wasted," as they termed it, on such trivial things, when Scranton
+really needed an up-to-date library building in place of the poor
+apology for one that had to serve.
+
+These people, doubtless from worthy motives, though they were
+short-sighted in their opposition, lost no opportunity for running
+down the entire enterprise. The person who, perhaps, had more
+influence than any of the others, and was more vehement in deriding
+the "foolish expenditure of funds along such silly lines, instead of
+trying to elevate the standard of reading among Scranton's young
+people," was the rich widow, Mrs. Jardine.
+
+She had a son named Claude, whose life was rendered miserable by the
+lofty ambition of his mother to make him a genius. She never ceased
+talking upon all sorts of elevating subjects; and where other boys
+were allowed to lead normal lives, and have lots of innocent if
+strenuous fun during vacations, and holidays, poor Claude led a life
+of bondage.
+
+He was rather an effeminate-looking boy, tall and slender, with a
+face entirely destitute of color such as would indicate abounding
+spirits and good health; but it was no wonder, everyone knew how he
+was being made such a "sissy" of by his doting "mamma."
+
+Despite all this there seemed to be a spark of ordinary boyish
+spirits concealed under Claude's superior airs. He sometimes stood
+and watched the other fellows engaged in playing prisoner's base, or
+some such rough-and-tumble game, with envy. Once upon a time his
+mother, chancing to pass along the street in her fine car, was
+horrified to discover her darling Claude actually taking part in some
+"rowdy game," in which he scrambled with the rest just as vehemently,
+and was, moreover, even worse off than the other boys with regard to
+soiled garments and disheveled hair. Evidently the long suppressed
+spirit of the lad had broken bounds, and for once he allowed himself
+to be natural.
+
+The other fellows never tired of telling how she had called to him
+almost frantically, as though she believed he had become inoculated
+with some deadly germ, and must be contaminated, bundling the boy
+into the car, and actually crying with dismay when she found that he
+actually had a scratch upon his nose, which had been bleeding. But
+it was also noticed that Claude grinned at his late fellow wrestlers
+as he was borne triumphantly away, as though to emphasize the fact
+that he had, at least, enjoyed one real period of excitement in his
+life, to remain as a bright spot for many days.
+
+Hugh had often wondered whether there might not be some way through
+which this deluded mother might be shown what a terrible error she
+was making in bringing up her boy to be so inane and useless. He
+needed physical development more than any other fellow in Scranton
+High. Constant feeding upon lofty ideas, and never given a chance to
+develop his muscles, was wrecking his health. Mr. Leonard had even
+gone to Mrs. Jardine and entreated her to let him undertake a
+moderate programme of athletic exercises with Claude; but he might as
+well have tried to lift the high-school building as to make her
+change her set ideas.
+
+Hugh and Thad had been out on a particular night after supper,
+visiting another boy who chanced to live on the outskirts of town.
+He had received a wonderful collection of curios from an uncle living
+out in India, after whom he had been named; and upon being especially
+invited over to view these things, which included a wonderful
+assortment of rare postage stamps, the two chums had made it a point
+to accept, being greatly interested in all boyish "hobbies."
+
+That was how they happened to be passing along the road close to the
+athletic grounds about half-past nine o'clock that same night.
+
+There was a fair moon shining, but objects appeared more or less
+misty, as often occurs under such conditions. The boys had about
+exhausted their vocabulary of words that express delight, in
+examining the many things of interest shown by "Limpy" Wallace, who
+was a cripple, and had to use a crutch, he being also a great admirer
+of Hugh Morgan, whom he considered in the light of a hero.
+
+Besides this, both boys were unusually tired after the exertions of
+the day, and Thad frequently yawned in a most terrific fashion, as he
+walked homeward. Probably these were the main reasons for their
+unnatural silence, as they stalked along side by side; since it is
+seldom that two lads will refrain from exchanging opinions on some
+subject or other, when in company.
+
+Afterwards, in the light of what happened, they were inclined to
+believe that it was exceedingly fortunate they had lapsed into this
+queer condition of silence, for, otherwise, they would have missed
+something that proved unusually interesting, as well as afforded them
+more or less excitement.
+
+It was Thad who discovered it first. Perhaps he chanced to be
+looking that way while Hugh was star-gazing. At any rate he gripped
+his chum suddenly by the arm.
+
+"Sh! Hugh, what's that yonder, a skulking dog, or a fellow half bent
+over?" was what Thad whispered in the ear of his chum.
+
+Both of them had come to a full stop, under the impulse of the
+moment; and Thad was pointing a little to the right, which was where
+the building erected on the athletic grounds stood, dimly seen in the
+mysterious moonlight.
+
+So Hugh, staring quickly, made out the object indicated by his
+companion. Really, he could hardly blame Thad for asking such a
+question, because at first it was next to impossible to determine
+whether it was a four-footed creature, or a human being who, for some
+good reason, was trying to make himself appear as small as possible.
+
+But as Hugh continued to look he saw the other raise himself to his
+full height, as though to take a cautious survey of his surroundings.
+Then he knew that it was no canine prowling around to discover scraps
+thrown aside by the carpenters working on the board fence, as they
+ate their noon lunch.
+
+"It's a human being all right, Thad," Hugh whispered, in such a low
+tone that even the sharpest pair of ears going could never have
+caught the sound ten feet away.
+
+"Man, or boy, Hugh?" asked Thad, copying the example set by the
+other, and even bending his head so that his lips might come closer
+to Hugh's right ear.
+
+"Can't make that out," he was told.
+
+"But what in the wide world is he trying to do?" pursued Thad, his
+curiosity now fully aroused, as the unknown again started to move
+forward, pursuing the same strange cautious tactics as before.
+
+"That's what we ought to find out," Hugh told him. "I don't like the
+way he's sneaking around here. It looks as if he might be up to some
+game."
+
+"Oh! perhaps it's a tramp," suggested Thad, as the idea dawned upon
+his brain.
+
+"He may be meaning to break into the building, to sleep there
+to-night. I wouldn't put it past a hobo to steal anything he could
+find left in the lockers. Hugh, it's up to us to put a kink in his
+rope. Let's chase after him before he disappears."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VII
+
+CAUGHT IN THE ACT
+
+"Hold on, Thad," continued Hugh, as he put a restraining hand on the
+shoulder of his more impulsive chum, "we've got to be careful, or
+else he'll learn how we're meaning to spy on him. Bend over, and do
+the grand sneak act."
+
+"He's headed straight for the building, Hugh!" breathed the other, as
+he complied with the directions given by the one whom he was
+accustomed to look upon in the light of a leader.
+
+"That's right, and I guess he's meaning to crawl inside, if only he
+can find a window that's been left unfastened. Steady now, Thad;
+he's stopped under one right now!"
+
+They continued to crouch there and watch what went on, their eyes
+glued upon the dimly seen figure of the unknown. Greatly to the
+surprise of Thad, the party stepped to one side, and seemed to be
+dragging back a heavy plank, not of any vast length, but sufficiently
+long to reach the window when placed on a slant.
+
+"Say, did you notice how he seemed to know just where that plank was
+lying, Hugh?" asked Thad deliriously. "Seems like he must have been
+spying out the land by daylight beforehand."
+
+"You're right there," whispered Hugh; "and he acts as if he felt
+pretty certain that particular window would be unfastened, in the
+bargain."
+
+"Hugh, that settles it," added the other sturdily, as though now
+fully convinced.
+
+"Yes, settles what, Thad?"
+
+"Why, it's a _boy_, don't you see, and he must have left that
+window unlatched on purpose this afternoon when some of the
+fellows were shutting up."
+
+"Wait and see," advised Hugh, although almost convinced of the same
+thing himself.
+
+The test was not long in coming. They could see the other "shinning"
+up the sloping plank, as any athletic boy would be apt to do, without
+any particular trouble. Now he had reached the window, and Thad held
+his breath in suspense. He sighed as he heard a slight squeaking
+sound. Evidently the sash which was supposed to be fastened every
+night through ordinary prudence, had given way to his hand, when he
+exerted some pressure.
+
+"He's going in, Hugh!" Thad observed, again laying a quivering hand
+on the arm of his comrade, and then following these words with a low
+exclamation of startled wonder: "Oh! look there, what's that queer
+glow mean?"
+
+Hugh understood readily enough.
+
+"Why, he's got one of those little handy electric torches, you see,
+and is using it so as to get his bearings inside the building."
+
+"Guess you're right, Hugh," admitted the other; "and there, he's
+crawling over the sill now, as sure as anything. Oh! the skunk, what
+can he be up to?"
+
+"We'll try and find out," said Hugh, with his usual promptness. "Now
+he's gone further from the window let's be moving along. That plank
+ought to make it easy sledding for fellows like us."
+
+Indeed, it would be hard to find a couple of more athletic boys than
+Hugh and his chum. Their intense love for every type of outdoor
+sport had kept them in splendid physical condition, so that their
+muscles were as firm as those of an athlete in training. To make
+their way up that sloping board and reaching the open window was
+likely to prove a mere bit of child's play with such fellows.
+
+Hugh was the first to ascend. When he had raised himself so that he
+could peep over the window ledge and see within the building he
+apparently found the coast clear; for Thad, coming along just behind,
+received a gentle prod with a toe, twice repeated, which he knew to
+be a signal that all was well.
+
+By the time Thad arrived the other was already well within the room,
+having slipped across the window-sill without making the slightest
+sound. All was dark around them, but further on they could see that
+weird shaft of light moving this way and that, indicating the spot
+where the unknown intruder just then happened to be located.
+
+"He's making for the locker room, don't you see, Hugh?" Thad
+ventured, with a perceptible quiver to his low voice.
+
+"Sure thing, and he knows where he's going, in the bargain," the
+other went on.
+
+"Of course, it's no hobo, then," continued Thad. "That scamp knows
+every foot of ground under this roof. You can see it by the way he
+keeps straight on. Hugh, do you think it might be Nick Lang?"
+
+After all, it was only natural for Thad to jump to this conclusion,
+because of the evil reputation enjoyed by the boy he mentioned. Nick
+Lang had been the bully and the terror of Scranton for years. There
+was seldom a prank played (from stealing fruit from neighboring
+farmers, to painting old Dobbin, a stray nag accustomed to feeding on
+the open lots, so that the ordinarily white horse resembled the
+National flag, and created no end of astonishment as he stalked
+around, prancing at a lively rate when the hot sun began to start the
+turpentine to burning), but that everybody at once suspected Nick of
+being the conspirator.
+
+Possibly he may not have always been the chief offender; but give Dog
+Tray a bad name and he gets the blame of everything that happens
+calculated to outrage the respectability of the law-abiding community.
+
+"I thought of him at first," replied Hugh, "but it strikes me that
+chap isn't of Nick's build. You see his light leaves his figure
+pretty much in the dark; for he's using it principally to show him
+the way, so he won't stumble over any chair, and make no end of a
+row."
+
+The two had been stealthily creeping forward all this while, and
+were, therefore, gradually diminishing the distance separating them
+from the bearer of the electric hand-torch. Thad had evidently been
+consulting his memory concerning something, for presently he again
+whispered in his chum's ear:
+
+"Then mebbe it might be Leon Disney, Hugh. Seems to me that sneak
+would be just the one to try some mean trick like this. And,
+besides, I happen to know he bought one of those little vest-pocket
+lights down at Paul Kramer's store only three nights ago, because I
+saw him testing them and heard him say he'd take it."
+
+"Yes, that looks significant, I must say, Thad. But I'm trying to
+make out what he's done with his head. Don't you notice he's got it
+bundled up with a sort of woollen comforter or something like that?"
+
+"Why, so he has," replied the other; "I tell you what, Hugh, he's
+hoping to hide his face, so if he's discovered prowling around in
+here no one can say positively that they recognized him. Leon is up
+to all those sly tricks. He gets ideas like that out of the stories
+he's so fond of soaking in."
+
+"Keep still now, Thad, and we'll creep closer," warned the other.
+
+They really had their hands full endeavoring to advance upon the
+prowler without making any sort of sound that would arouse his
+suspicions. Hugh realized that if anything of this sort occurred the
+other would instantly throw the full glow of his little electric
+torch in their direction, and, of course, immediately discover their
+presence. If such a thing happened it might interfere with their
+suddenly arranged plan of campaign, and prevent the capture they
+contemplated, which would be a grievous disappointment to both boys.
+
+The unknown party had come to a standstill. He stood there in front
+of the long row of new lockers in which the boys who meant to take
+part in the principal events of the great athletic tournament kept
+their possessions, without which they would be more or less
+handicapped in their practice work.
+
+Thad had made another important discovery; indeed, it struck him as
+so significant that he could not forbear dragging Hugh down so that
+he could place his lips against the other's ear and whisper:
+
+"It's _your_ locker he's trying to open, Hugh, don't you see?"
+
+Hugh, of course, had already noted this circumstance, and felt duly
+thrilled, for really it struck him as something more than an
+accident, and along the lines of a deep design. Doubtless, his
+active brain started to wrestle with the problem as to why any one
+should wish to open his locker, since the only things he kept there
+consisted of his running jersey and trunks and shoes.
+
+Could it be possible that this was only some small piece of
+spite-work engineered by his old and inveterate enemy, Nick Lang, and
+ordered carried out by one of the bully's cronies; while Nick himself
+made certain to be in good company, so he could easily prove an alibi
+if accused of the mean trick.
+
+It seemed almost too contemptible to be true, since Hugh could easily
+purchase other garments down at the sporting-goods store in Scranton.
+Still, some mean natures are small enough to love to give "stabs"
+that might annoy the recipient; and boys sometimes grow so accustomed
+to certain articles of wearing apparel that being compelled to "break
+in" a new pair of running shoes might lose Hugh the great race!
+
+He gritted his teeth as a wave of indignation swept over him. Really
+it was high time this contemptible spirit of annoying those he chose
+to look upon in the light of enemies was crushed in Nick Lang. He
+had carried on with a "high horse" too long already, and, for one,
+Hugh felt as though combined action should be taken against him by
+the respectable fellows of Scranton High.
+
+But it was far from Hugh's intention to stand there and see his
+locker robbed by such an unprincipled fellow as Leon Disney, if,
+indeed, the skulker proved to be the party they suspected. Possibly
+Hugh moved too soon, for it would have been much wiser had he waited
+until the sneak thief actually had the locker open, and disclosed his
+full intention.
+
+Urged on to action by his indignation, Hugh started forward. Thad,
+realizing that it was his chum's intention to do something radical,
+skipped off a little to the right. He fancied that should the
+skulker take the alarm and try to flee, making for the open window in
+the rear, he was apt to turn aside and try to pass by; so his move
+was intended to block this little game.
+
+It turned out to be needless, for so interested was the fellow with
+the flash-light in his work of inserting a key in the lock, and
+trying to turn it, that he did not appear to notice anything wrong
+until Hugh was close at his elbow. Then, as Thad slipped around to
+one side to cover all lines of retreat, Hugh reached out a hand and
+caught hold of the fellow by the shoulder. At the same time he
+exclaimed in a severe voice:
+
+"Well, what are you doing here, I want to know, trying to break into
+my locker?"
+
+The other gave a tremendous start, and a low, bubbling cry, half of
+fright, and also of disgust, came from his lips. The woollen muffler
+fell from about his face, and, although he snapped off the light just
+then by a movement of his thumb, the others had glimpsed his features.
+
+Thad had evidently hit the target in the bull's-eye when he mentioned
+his suspicions concerning the probable identity of the skulker. It
+was Leon Disney!
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VIII
+
+LEON PROMISES TO REFORM
+
+The startled boy struggled to get free, but Hugh had taken a firmer
+grip upon his person, and saw to it that he could not squirm loose.
+
+"Quit your kicking!" cried Thad, indignantly, when one of the
+fellow's shoes came in rough contact with his own shins; "or we'll
+start something along the same lines! We know you, Leon Disney, so
+there's no use trying to hide your face."
+
+Leaning over, Thad groped around until he managed to find the hand
+that held the little electric torch. This latter article he tore
+from the grasp of Leon, and immediately pressed the button that
+caused the battery to work. The intense darkness around them was
+dissipated to some degree. Thad threw the glow directly into the
+face of the fellow Hugh was holding.
+
+Leon stopped his desperate struggles. He realized that the game was
+up so far as trying to keep his identity a secret; and, being a most
+resourceful sort of chap, he now resorted to another little scheme
+which he had undoubtedly thought out, to be used in case he was
+discovered, and cornered, while on his night mission.
+
+"Oh! is that you, Hugh?" he burst out, in a shaky voice. "Say, you
+gave me an _aw_ful scare! I thought it must be some old tramp that
+grabbed me, sure I did. It's all right now, Hugh, and I'm not
+wanting to clear out, since I know who you are. That's Thad, too, I
+reckon, holding my little flash-light. How you did startle me,
+though. I never dreamed anybody was around here when I started to
+come back after my watch."
+
+"What's that you say?" gasped Thad; "your watch? Tell that to the
+marines, Leon Disney!"
+
+"But it's so, I tell you. Thad, it sure is," persisted the other
+tenaciously, as though he had laid all his plans for just such an
+"accident," whereby his attempt to rob Hugh's locker would be held
+up. "I believe I must have forgotten to take it out of my locker
+this evening when I was dressing, after hard work on the field,
+running, and practising throwing the hammer. I never noticed it till
+long after supper, and I was afraid of what my dad would say when he
+asked me for it in the morning, to take back to the store where he
+got it, to exchange for another. So, Hugh, don't you see, the idea
+came to me that mebbe I might be able to get in the building out here
+if a window happened to be unfastened; which turned out to be the
+case, you know."
+
+"Yes, the very _first_ window you tackled in the bargain, Leon; how
+fortunate for you!" sneered the unbelieving Thad. "And say, you
+ought to know that this isn't your locker, because the numbers are
+painted big enough on the door for anybody with only one eye to see."
+
+Even this did not appear to disconcert the other boy. He was a
+slippery sort of customer, who always seemed able to find some sort
+of ready excuse, or a way to "climb down a tree" when caught in the
+act.
+
+He turned, and stared at the number 16 plainly on the door. Then he
+grinned at Thad as he hurriedly went on to explain further; for his
+inventive faculties seemed without end when they were exercised in
+order to get him out of any bad scrape:
+
+"Well, that shows my first guess was the right one after all. You
+see, Hugh, I knew my number was either 16 or 19, and, for the life of
+me, I couldn't tell which. Of course, if the first belongs to you
+when my number is 19, I was foolish to change my mind; though, of
+course, even if the key opened your locker I'd have known my mistake
+right away. No harm done, I hope, Hugh?"
+
+Thad made a low, growling sound, as though he put not the slightest
+faith in the story Leon was telling. He knew the other to be utterly
+unprincipled, and a willing tool in the hands of Nick Lang; indeed,
+there were some things about the sneaky Leon that blunt, honest Thad
+hated worse than the bullying propensities of the other boy.
+
+"So you really and truly left your watch in your locker, did you?" he
+demanded, with a perceptible sneer in his tones.
+
+"I think I did; in fact, I'm certainly hoping so," Leon hastily
+replied; "because if it doesn't happen to be there I don't know where
+I could have lost it; and I'll get a fine turning over from dad in
+the morning when he asks me for the same to take back, and exchange
+for one that keeps decent time."
+
+"Oh!" continued the still skeptical Thad, thinking to corner Leon,
+"then, perhaps, you'll prove your words by showing us the inside of
+your locker right now? Number 19 it would be, you said; well, here
+it is, on a direct line with Hugh's locker. Get busy with your key,
+Leon, and open up!"
+
+Possibly Thad was confident that the other would not venture to do as
+he demanded. He may have expected him to invent some handy excuse
+for not complying; but then the other had already laid the foundation
+for a reasonable sense of disappointment in case no watch was
+forthcoming when the locker was opened; since he said he _hoped_ he
+might have forgotten it when dressing, and not lost it on the way
+home that evening at dusk.
+
+Leon started to obey with alacrity, as though he had no fears. His
+key immediately opened the door, and this, upon being swung aside,
+revealed a bundle of old athletic garments hastily thrown in without
+regard to neatness.
+
+These Leon commenced to eagerly take out, one at a time. He was
+careful how he handled them, as though fearful lest he might toss the
+silver watch out, to land on the floor with disastrous results.
+
+As he picked up such various articles of wearing apparel as used by
+an athlete in training, Leon continued to air his grievances, as
+though he meant Hugh to understand how utterly impossible it was for
+him to have intended any mean thing by breaking open a locker other
+than his own:
+
+"It was silly of me getting those numbers mixed in my head, of
+course; but then a figure nine is only a six turned upside down, you
+see. I was so worked up over missing my clock that I just couldn't
+think straight at all. Well, it isn't under that jersey, anyhow; nor
+yet covered by those trunks. I remember now I pushed it away back,
+so I couldn't drag it out. There's an old sweater I use when I'm
+overheated, and afraid of taking cold; mebbe now it's under that."
+
+Reaching further in, Leon caught hold of the article in question, and
+carefully drew it toward him. Then he as cautiously lifted the torn
+sweater; and, as Thad turned the glow of the flash-light directly
+into the box they all saw the watch reposing in the corner, just as
+the boy had left it.
+
+Leon made a clutch for his property. He over-did the matter, Hugh
+thought, acting in an exuberant fashion.
+
+"Oh! mebbe I'm not joyful over getting my hands on you again, you
+poor old time-keeper!" he exclaimed, as he snatched the silver watch
+up and shook it, as though any fault could be attached to the article
+in question. "A fine chase you've given me to-night; and playing the
+part of sneak-thief in the bargain; but then, of course, you believe
+what I told you, now, Hugh, since you've seen that the watch was in
+my locker?"
+
+Hugh did not care to fully commit himself, it seemed, judging from
+the way in which he went on to say:
+
+"We've seen you recover your watch all right, Leon; and it was in
+your locker just as you said; but whether you forgot it, or left it
+there on purpose, is a question I'm not prepared to settle."
+
+Of course there was no further excuse for Hugh keeping that grip on
+Leon's shoulder, so he released his hold, and the other gave a sigh
+as of relief at this evidence of a change in policy on the part of
+his captor.
+
+"Say, I wish you'd do me a great favor, Hugh," Leon went on to say,
+as though he believed in the old maxim that it is wise to "strike
+while the iron is hot."
+
+"As to what?" demanded the one addressed in this whining way.
+
+"What's the use of saying anything about this business?" Leon went on
+eagerly. "It certainly wouldn't do any good, and I proved to you
+that I did enter here just to recover my watch, didn't I? But mebbe
+it might get to my dad's ears, how I'd gone and been so careless
+about looking after my property. You see, he told me that if I lost
+this birthday present he'd not get me another watch till I graduated
+from high school; and say, I'm beginning to lose all hope of that
+ever happening in my case. But you will keep mum about it, won't
+you, Hugh; just to save me from getting up against it rough with my
+strict dad?"
+
+It sounded like a reasonable request, Hugh must have thought.
+Besides, no matter what the intentions of Leon may have been, there
+had really been no harm done, owing to the fact of their being drawn
+to the spot by discovering his skulking figure dimly outlined in the
+moonlight.
+
+Hugh considered before committing himself to making any reply. He
+did not believe most of what the other so glibly declared, partly
+because he knew very well that Mr. Disney was not a strict parent at
+all, but a most indifferent one, or he would never have allowed his
+young hopeful to go in the company of Nick Lang, and take part in
+many of the other's practical jokes. Some of these had bordered on a
+serious nature, like the time the electric current was shut off
+abruptly when the graduation exercises were going on at night-time in
+the big auditorium in the high-school building; and the ensuing utter
+darkness almost created a panic among the audience, composed
+principally of women and young people, the wires having been severed,
+it was later discovered, at a point where they entered the building.
+
+"I'll say this, Leon," he finally told the waiting boy; "I'll keep
+quiet about this little thing for three days, and then feel free to
+mention it, if the necessity arises. I'll make a further bargain
+with you to this effect; you fight shy of the company of Nick Lang
+after this, and I'll hold my tongue as long as I understand that
+you've cut his acquaintance; otherwise, I'll feel free to speak; and
+there are lots of people in this town who'll believe you had some
+dark motive back of your breaking into this building to-night. Your
+reputation is against you, Leon, you understand. Another fellow
+might enter here, and everybody would believe what he said; but
+you've long ago lost the confidence of everybody worth while in
+Scranton. Is it a bargain, then?"
+
+Leon replied with alacrity; but then that was no sign that he meant
+to keep his word. He had been caught in a downright lie on many
+another occasion; so Hugh did not place much reliance on his promise
+to reform.
+
+"Oh! as to that, Hugh," said the crafty Leon, "I've been figuring on
+cutting away from Nick for a long time now, and I guess I'll do it.
+He's got me in lots of nasty scrapes, you understand, and then just
+laughs at me. I'd have given him the shake long since, only he
+threatened to whip me black and blue if I ever did. But this would
+be a good chance to try it out. Yes, I'll promise you to try and
+break away from Nick; and I hope you'll keep mum about my coming here
+to-night. If you don't mind, Thad, I'd like to have my flashlight
+now. And I ought to be going back home in the bargain, because dad
+doesn't like me to be out nights unless he knows where I'm at."
+
+Thad chuckled as though he considered this last remark in the light
+of a joke; for Leon roamed the streets until a late hour every night
+he chose; but, as there was no need of their staying longer, they
+passed out of the window, and headed toward their respective homes.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IX
+
+SCRANTON IN GALA ATTIRE
+
+That was, indeed, a busy Friday with the students of Scranton High.
+Lessons had been tabooed entirely, for what was the use of trying to
+hold the attention of the scholars upon dry subjects when their
+thoughts continually roamed afield, and seemed concerned only with
+what great things were scheduled for the next afternoon? Still, they
+gathered at school, which was a sort of general headquarters where
+the various committees appointed could consult, and go forth to the
+work assigned to their particular charge.
+
+The girls were just as enthusiastic as the boys, and demanded equal
+representation upon a number of the said committees, especially the
+ones designed for the welcome and entertainment of the vast crowds
+expected to be present from neighboring towns and villages.
+
+It was going to be an event long to be remembered in Scranton, and
+the town dressed in gala attire in honor of the occasion. Flags and
+banners were being displayed as though a great wave of patriotism had
+overwhelmed the place. If a stranger had suddenly dropped down on
+the town just then he must have believed American soldiers were on
+the fighting line across in France, and that news had been cabled
+over to the effect that they had met the enemy in their first
+engagement, and won a decisive victory.
+
+The fairly good town brass band had promised to be on hand, and play
+during the best part of the afternoon. Then there would be a host of
+refreshment booths at which Scranton's fairest daughters would
+preside, accompanied in each instance by a matron of mature years, to
+lend dignity to the occasion. Here the good folks from Allandale,
+Belleville and other places, who honored the town with their presence
+would always be warmly welcomed, and given a cup of delicious tea,
+coffee or chocolate, as they preferred, accompanied with sandwiches
+galore, and even cake.
+
+Meanwhile it was planned that those who meant to take part in any of
+the events on the long programme should have a last "workout" that
+Friday afternoon. Saturday morning it was intended they should rest
+up, so as to be in the pink of condition when the meet opened at one
+o'clock.
+
+That might seem to be an early hour, as some had argued, but the
+programme was so extended that there was a possibility of darkness
+creeping up on them before the fifteen-mile Marathon, the greatest
+event of the day, had been fully completed.
+
+During that energetic morning at school, when boys and girls were
+hustling to carry out the part of the work entrusted to them, Hugh
+had managed to keep an eye on Leon Disney from time to time. He felt
+pretty certain that the tricky boy had no intention of fulfilling the
+promise he had made under duress, and while a threat of exposure hung
+over his head, like the famous sword of Damocles, suspended by but a
+single hair.
+
+Leon watched Hugh also, and tried to act in a manner calculated not
+to arouse suspicion; but Hugh understood from his actions how matters
+probably stood. Leon had, of course, managed to see Nick Lang before
+coming to school, and explain to him what a bad fix he had managed to
+get himself in when caught in the act of breaking into Hugh Morgan's
+locker at the athletic grounds building.
+
+No doubt it had been artfully arranged between the precious pair that
+Leon was to seem to keep his distance away from Nick; and if at any
+other time the latter joined a group amidst whom Leon chanced to be
+standing the other was to immediately move away in an ostentatious
+fashion that would cause Hugh to believe he meant to keep his given
+word.
+
+But several times Hugh felt certain he detected sly winks exchanged
+between Nick and his apparently estranged pal; which could only mean
+that Leon was playing a double game. Still Hugh did not bother
+telling anyone about the affair of the preceding night. No harm had
+really been done, fortunately, and Leon might hold his evil
+propensities in check for a while if he had reason to fear disclosure.
+
+The committees were wearing their badges proudly, and every member
+seemed desirous of doing everything in his or her power to render the
+athletic tournament a wonderful success. Nothing like it had ever
+been attempted in the county, and for that reason they were compelled
+to look up all manner of accounts in papers and magazines, in order
+to do things properly.
+
+Mr. Leonard was a great help, for he, being a Princeton graduate, and
+interested in all manner of athletics for years, had kept in touch
+with such things. Then from various other unexpected sources
+assistance cropped up. Why, even old Doctor Cadmus, the leading
+physician of Scranton, proved to be a walking encyclopedia of
+knowledge concerning the management of such an event; and it turned
+out that several times long years before, in another community
+entirely, he had had full charge of just such a tournament; also that
+he had many articles laid away telling of the modern innovations that
+had displaced the older method of doing things.
+
+After lunch the young people began to gather on the field by squads
+and battalions, and it was soon quite an animated sight, with the
+girls circulating around in gaily dressed bunches, and the various
+candidates going through their various stunts under the personal
+supervision of Mr. Leonard.
+
+There had been more or less talk concerning the advisability of
+allowing school boys to undertake such a long Marathon race. Fifteen
+miles, many thought, was far too strenuous an undertaking for lads as
+yet in their teens. Full-fledged athletes only run twenty miles in
+all the famous long-distance races, and even at that numbers of them
+do not finish, the task being too much for them.
+
+But Mr. Leonard was of a different opinion, and he had his way. One
+thing, however, he did insist on. This was that each and every
+candidate entering for the Marathon fetch along with him a paper from
+his family physician, stating that he had undergone a rigid
+examination to ascertain whether he was in the pink of condition, and
+without the slightest heart trouble.
+
+Doctor Cadmus gladly examined all the Scranton fellows free of
+charge, and it was given out to the neighboring towns, from whence
+aspiring runners hailed, that the lack of such a physician's
+certificate would debar any candidate from the race.
+
+Hugh, along with several other fellows, intended to take a run of
+from seven to ten miles over the course that Friday afternoon. They
+did not wish to follow out the entire course, as that might injure
+their prospects for the next day, so Mr. Leonard convinced them. But
+half the distance would be apt to keep their muscles in good trim.
+
+Before making a start, however, Hugh wished to hang around, and watch
+what the other fellows were doing. He was deeply interested in the
+hammer throwing, as well as the sprinting, and, after seeing how well
+the boys acquitted themselves, felt more than ever assured that
+Scranton High would pull down quite a number of the fine prizes
+offered to successful competitors.
+
+It was while things were thus booming that a car rolled past on the
+main road leading out of town. Hugh noticed it particularly, for he
+chanced to be over at that side of the extensive field.
+
+There was a chauffeur at the wheel, and in the tonneau a lady and a
+boy sat, in whom Hugh quickly recognized Claude Jardine and his
+mother. She held her face deliberately away from the bright scene,
+as though appalled to know that so many parents in Scranton were so
+unwise, almost foolish, as to allow their sons to participate in such
+antics; and their daughters to attend the same.
+
+But Hugh chuckled when he saw Claude give a quick look up at his
+mother, as if to make certain she was not looking; after which he
+leaned forward and stared hard and eagerly at the wonderful picture
+that athletic field presented. Hugh had good eyesight, and he could
+detect the longing expression in the effeminate features of the boy
+whose mother seemed bent on making him a weakling and a "sissy."
+
+"Poor Claude, I certainly do pity you," Hugh was telling himself as
+the big car rolled on amidst a cloud of dust. "Deep down in your
+heart you are yearning to be as other natural boys are, who have red
+blood in their veins. If your dad had lived I warrant there'd be a
+different story to tell, because they say he liked all kinds of
+healthy sport; but, somehow, Mrs. Jardine has taken a dislike to such
+things that seems to keep growing stronger all the time, until it's
+become a regular mania with her. But unless she changes her mind
+there'll be a day coming when she'll bitterly regret it all. I
+suppose now, if she had a daughter she'd prevent her from associating
+with Sue, and Ivy, and Peggy, as well as all the other high-school
+girls whose mothers actually allow them to go to dances with us boys,
+and even cheer the Scranton players in a rattling good baseball game."
+
+There was an air of feverish expectation rampant throughout the whole
+town, and wherever young people got together the talk was of nothing
+else save the great event on the programme for the next day. Even
+many older persons seemed to have become infected with the sporting
+virus, because memories of other days were being recalled; and it was
+remarkable how many elderly men had once been deeply interested in
+just such things, though, of course, along somewhat less modern lines.
+
+Then again there was an undercurrent of talk that carried a thrill
+along with it. Stories that could not be confirmed, but were
+believed more or less, began to be circulated to the effect that some
+irresponsible parties meant to start something during the tournament
+that was calculated to bring disrepute upon the town of Scranton. It
+was even darkly hinted that the partly built, new, wooden fence had
+been set on fire as a lark; and squads of curious boys and girls even
+circulated along its entire length, bent upon ascertaining if such a
+thing could really be true.
+
+When they failed to find any evidence of a fire, they were still
+unconvinced; for, of course, it would be policy on the part of the
+management to conceal all traces, so as to save the good name of the
+town.
+
+These rumors could not be traced to any particular source, but there
+are always a certain number of persons who delight to circulate such
+stories, and, perhaps, unconsciously, add a little to the same with
+each and every additional telling, until a trivial happening becomes
+a colossal thing.
+
+That the committee in general charge of the great undertaking
+cherished some sort of fear that some daring outrage might be
+attempted by boys who were not connected with the high school was
+evident from the fact that they had had warning notices printed at
+the office of the _Weekly Courier_, notifying all boys who might
+contemplate playing any sort of practical joke during the holding of
+the carnival that Chief Adolph Wambold, the head of the local police,
+would have his entire force on the grounds, and such offenders would
+be harshly treated, if detected.
+
+The afternoon was well along when Hugh was approached by "Just"
+Smith, one of the candidates who meant to try for the Marathon prize.
+
+"Several of the boys are meaning to start off on that seven-mile
+spin, Hugh," the other announced as he came up; "and they want you to
+come along. We can start together, and then separate, as we feel
+disposed;" and, as this suited Hugh, he agreed.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER X
+
+WHEN MUSCLES COUNTED
+
+There were four of them who made the start, Hugh, "Just" Smith,
+Horatio Juggins, and "K. K.," the Kinkaid boy. Three of the bunch
+had been fielders in the baseball nine that carried off the
+championship pennant of the three-town high-school league the
+preceding summer; and, having been known as great runners, it was
+only natural that they had felt impelled to enter for the
+long-distance race.
+
+An equal number could be expected from both Allandale and Belleville,
+so that with others who would feel disposed to, at least, be in at
+the start, though calculating to fall out after a few miles had been
+run, possibly a full score would toe the string at the time the great
+Marathon was called.
+
+In an event of this nature a big "field" adds to the excitement of
+the occasion; and it is often noticed that those who have no
+intention of finishing usually look the most confident during the
+preparations for making the grand start. Well, they have no hope of
+getting any fun out of the race after losing sight of the crowd, and
+so they mean to take what they can beforehand.
+
+Talking is almost tabooed during such a race, since every breath lost
+in useless conversation saps so much energy. Even on a trial run Mr.
+Leonard had advised the boys to separate as soon as possible, and
+keep some distance apart, mostly to obviate this temptation to
+exchange views; so that each candidate could conserve every atom of
+his powers.
+
+So it came about that by the time two miles had been run Hugh found
+himself absolutely alone. Hugh had left the main thoroughfare, and
+was passing along a byroad that would take him around through the
+hilly country, until the Scranton turnpike was again reached.
+
+The other fellows had the option of doing as Hugh did, or they could
+continue on further, and, perhaps, get a lift back home on some
+farmer's wagon, or possibly a car bound for Scranton. Hugh had an
+idea, however, that one of them was coming along the same road a mile
+or more behind, and that it would turn out to be "Just" Smith. Some
+words the other chap had uttered when they were together before
+starting forth on the run gave Hugh this impression, though he could
+not be positive about it.
+
+At the time, it gave him little concern; but then he could not look
+into the immediate future, and see what it held for him. The coming
+of "Just" Smith would yet turn out to be an event of the first
+magnitude in Hugh's humble opinion; as the reader will soon learn.
+
+Hugh was jogging along nicely, and had long ago caught his second
+wind. He kept "tabs" upon himself, in order to know just how his
+energy held out, and if he was likely to be in condition for the
+gruelling finish that might become necessary, over the last half mile
+of the long course, should a visiting runner threaten to head the
+list with the goal in sight, and the thousands of eager spectators
+bursting out with cheers calculated to thrill the heart, and give
+fresh impetus to wearied limbs.
+
+On the whole, Hugh felt fairly well satisfied with himself. He knew
+he had gone about as fast as ordinary runners would care to travel,
+who wished to conserve their strength toward the close of the race;
+and that he was holding back a good reserve stock of energy. Yes, he
+believed he was at his best, and if he failed to land the prize it
+was because some fellow was a better runner than he could ever hope
+to be.
+
+Just then he heard a sound that gave him a sudden thrill. It was
+like a faint human cry for help, uttered in a weak voice, and seemed
+to come from his right.
+
+Hugh stopped short.
+
+His first inclination was to instantly dash from the road and
+endeavor to discover what caused that cry. Then he had a wave of
+suspicion dart over him. Could this be a sly trick on the part of
+some enemy, meant to lure him into the brush and rocks, where he
+could, perhaps, be overpowered? But Nick, as well as his two
+satellites, Leon Disney and Tip Slavin, had been on the grounds at
+the time Hugh started his run, for he had taken particular notice of
+this fact; consequently, it was hardly likely that they could be
+concerned in any practical joke; and certainly no other fellow would
+be guilty of such a thing.
+
+That decided Hugh. He left the road, and started toward the spot
+where he judged that strange sound had welled forth. The country was
+exceedingly rough just there, and he fancied that some sort of deep
+gully, possibly a precipice, might lie off on his right, judging from
+the aspect of the land.
+
+Not hearing the sound again, Hugh uttered a loud hello. Then, as he
+continued to press hastily forward, he once more caught the
+beseeching cry. It had an agonizing strain to it, and Hugh could
+plainly make out the words:
+
+"Help! Oh! help! help!"
+
+Someone was evidently in trouble, Hugh decided, accelerating his pace
+as well as the conditions of the rough surface of the ground
+permitted. He had taken pains to locate the cry this time, and was,
+therefore, altering his course just a little.
+
+Again he called, and once more received a reply, more fearful than
+before:
+
+"Hurry! Oh! hurry, before it gives way, and I'm lost!"
+
+It sounded more like the voice of a girl than anything else. Hugh
+was thrilled at the bare thought of one of the opposite sex being
+caught in a trap whereby life itself was imperiled.
+
+He had been ascending all this time. From a single look, which he
+cast over his shoulder, he could see the road he had lately come
+along, trace its course, in fact, until it was lost at a bend half a
+mile away.
+
+He noted that a runner had just turned that same bend, and was
+jogging along in a rhythmic, contented fashion, as though satisfied
+with the progress he was making; although "Just" Smith would have to
+speed up considerable on the morrow if he wished to be anywhere near
+the head of the procession when the race neared its close. Hugh,
+somehow, fixed the fact of his comrade's presence on his mind. He
+even mentally figured just how long it was likely to take the other
+to reach the spot where he himself had left the road; for, perhaps,
+that circumstance might loom up large in his calculations.
+
+Then he arrived at the brink of what seemed to be a precipice. The
+presence of this told Hugh plainly the nature of the task that
+awaited him. Someone had undoubtedly fallen over the brink, and was,
+even then, hanging on desperately to some jutting rock or bush that
+represented the only hope of safety from a serious fall. He threw
+himself down and thrust his head out over the edge. What Hugh saw
+was enough to give any boy a thrill of horror. Some ten feet below
+the top a human figure sprawled, kicking with his legs in the
+endeavor to find a brace for his feet. He was clinging to a bush
+that seemed to be growing from the face of the precipice, and which
+Hugh could see was slowly but surely giving way, one root after
+another losing its grip in the soil and rocky crevices.
+
+Hugh recognized the imperiled boy instantly, though utterly amazed at
+his discovery; he could not understand for the life of him how Claude
+Jardine, of all fellows in Scranton, could be placed in such a
+dreadful predicament.
+
+But Hugh did not waste a single precious second in trying to solve
+that puzzle; it could be all made plain after he had managed to save
+the poor chap.
+
+"Stop kicking, and keep perfectly still, Claude!" he instantly called.
+
+"But it's going to give way, and let me drop!" wailed the terrified
+boy.
+
+"It'll do that all the sooner if you keep moving as you are," Hugh
+told him sharply, with the tone of authority that one accustomed to
+command might use. "I'm coming down after you, so don't be afraid.
+Can you hold on just ten seconds more?"
+
+"I'll try to, but, oh! hurry, please!" came the trembling answer.
+
+Already Hugh was passing over the edge. He took care not to make a
+false movement, for the precipice was all of forty feet in depth, and
+a fall on the rocks below was bound to be a serious matter.
+
+To lower himself to where the imperiled boy clung he had to take
+advantage of numerous projecting points of rock that offered him a
+foothold, or a place where he could hang on with his hands. Hugh was
+as nimble as any boy in Scranton, which fact proved of great
+advantage to him just then. Had it been otherwise, he might have
+himself fallen, and there would then have been a double tragedy.
+
+Somehow, through Hugh's mind flashed the memory of how Claude's
+doting mother had always, on every occasion, condemned all athletic
+exercises that were intended to build up the muscles, and give new
+power to the body. It seemed the irony of fate that the life of her
+precious boy was now going to hang upon the ability of Hugh Morgan to
+sustain himself, and the weight of another, there upon the face of
+that rocky precipice! Perhaps in times to come Mrs. Jardine would
+discover how false her ideas were, and experience a radical change of
+heart. The opportunity which Hugh had once sighed for had come to
+him in a most wonderful way.
+
+He succeeded in making his way down in safety, though once he
+slipped, and had a thrill of alarm pass over him. Now he found
+himself alongside Claude. The boy's face was the color of ashes;
+Hugh had never looked upon a corpse in all his life, but he could not
+help comparing Claude's pallid countenance to one.
+
+He was glancing around with the eye of a general who lets nothing, no
+matter how trivial, escape him. Just a foot below Claude's dangling
+toes there was a narrow ledge. If only both of them could find
+lodgment upon this; and have some hold above for their hands, they
+might maintain their position until Hugh's shouts attracted "Just"
+Smith to the spot, and he could do something to aid them.
+
+"Listen, Claude," he said earnestly. "There's a way to save you, if
+only you keep your head about you. 'Just' Smith is coming along the
+road, and I'll shout out to guide him here so he can help us."
+
+"But--the bush is going to give way right off!" gasped the terrified
+boy.
+
+"Well, below us there's a ledge where we must plant our feet, and
+hold on," continued Hugh, convincingly. "I'm going to drop down to
+it now. Then you must try to lower yourself along the bush, inch by
+inch, until you feel the ledge under you. Don't be afraid, because I
+mean to grab hold of you; but when you feel me touching you, above
+all things don't let go above, or you'll throw us both down. Now, be
+ready, Claude; and, remember, it's going to be all right. Keep cool!"
+
+Of course, Hugh only said that last to reassure the poor chap.
+Claude was already cold with fear, as cold as an icicle, in fact; and
+quaking with fear in the bargain.
+
+It was easy enough for Hugh to drop down another foot or so, until he
+felt the solid little ledge under him. Indeed, had it been
+necessary, such an agile fellow very likely might have continued all
+the way down to the base of the precipice.
+
+His next move was to find a firm hold for his left hand, to which he
+could continue to cling while he sustained much of the weight of the
+other boy, after the weakened roots of the bush gave way entirely.
+
+Claude was trying to do what he had been told, though in rather a
+bungling fashion. Inch by inch he allowed the bush to slip through
+his hands, looking down as well as he was able at the same time, in
+order to ascertain just how near he might be to that same ledge Hugh
+had told him of.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XI
+
+THE CRISIS IN CLAUDE'S LIFE
+
+Hugh kept a watchful eye on that bush. He knew it was going to give
+way presently, when, unless Claude had managed to secure a fresh grip
+on some object with his poor scratched hands, he was likely to be
+dashed downward.
+
+Fortune was, however, kind in that respect, for there chanced to be a
+nice projection of rock, somewhat in the shape of a horn, just in the
+right place for Claude to seize upon, and which would help sustain
+his weight. Hugh knew very well, though, that most of the burden
+would fall upon him; and he, therefore, prepared to accept it.
+
+"Here, reach out with your left hand, Claude, and take hold of this
+rock. Your feet are both safely anchored on the ledge. Keep up your
+grit, and everything will be all right yet. Do you understand what
+I'm telling you, Claude?"
+
+"Yes, I do, Hugh," chattered the other, for his teeth were rattling
+together in a way that reminded Hugh of the "Bones" at the end of a
+minstrel line; if he had ever seen a Spanish stage performance he
+would have said they made a sound like castanets in the hands of the
+senorita who gave the national Castilian dance.
+
+Claude really managed to carry out that part of the task with a fair
+amount of success. His other hand still gripped the bush, which
+continued to gradually give way under the long and severe strain.
+
+Hugh braced himself. He had taken as firm a hold as was possible,
+and had his other arm thrown around Claude.
+
+"Steady, now, Claude, it's almost gone. When you feel it give way,
+try and make use of your right hand to find some other rocky point
+where you can hold on. I think there's one such on the other side of
+you. Above all, don't struggle, or you may throw me off my balance,
+and then it's good-bye to both of us. Now, be ready!"
+
+Hugh's calculations proved to be correct, for the bush gave way, and
+fell with a clatter of small stones and loosened earth, down toward
+the bottom of the steep declivity. Claude uttered a cry of dismay
+when he felt his support gone; but luckily he gripped the rocky knob
+with his left hand more convulsively than ever, while Hugh sustained
+him to the best of his ability.
+
+"That was well done, Claude," Hugh now told him, his main object
+being to put a little more confidence in the other boy, and thus
+lighten his own load. "We'll manage to cling here for a bit longer.
+When I think 'Just' Smith is getting near by I'll let out a whoop
+that is bound to fetch him to our assistance."
+
+One, two, three minutes passed. It was very trying to Hugh, and
+already his muscles began to feel the undue strain keenly. But he
+gritted his teeth, and waited, as it would be only a waste of breath
+and energy to shout before the next runner was close enough up to
+locate the sound.
+
+Claude was shivering as though he would shake to pieces. He had
+received a dreadful fright, for a fact, and it was having its due
+effect upon his never strong frame. What would his doting mamma
+think, and say, Hugh told himself, almost with a chuckle of
+amusement, could she see her darling then and there, and realize how
+his very life depended upon the strong muscles and will to do things
+that Hugh Morgan had developed in himself?
+
+How slowly the seconds passed! Hugh was trying to count, so as to
+judge when the Marathon runner would be likely to have covered that
+half-mile, and be at the spot where he, Hugh, had left the road.
+
+When, finally, the time had expired he again spoke to Claude.
+
+"Don't be startled, Claude, because I'm going to shout out. Hang
+tight, now!"
+
+With that he sent out a whoop, and coupled it with the name of "Just"
+Smith. There was no immediate response, but then Hugh had already
+discounted this in his mind, remembering how he also had come to a
+sudden stop, and listened as though unable to believe his ears.
+
+Again he shouted, and once more uttered the name of the other boy.
+This time there came a speedy reply.
+
+"Hello! that you, Hugh?"
+
+"Yes, and I want help right away!" answered the boy who clung there
+with a burden on his hands. "Turn out of the road to the left, and
+hurry here. I'm down a precipice, Just. Keep coming, and I'll guide
+you all right."
+
+So Hugh continued to utter loud shouts every dozen seconds or so. He
+could catch the calls of the advancing runner, and knew from their
+increasing loudness that he was gradually getting closer.
+
+Then, looking up, he saw a head projected over the brink above. He
+could easily understand how "Just" Smith's eyes must have almost
+started from their sockets when discovering the dreadful position of
+the pair below; and especially after he had recognized Claude
+Jardine, the last fellow in the wide world whom he would have
+expected to see in such a fix.
+
+"H-h-how in the wide world did you get down there, Hugh?" gasped the
+boy who leaned over the brink.
+
+"I came down after Claude here, who'd fallen over, and was hanging to
+a bush that was giving way," explained Hugh. "And now it's up to you
+to get us both out of this scrape, Just."
+
+"Oh, if only I had a rope!" cried the other, apparently nonplussed.
+
+"Well, wishes won't make one," said the practical Hugh; "and so we'll
+have to do without. But if you look around sharply I think you'll
+find a long pole there, for I remember noticing something of the
+kind."
+
+The boy above vanished for a brief period, which seemed ages to the
+anxious Claude; and even Hugh counted the seconds, for the strain was
+something serious. Then again that friendly head appeared in view.
+
+"You were right, Hugh!" called the Smith boy; "there was such a pole
+handy, and I've got the same right here now. It's plenty long enough
+to reach down to you; but I'm wondering however I'll be able to draw
+two of you up."
+
+"I don't expect you to, all by yourself, Just," Huge told him. "Poke
+the end of it down here, and keep a good stiff grip on the butt.
+Then we'll hold on, and find places to set our feet. Inch by inch,
+and foot by foot, we'll manage to climb up. You can help a little by
+keeping the stick coming, you know."
+
+"I get you, Hugh!" snapped the other eagerly; "and it's sure a right
+good scheme. But be mighty careful you don't slip, either of you.
+That fall'd break bones, even if it didn't kill you outright."
+
+"Don't worry about us, Just Smith; pay attention to your part of the
+contract, and things are bound to work out first-class. Lower away,
+and don't poke us off our perch, please. We've only got a risky hold
+below here."
+
+So saying, Hugh encouraged the other two to do their part manfully.
+Even Claude was shivering less than before, as though a breath of
+renewed confidence might have been installed in his heart by this
+close contact with such a stalwart chap as Hugh Morgan. It was going
+to be the turning point in Claude's career, of that Hugh felt
+positive. After this thrilling experience he was bound to awaken to
+the fact that he was not like other boys of his age; and demand of
+his mother that she permit him to participate in the life-giving
+outdoor sports that are a part and parcel of boy nature.
+
+They began to climb. It was slow work, but Hugh would not be
+hurried. Better that they waste time in gaining each foot than by an
+unwise step ruin all. What matter if that arm of his was almost numb
+with pain, and he had to press his teeth firmly together in order to
+continue to hold up Claude? If only the other had been a normal boy
+he could have helped himself wonderfully; but, as it was, he seemed
+as weak and helpless as a kitten that had never opened its eyes as
+yet.
+
+Well, half of the distance separating them from the top had been
+safely navigated, and so far no accident had occurred. Hugh kept
+encouraging his charge from time to time; and then speaking words
+also to the laboring, anxious boy above, directing him just how to
+proceed.
+
+Finally they reached the top. Hugh still ordered "Just" Smith to
+hold the pole as he had been doing. Then he managed to push Claude
+up so that he could crawl over the edge, which the other did in a
+speedy manner, bordering on the ludicrous.
+
+Then, to the surprise, as well as delight of Hugh, what did Claude do
+but turn and stretch out a helping hand, as though his first thought
+was to assist his rescuer to top the rise; indeed, Hugh's one arm was
+so utterly gone that he could hardly count on it for a single thing.
+Hugh would not be apt to forget this action on the part of the
+"sissy"; it proved what he had all along more than half suspected,
+that Claude really did have the making of a genuine boy in him, given
+half a chance for it to show itself, and the seed to germinate. And
+Hugh determined that he would make it his particular business to see
+that there came a change in Claude's dreary life. His mother could
+hardly refuse anything asked by the one to whom she owed the life of
+her son.
+
+Soon the trio lay upon the ground, breathing hard, and trying to talk
+at the same time. Both Hugh and "Just" Smith were consumed with
+curiosity to know how Claude happened to get into such a strange
+predicament, and he hastened to explain.
+
+After all, there was nothing so very singular about it. His mother
+had stopped in to see an old nurse, who had been in the family many
+years but was at the time lying sick at her sister's place.
+Something influenced Claude to get out of the big car to take a
+little stroll. Perhaps the sight of all those happy lads running and
+jumping and throwing weights had made him feel more than ever his own
+narrow, confined life, kept out of the society of all the other boys
+after school hours, and made to play the part of a "mollycoddle," as
+Roosevelt called all such fellows who have never learned how to take
+care of themselves when a bully threatens.
+
+Unused to the woods and hills, of course the first thing Claude did
+was to lose all sense of direction. He became alarmed, and that made
+matters worse than ever. So he had roamed about for almost a full
+hour, dreadfully tiring his poor feet and limbs, since he had never
+before in all his life walked so far and done such vigorous climbing.
+
+Then he had come to that precipice, and, thinking he might glimpse
+the cottage where the old nurse lived, somewhere down in the valley,
+he had incautiously crept too close to the brink, when his weight
+caused a portion of the soil to give way. Finding himself falling,
+Claude had clutched desperately around him, and, as it happened, his
+fingers gripped a friendly bush, to which he continued to cling even
+as he struggled to better his condition and shouted as best he was
+able.
+
+Hugh finished the story, to the edification of "Just" Smith, who
+admitted that if it had not been for the courage and muscular ability
+of Hugh the other boy must long ago have fallen to the bottom of the
+awful precipice. And Claude, shivering as he afterwards looked up at
+the forty feet and more of rocky wall, vowed he would never rest
+satisfied until he too had learned how to develop his muscles so that
+if ever again caught in a similar scrape he might have a fighting
+chance for his life.
+
+The two boys eventually found the cottage, although Mrs. Jardine and
+the car had gone down the road hoping to overtake Claude, though they
+were expected back again later; so, leaving Claude there, Hugh and
+"Just" Smith continued their seven-mile run.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XII
+
+STARTLING NEWS FROM THE JUGGINS BOY
+
+"Burr-r-r-r!"
+
+That was the telephone bell ringing.
+
+"Hugh, will you answer it, since the chances are the call is from
+some one of your numerous boy chums?" the voice of Mrs. Morgan came
+from the dining-room, where she was looking after the silver and
+china, after washing up the supper dishes, for they temporarily
+chanced to be without a hired-girl.
+
+Hugh guessed as much himself. He had already been called to the
+phone several times since arriving home after his seven-mile spin.
+Once it had been Claude's mother, begging him to be sure and call at
+her house early in the morning, because she wanted to have a good,
+long, earnest talk with him about Claude's future; and also to let
+him know how brimful of gratitude a mother's heart could be toward
+the brave boy who, at the risk of his own life, had saved her only
+child for her.
+
+Hugh had promised he would see her, although he expected to be very
+busy on the morning of the athletic tournament and then expressed the
+hope that Claude and herself would honor the tournament with their
+presence. This she hastily assured him she meant to do, because it
+was now borne in on her heart that she had been making a terrible
+mistake in reference to the way she was bringing up her darling
+Claude.
+
+Needless to say, Hugh had chuckled joyously after that little talk.
+He guessed he would have little trouble now in removing the scales
+Mrs. Jardine had allowed to cover her eyes with regard to the
+benefits to be derived by any boy, no matter how weak he might be,
+through a judicious system of athletic exercises, the same to be
+lengthened as he gradually grew more capable of standing fatigue.
+
+"Hello!" Hugh called.
+
+A voice he immediately recognized as that of Horatio Juggins greeted
+him. "That you, Hugh?"
+
+"Just who it is; what's the matter, Horatio? Feeling the effects of
+your little jog this afternoon? I hope not, for your sake,
+to-morrow."
+
+"Oh! come off, Hugh," the other quickly replied. "I'd be a fine
+candidate for a fifteen-mile Marathon race, wouldn't I, if seven
+miles knocked me out? I'm as fit right now as a fiddle. But Hugh,
+can you come right over here now? Something dreadful has happened."
+
+Hugh had a chilly feeling pass over him. It seemed as though some
+sort of bad news was coming. Had the great meet been called off, for
+some unknown reason or other? Somehow that struck him first as a
+dire possibility, since it would grievously disappoint thousands of
+eager boys and girls, not to mention many older folks with young
+hearts.
+
+Now Hugh had intended to take that evening quietly, resting after his
+strenuous afternoon, and absolutely refuse to allow Thad, or any
+other fellow, to coax him outside the door. But already this resolve
+began to weaken. That dim mention of some possible tragedy happening
+started him going.
+
+"Of course I can come over, Horatio," he told the boy at the other
+end of the wire; "and I'll do so right away on condition that it's no
+joke. Tell me what's up first."
+
+"Oh! I meant to do that, Hugh," his friend hastened to say, and Hugh
+could detect a tremor to the boyish voice that told of excitement.
+"You see, it's K. K."
+
+"What's happened to him?" demanded Hugh, his mind instantly
+suggesting all manner of terrible possibilities, from a sudden attack
+of sickness to an accident whereby his life might be in danger; for
+with boys these things sometimes happen as unexpectedly as a flash of
+lightning from a clear sky.
+
+"Why, he never came back again from that run this afternoon, Hugh!"
+Horatio was saying, in an awed tone now.
+
+"What's that you're telling me?" exclaimed the astonished Hugh. "I
+thought I saw K. K. with some of the other fellows when I was
+starting home just before dusk came on, though, of course, I may have
+been mistaken about it."
+
+"You were, Hugh, you certainly were," Horatio assured him in a
+softened tone. "His own mother ought to know, hadn't she? Well,
+she's over here at our house right now, crying her eyes out, and
+imagining all sorts of terrible things. You remember the Kinkaids
+live close by us; and she knew her boy was going to take the run this
+afternoon along with me, so she thought I could tell her if anything
+had happened to detain him. Why, she says K. K. never missed his
+supper before in all his life. It'd have to be something _fierce_ to
+keep him away from his best meal of the whole day."
+
+Hugh was thinking swiftly. He realized that this was no little
+matter to be dismissed as unimportant. Something certainly must have
+happened to detain K. K. for all this time. Several hours had
+elapsed since the other fellows reached the terminus of the long run
+at the athletic grounds. Why then had not K. K. shown up?
+
+"Keep the rest till I get there, Horatio!" he told the other.
+
+"Then you're sure coming, are you, Hugh?"
+
+"Right away," Hugh added.
+
+"Well, I'm glad, because you'll know what to do about it. And
+there's something else!"
+
+"Yes?"
+
+"I've got something to tell you that, say, I didn't have the heart to
+explain to K. K.'s mother, because she's bad enough frightened as it
+is; but it's looking particularly ugly to me, now that he hasn't come
+back. Oh! perhaps there is more'n a grain of truth in all those
+terrible stories those hayseeds tell about that place!"
+
+Hugh put up the receiver with a bang, made a dash for his cap,
+slipped on his sweater, for he knew the night air was cold, and then
+shot out of doors. Somehow those last few words of Horatio,
+breathing of mystery as they did, had excited his curiosity until it
+now reached fever-pitch.
+
+As he knew of several short-cuts across lots it took him but a few
+minutes to arrive at the Juggins home. Horatio was waiting at the
+door, and must have heard him running up the steps, for he instantly
+opened it to admit him.
+
+"Gee, but I'm glad you've come, Hugh!" was his greeting. "She's in
+there with mother, and taking on awful about it. It's a dreadful
+thing to see a woman cry, Hugh. And I'm afraid there may be a good
+reason for expecting the worst."
+
+"Tell me what you've got up your sleeve, Horatio," snapped Hugh, "and
+quit giving all these dark hints. You know something connected with
+K. K. that perhaps no one else does."
+
+"Guess I do, Hugh; for he confided in me, and told me not to say
+anything to the rest. Oh, how foolish it was for K. K. to think he
+could do that big job two days in succession; but he said he was
+feeling equal to nearly anything; and just had to make the try, since
+the notion had gripped him. But come on over to my den, Hugh, and
+I'll tell you all about it. Then you must decide what's best to be
+done; and say, I hope you can soothe Mrs. Kinkaid a bit in the
+bargain."
+
+Ten seconds later and the two boys found themselves ensconced in the
+room Horatio called his "den," although it was also his sleeping
+apartment. But he had fixed it as near like a boy's ideal of a
+lounging-place could be, the walls carrying the customary college
+pennants and a great variety of other things besides that gave them a
+rather crowded appearance. Evidently Horatio believed it added to
+the charm, for he never entered that "sanctum" without an involuntary
+smile of appreciation.
+
+Horatio closed the door softly after him. Hugh had also noticed how
+he did this just as carefully when admitting him to the front hall;
+and as though he expected that this must have aroused a certain
+amount of curiosity, Horatio hastened to explain.
+
+"You see, the poor woman is so excited, and in such a nervous
+condition, that she jumps up at the sound of a door closing, and
+starts to rush out into the hall, believing that Justin has got back
+home and hurried over to acquaint her with the joyous fact. Each
+time her disappointment leaves her worse than before. She will be
+needing Doctor Cadmus if this keeps on, as sure as anything."
+
+"Well, what is it you want to tell me, Horatio?" demanded Hugh, not
+even taking the trouble to drop down into the chair the owner of the
+"den" shoved toward him; for it seemed as though he must soon be on
+the jump--there was evidently something hanging over their heads,
+which would be needing prompt attention.
+
+"Why, it's just this, Hugh," began the other. "K. K. took a foolish
+notion he'd like to say he'd gone over the full course just for
+practice. And, Hugh. he told me he meant to make use of the
+short-cut that crosses the old haunted quarry!"
+
+Hugh started, and looked serious.
+
+"Then, if anything has happened to K. K., it must have been while he
+was crossing that mile tract between the two main roads," he went on
+to say, without hesitation. Horatio nodded his head eagerly.
+
+"I jumped to that same conclusion, Hugh, only I didn't dare mention
+it to Mrs. Kinkaid. I thought you ought to know first of all, and
+decide on the program. It's terrible just to think of it; and K. K.
+actually pretended to make light, too, of all those stories the
+farmers have been telling about that awful place."
+
+"Hold your horses, Horatio!" Hugh exclaimed. "When I said that I
+wasn't thinking of ghosts, or anything else unnatural. I meant that
+in all probability poor K. K. met with some ordinary accident while
+on that stretch, and has been unable to continue his run. He may
+have tripped on a vine he failed to see, and either broken his leg,
+or else sprained his ankle so badly that he can't even limp along.
+I've known such a thing to happen--in fact, once I got myself in the
+same pickle, and had to _crawl_ two miles to a house, every foot of
+the way on hands and knees, because the pain was frightful whenever I
+tried to stand up. Well, the chances are K. K. has had such a thing
+befall him."
+
+Horatio heaved a tremendous sigh, as though quite a weighty load had
+been taken off his chest.
+
+"You make me feel a heap better, Hugh, when you're so positive," he
+hastened to admit. "I was afraid it might be something even worse
+than a sprain; but never mind what I thought. The question now is,
+what ought we do about it?"
+
+"There's only one thing that can be done," Hugh told him in his
+customary straight-from-the-shoulder fashion, "which is for some of
+his chums to organize a searching party, get the old Kinkaid car out,
+and go up there to look over that abandoned road from one end to the
+other. We'll find K. K., or know the reason why."
+
+"That sounds good to me, Hugh!" declared Horatio, always ready to
+follow where a bold leader showed the way; "and perhaps we may have
+an opportunity to discover whether there _is_ any truth about those
+queer happenings the farmers keep telling of whenever the old quarry
+is mentioned in their presence."
+
+"We'll not bother our minds about fairy stories," Hugh assured him.
+"What we're meaning to do is to look for a practical explanation of
+K. K.'s holding out. And, mark my words, the chances are ten to one
+we'll find the poor chap groaning alongside that road somewhere. But
+let's get busy now, Horatio!"
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIII
+
+TO THE RESCUE OF K. K.
+
+Hugh would really have been better satisfied if he could have hurried
+away without seeing K. K.'s mother. He feared that she might delay
+progress more or less, and at such a time every minute counted.
+
+But at the same time he realized that the poor lady was in a dreadful
+state of mind. It was necessary then that he try and soothe her
+anxiety, for, as Horatio knew very well, Hugh Morgan had a way of
+making other people feel the utmost confidence in him.
+
+"Well, let's see K. K.'s mother, Horatio; but we mustn't waste much
+time. We'll have to get her permission to run the car. I only hope
+there's a decent supply of gas aboard, or in the garage."
+
+Accordingly, Horatio led him into another room, where they found Mrs.
+Kinkaid in a dreadfully nervous condition. She jumped to her feet on
+discovering that Horatio had another boy with him, and then upon
+seeing that it was not the one her heart was yearning after she
+uttered a pitiful wail, and fell back into her chair again.
+
+Hugh wasted no time, but commenced telling her something of what he
+had heard from Horatio, connected with K. K.'s foolish determination
+to take in the entire course as though in the race.
+
+"Of a certainty he's fallen and sprained an ankle somewhere along
+that cross-country road, Mrs. Kinkaid," he ended with. "We mean to
+gather a few of the fellows, and if you'll give us permission to use
+your big car we intend to run up there and look that road over from
+end to end. There is no doubt but what we'll find K. K. and fetch
+him back with us. So please try and feel that things will turn out
+all right. Make up your mind we won't come back without him, that's
+all there is to it."
+
+Somehow the very confidence shown in Hugh's words seemed to pass
+along to the almost distracted lady. Her eyes lighted up with
+renewed courage, and she even smiled, though wanly, it must be
+confessed. But then Hugh was pretty much of a magician in regard to
+arousing a feeling of hope in the most depressed mind.
+
+"You are a thousand times welcome to the car," she hurriedly assured
+him; "and anything else you might want. It is dreadfully unfortunate
+Mr. Kinkaid is away on one of his usual business trips to the west,
+or he would insist on going with you. But I feel certain, Hugh, you
+will manage things splendidly, and a mother's prayers will go after
+you, that you may not only find my boy, but that he may not have been
+seriously injured."
+
+"Then we'll not linger any longer, ma'am," said Hugh, eager to be on
+the move.
+
+Horatio wrapped himself up warmly, and the two of them shot out of
+the door.
+
+"Now, what first, Hugh?"
+
+Hugh seemed to have mapped out a plan of campaign in his mind, for he
+answered without hesitation.
+
+"We must pick up several of the fellows--Thad for one, then Owen
+Dugdale would be another good hand at hunting for a lost party; and,
+well, Julius Hobson for the third. That will make five in
+all,--enough to search the quarry road from end to end. Besides, we
+ought to carry several lanterns, because, while there is a moon, I
+reckon we'll find it far from light along that overgrown trail."
+
+"You just think of everything, Hugh," remarked Horatio, wonderingly.
+
+"Let's get the car, first of all," Hugh continued shrewdly, "because
+it can save us many steps in picking up the other fellows."
+
+By this time they were at the Kinkaid home. Horatio was well
+acquainted with the premises, as he had played with K. K. since they
+were small boys together. Hugh had been told where the key of the
+garage was hidden, and quickly discovered it hanging on a concealed
+nail.
+
+"Wait till I throw the switch, and light up," said Horatio, for they
+had electricity at the Kinkaid place, and, of course, a bulb lighted
+in the garage was considered much safer than a lantern.
+
+As soon as the illumination came both boys set about examining the
+big touring car that occupied the garage.
+
+"Bully!" ejaculated Horatio, after making the rounds with suspended
+breath; "all the tires are as hard as anything. How about the supply
+of gas, Hugh?" for his companion had occupied himself with making an
+examination of the tank.
+
+"Plenty to carry us up and back twice over!" cried the delighted
+Hugh. "This is what I call great luck. I was afraid there would be
+a tire that needed changing; or else no gasolene at all. K. K.
+didn't realize how kind he was to himself when he fitted up the old
+car so handsomely, for some purpose."
+
+"Oh!" chuckled Horatio, "mebbe I know why. You see, there's going to
+be another barn dance next Tuesday night up at Bailey's, and I think
+K. K. asked a girl to go with him and Peggy Noland and Owen Dugdale.
+Yes, he even told me there was still room for two more, if I could
+coax somebody to keep me company."
+
+Hugh busied himself in starting the car going. He knew considerable
+about mechanics, as most boys of the present generation do, since
+automobiles have become so very common. Running it out of the garage
+Hugh bade Horatio "hop aboard," which that worthy did without a
+second invitation.
+
+"Better get Thad first of all, I reckon," suggested Hugh, as though
+he might even have figured out how best to save themselves from any
+unnecessary delay; "then we can clip around to Julius Hobson's place,
+and pick up Owen last on our way out of town."
+
+The program suited Horatio first class. Indeed, he had such perfect
+confidence in Hugh that anything the other said carried conviction
+along with it. It is a fine thing for any boy to have aroused such a
+spirit of trust in the minds of his comrades that they look up to him
+as a sort of natural leader, and obey his slightest wish without
+hesitation. But Hugh bore his honors with humility, and never
+attempted to display the attributes of a czar.
+
+Great was the astonishment of Thad Stevens when he found two excited
+fellows demanding that he bundle up and go with them for a night ride
+up to the abandoned quarry that had gained such a bad reputation
+among the country folks residing roundabout.
+
+The story was partly told in rapid-fire style, enough of it, at
+least, to cause Thad to bounce into his heavy coat, and provide
+himself with a lantern. He expected to become better informed from
+time to time as they pushed along the road.
+
+Next came Julius Hobson. They found him at home also, and, of
+course, he was duly worked up on hearing how poor K. K. had never
+returned home from his run over the long course of fifteen miles.
+When he heard that they needed lanterns Julius produced a new
+electric flashlight which he had received for a birthday present, and
+Hugh said it would do very well as an additional means of
+illumination.
+
+Last of all they stopped at the home of Owen Dugdale, the dark-faced
+lad who lived with his grandfather in a big house, and about whom
+there had at one time been quite a little halo of mystery hanging.
+["The Chums of Scranton High on Deck."]
+
+Again was the main fact mentioned concerning the necessity for a
+searching party starting forth to find poor K. K. Owen did not have
+to be urged to join the bunch; indeed, he showed himself eager to
+accompany them.
+
+"I can fetch a lantern, if you want me to, Hugh," he observed; "and
+say, do you know I'm of a mind to carry my new shotgun that I had
+given to me just last month, when Grandfather concluded I was old
+enough to want to go hunting. If we have to chase all around through
+that place there's so many queer stories told about we might as well
+be fixed so as to protect ourselves."
+
+"Huh!" snorted Horatio Juggins, skeptically, "I've always heard that
+ghosts don't mind ordinary birdshot any more'n an alligator would.
+But then fetch it along, Owen; it'll no doubt make us feel a little
+better when we find ourselves up in that terribly lonely tract of
+country. And who knows but what there might be a stray wildcat
+abroad in those woods. Such things have been heard of, and I even
+saw the skin of a whopper shown in the market."
+
+So Owen carried out his design, and when he got aboard the big car he
+took with him not only a lantern, well filled with oil, but also his
+brand new twelve-gauge shotgun.
+
+At last they were off. Every fellow felt a peculiar sense of
+exhilaration that possibly even bordered on anticipation, take
+possession of him; for the future was there before them all unknown.
+Who could say what strange adventures might befall them before this
+undertaking was finished?
+
+Of course they had the headlights turned on at full force, and Hugh
+at the wheel found no difficulty in keeping the middle of the road.
+He did not mean to pursue a reckless pace, because, if they met with
+an accident it would spoil all their plans. Better to go at an
+ordinary rate of speed, and make haste slowly, so to speak.
+
+Meanwhile there was a clatter of tongues aboard the big car. Julius,
+Thad and Owen had dozens of pertinent questions ready to fire at
+Horatio, who was kept busy making illuminating replies. Thus the
+trio learned how K. K. had unwisely determined to cover the entire
+course and only whispered his intention to his chum, Horatio, at the
+same time binding him to silence, for fear lest Mr. Leonard put a
+damper on his plans by vetoing the scheme in the start.
+
+Then suggestions began to flow like water after a storm. All sorts
+of possibilities covering such a strange disappearance were advanced.
+Owen believed that Horatio was not far amiss when he declared there
+might be something in that ghost business, after all; and that poor
+K. K. had found it out to his cost; though, beyond this broad
+statement, Owen declined to commit himself, because he, of course,
+could not imagine what a genuine ghost would look like, in the
+daytime at that; or what such an apparition would be likely to do to
+a boy who had had the ill-luck to fall into its clutches.
+
+A dozen additional ideas were advanced, some of them bordering on the
+absurd and others really plausible. The unlimited resources of a
+boy's fertile mind in conjuring up remarkable explanations in a
+mysterious case like the one now engaging their attention had not yet
+been reached at the time Hugh suddenly announced they were close to
+the place where the abandoned quarry road started in from the
+thoroughfare they were then following.
+
+"We just passed the twin oaks I remember stood alongside the road on
+the left," he explained, at the same time slowing up considerably;
+"and they are close to the turning-in place. I noticed them in
+particular, you see, because I didn't want to lose even three seconds
+when on the run, in searching for some sign of the spot; though, of
+course, I could have looked for the marks of our tires left there at
+the time we came back from our nutting excursion, and went through to
+the other road. Yes, here we are right now, and I'm going to turn
+in, boys."
+
+He negotiated the turn without accident, though the branches of the
+trees did scrape against the sides of the car in a way that made some
+of the occupants shudder; for already they were beginning to feel a
+trace of the uneasiness that their gruesome surroundings were apt to
+arouse within their boyish hearts.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIV
+
+THE SEARCHING PARTY
+
+"Hugh, it looks like we mightn't need those lanterns after all,"
+remarked Horatio, after they had gotten well started along the dimly
+seen quarry road.
+
+Indeed, the brilliant headlights of the big car illuminated a radius
+of considerable size ahead of them and around. Every tiny twig was
+thrown out into bold relief, as though a powerful sun had found a way
+of forcing ingress through the canopy of leafless branches overhead.
+
+"Not just at present, perhaps," replied the driver at the wheel; "but
+they may come in handy yet. We'll wait and see."
+
+Owen sat beside Hugh, the other three occupying the tonneau of the
+car. There was abundance of room for all, and some to spare. Owen
+held his new shotgun in his hands and he kept a close watch upon the
+road ahead, just as though that idea connected with a ferocious
+wildcat might have taken hold on his mind, and he believed there was
+a possibility of such a thing coming to pass.
+
+Hugh drove with exceedingly great care, and made no attempt at speed.
+Indeed, such a thing was utterly out of the question, with that rough
+road to follow and the necessity of keeping a constant vigilant
+outlook, lest they collide with some tree. When the quarry was in
+full operation automobiles were an unknown luxury; and certainly no
+provision had ever been made for such a contraption passing along
+that crooked trail, with its numerous sharp curves intended to avoid
+natural obstacles. Three separate times already had Hugh brought the
+car to a full stop, and even caused the engine to cease its
+throbbing. This was done in order that all of them might strain
+their hearing, in hopes of catching some faint sound to tell that the
+missing boy whom they sought was close at hand.
+
+But only disappointment succeeded each attempt to pick up
+information. They caught the dismal hooting of an owl in some dead
+tree not far away, but certainly such a doleful sound did not raise
+their spirits materially. Several times while they were moving along
+Owen had seen a movement amidst the brush that gave him a little
+thrill; but the glimpses he obtained of the disappearing animal
+convinced him in one instance that it was a red fox that scurried off
+in alarm; while on the second occasion he rather imagined it was only
+a ring-tailed raccoon scuttling away and badly frightened by the
+intense white glow that had suddenly penetrated his dark quarters.
+
+If there was a wildcat within twenty miles the spot they certainly
+never knew of it, because no such beast of prey disclosed its
+presence to them while they continued on their way.
+
+But then there were plenty of thrills for the boys. Not only did the
+weird hooting of that horned owl come to make their flesh creep, but
+now and again they detected strange sounds that may have been caused
+by limbs of the trees rubbing together in the night breeze, but which
+had a wonderful resemblance to human groans.
+
+They had been pursuing their way along for some little time without
+much attempt at conversation; but it is pretty hard for a parcel of
+boys to remain long silent, no matter what the provocation. And
+Horatio, for one, felt urged to free his mind of certain fancies that
+had taken lodging there.
+
+"I say, fellows, doesn't this beat everything you ever saw all
+hollow?" he went on to say, for there was really no need of their
+keeping quiet, since they had not started out to steal a march upon
+any enemy,--only to find poor lost K. K. "Just listen to that awful
+groaning sound, will you? If I didn't know it was caused by the
+limbs of trees sawing across each other in the wind I'd think
+somebody was almost dying."
+
+"At another time I guess we wouldn't bother our heads about such a
+silly thing," observed Julius Hobson; "but, of course, our minds are
+full up with what may have happened to our comrade, and all that
+noise makes us shiver a heap; it's so suggestive, so to speak."
+
+"Oh! what did you think you saw then, Owen?" gasped Horatio, as,
+chancing to fix his gaze on the other, he noticed him suddenly
+elevate his gun, as though tempted to shoot the same.
+
+Owen chuckled.
+
+"It was only a frisky rabbit, after all," he announced calmly enough.
+"I was just covering him to find out how easy I could nail the
+rascal, if only I was out hunting game instead of a lost boy. And
+we'd have had rabbit stew at the Dugdale home to-morrow, let me tell
+you, Horatio, if I'd cared to let fly, for I had him covered
+handsomely."
+
+"Well, please don't do it in a hurry again, Owen," asked Horatio,
+settling back once more, and hoping his throbbing heart might not
+beat so loudly that any of his comrades could hear it pounding
+against his ribs. "Remember this is no ordinary patch of woods we're
+in right now. All sorts of stories have been told concerning the
+country up here; and in passing through after nightfall we're doing
+what a big bribe couldn't tempt any farmer's help to try. But, Hugh,
+don't you think we must be getting pretty near that place by this
+time?"
+
+"Just about two-thirds of the way, Horatio," he was informed. "That
+leaning tree we passed is exactly three hundred and thirty-seven
+paces from the place we left the road."
+
+"Well, what do you think of that for looking ahead, fellows!"
+ejaculated Horatio. "Hugh here took all the trouble to count the
+steps while passing through, the day he came up to examine the
+ground. That's what I call preparedness, and I guess it counts in a
+race, just as much as in getting ready for war."
+
+Hugh laughed as though momentarily amused.
+
+"Well, they're both in the same category, Horatio, if you look at
+things from the right point of view; rival armies and rival athletes
+contending for the prize which in both cases would mean victory.
+Looking ahead is a useful hobby, and it's served me handsomely on
+many an occasion. I consider no time wasted that is employed to
+insure success; even if you never need the information you've picked
+up it adds to your stock of knowledge; and no fellow can have too big
+a fund of that."
+
+"Then we ought soon to be getting there, at this rate," continued
+Horatio. "Let's hope nothing happens to our old car. We'd have a
+jolly walk back to town if we broke down here and couldn't fix
+things. I'd prefer making a fire and spending the night in the woods
+to taking such a tramp, which would debar us from all hope of making
+that big run to-morrow."
+
+"With K. K. out of the game the chances for Scranton High begin to
+flicker some," admitted Julius. "He was showing unusual stamina
+right now, and secretly I was backing K. K. to bring home the bacon
+for our school. Of course, with Hugh and Horatio and 'Just' Smith
+still in the ring it isn't hopeless by any means; but they do say
+those Allandale chaps have unearthed several wonders at long-distance
+running, and they are dying to knock Scranton down this time."
+
+Again Hugh stopped the car and bade the others listen.
+
+"It isn't that I thought I heard anything suspicious, fellows," he
+went on to explain, when they manifested a certain amount of
+excitement; "but, on general principles, I think we ought to stop
+oftener, and find out if there's anything doing."
+
+After testing their combined hearing to the limit, and without any
+success, Hugh again started up. It was Thad who spoke next, and
+apparently he had been considering something that he would like to
+have made clear.
+
+"What if we pass all the way through to the other road, without
+learning a single thing, Hugh?" he went on to say; "do you mean to
+give it up, and head for home then and there?"
+
+"Well, I should hope not, Thad!" burst out Horatio; "we're none of us
+built that way. Because a fellow gets a single knock-down in a fight
+ought he to throw up the sponge right away, and own himself beaten?
+Why, we started out to find K. K., and sleep isn't going to visit my
+eyes this night until we succeed. That's the way I look at it, and I
+reckon the rest of you are in the same boat."
+
+"If such a thing should happen, Thad," said Hugh, sturdily, "we'll
+simply turn around and come back again; only, under the new
+conditions, some of you will have to turn out with the lanterns, and
+search alongside the road as we go slowly along."
+
+Horatio gave a gasp that was plainly audible.
+
+"Do you really mean, Hugh," he went on to ask, in a voice that
+trembled more or less despite Horatio's effort to control the same,
+"that you half expect to find K. K. lying alongside the road, either
+dead, or else insensible from the pain of his broken leg?"
+
+"Well, I wasn't just thinking things would be as bad as all that,"
+Hugh hastened to say. "What I had in mind was the chance of coming
+on his footprints, and then trying to follow the same. We could
+easily tell them, for K. K. had on his running shoes, you remember.
+By tracking him, step by step, don't you see, we could tell just
+where he met with his trouble, even find out, perhaps, the nature of
+his accident, and continue to follow him up."
+
+"That would suit me first rate," said Julius, promptly; "and my fine
+electric hand-torch might come into play with a vengeance. There's
+nothing better going for following a trail in the dark, because the
+light is focussed, you see, on a small compass. Why, you can pick up
+night-walkers like everything when the fishing season's on, by using
+a flashlight. I could even find a needle in a haystack, I believe,
+with one of these jim-dandy contraptions."
+
+"All right, Julius, we'll appoint you head tracker, then," chuckled
+Horatio. "But, after all, perhaps we'll run across our comrade yet,
+before we get out of this tangle. We're about to come to the most
+critical point of the entire trip, remember, for the old quarry is
+just ahead of us."
+
+Horatio chanced to be on the side of the car toward the quarry. He
+was not spending nearly so much time now looking ahead, leaving that
+task to his chums; even while talking he kept his eyes fixed upon the
+dark expanse that represented the surrounding woods, anticipating
+catching a glimpse of something, he hardly knew what, at any moment
+now. Doubtless all those silly yarns retailed by the ignorant
+gossiping farm-hands in the market-place in Scranton, while they
+tried to outdo one another in matching fairy stories, must have been
+circulating through Horatio's brain just then. The heavy atmosphere
+of the deserted stone quarry, and its lonely surroundings, added to
+the mysterious disappearance of K. K., combined to make him
+peculiarly susceptible to such influences as see ghosts in every
+white object that moves in the darkness.
+
+This being the case with the Juggins boy it was not to be wondered at
+that there could be traced a vein of actual gratification in his
+voice when he suddenly electrified his companions by exclaiming:
+
+"Hugh! fellows, I tell you I saw it right then, just as that Swanson
+farmhand vowed to me he did once on a time this last summer--it was a
+light, waved up and down, back and forth, and just like they teach
+you when you join the Signal Corps, and learn how to wigwag with a
+flag or a lantern. It came from right over yonder, where we all know
+the old quarry lies! And I'm not fooling, either; cross my heart if
+I am!"
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XV
+
+PROWLING AROUND THE QUARRY
+
+Everybody was staring hard by the time Horatio finished. Hugh, of
+course, had immediately stopped the car on the road, so that they
+were now stationary.
+
+It chanced that the spot was one of few where a glimpse of the quarry
+could be picked up, as the boys had discovered at the time they
+passed along this way, when we overtook them on their nutting trip.
+
+Seconds crept past.
+
+Each boy could measure time by the beating of his wildly accelerated
+heart, and as these were throbbing at the rate of something like a
+hundred pulsations per minute it can be easily understood that
+"things were going some," to quote Horatio, when afterwards telling
+the story.
+
+Then all of them saw what the first discoverer had attempted to
+describe. They stared as though fascinated. Truly Horatio had said
+well when he spoke of the odd movements of the mysterious light; for
+it moved swiftly up and down, then sideways, and in eccentric
+circles, after which it vanished as suddenly as it had come into
+being.
+
+Some of the boys sighed, as though being wakened from a dream.
+Horatio, of course, was full of deepest gratification, since he had
+detected a skeptical air in the actions of Thad and Owen, which
+seemed to place him in the light of one who "saw things where none
+existed."
+
+"There, didn't I tell you?" he exclaimed, triumphantly. "And, say,
+wasn't that--eh, party, whoever he might be, making some sort of
+telegraphic signals with his old lantern or torch?"
+
+"Hugh, what do you think?" demanded Thad. "You're up in all that
+kind of wigwag signal work, and perhaps now you could tell what it
+means."
+
+"I lost some of it, I'm sorry to say, fellows," observed Hugh,
+gravely; "but all the same I caught enough to tell me that waving of
+a light was meant as a signal message, though who sent it, and to
+whom, is all a mystery."
+
+"But could you make out enough of the message, Hugh, to give you any
+idea what it stood for?" persisted Thad.
+
+"Yes, I believe I did," the other admitted, solemnly, so that each of
+his chums bent closer to catch the next words that fell from his
+lips. "I'm certain it spelled out the word 'help,' for one; and I
+thought another was 'quick'!"
+
+"Oh! what do you think of that?" gasped Horatio.
+
+"The mystery deepens," added Owen, dramatically, just as he had
+probably been accustomed to reading in some story of excitement.
+
+"Of course," continued Hugh, immediately, "we've got to take a look
+around that same old quarry, and see what's going on. Somebody's
+holding the fort there, even if it is said to be deserted. Who and
+what he can be, of course, remains to be seen; but I'm not taking a
+bit of stock in those old wives' yarns about a ghost, remember,
+Horatio."
+
+"Then we'll have to leave the car on the road, won't we, Hugh, when
+we tackle this big job?" questioned Owen.
+
+"Of course; and since I marked the best spot where anyone could make
+their way along to the face of the quarry, we must start up again,
+and keep moving till we strike that place."
+
+"But, Hugh, do you think the--er--party making those signals with a
+light could have noticed our illumination, and that message was meant
+for us?" Horatio went on to ask, solicitously.
+
+"I'm not prepared to say," he was told, "though I don't see how
+anybody with eyes could miss discovering us coming along. And,
+besides, the old car makes plenty of noise in the bargain, to attract
+attention. So it looks as if he did know, and was trying to talk to
+us."
+
+All this only added to the thrill that was forever passing through
+each and every member of the night expedition. It would be
+manifestly impossible to describe their mixed feelings as they
+advanced slowly along the rough road so long abandoned to nature. A
+dozen times Horatio believed he heard cries; why, it seemed as though
+the air must be filled with uncanny sounds, for his lively
+imagination was working at race-horse speed just then.
+
+The car stopped short.
+
+"Wow! what's happened now, Hugh?" whispered Horatio.
+
+"We've arrived at the getting-out place, that's all," came the steady
+reply, as the chauffeur caused the engine to cease working and then
+proceeded to leave his seat, after his companion had jumped out.
+
+The lanterns were now lighted and the electric torch made ready for
+use. If hands trembled considerably during this operation, causing
+several matches to be used before the desired results were obtained,
+could anyone blame Owen and the other possessor of a lantern? It was
+a most remarkable thing that no one evinced the slightest disposition
+to stay by the car, and guard it against thieves. It was a case of
+"follow the leader," and where Hugh went they were all bound to go
+also. To be honest, the chances were that Horatio, for one, could
+not have been coaxed to separate himself from the company of his four
+chums; because there was a great deal of truth in that old maxim, "in
+union there is strength."
+
+Hugh now led the way. He had been given one of the lanterns with
+which to light a passage across the heaps of broken stones, earth,
+and rubbish, cast there at the time in the remote past when the
+quarry was in full blast, with workmen delving into the hillside,
+blasting away sections through the use of dynamite or powder, and
+sending out many wagon-loads of building-stone each of the six
+working days of the week.
+
+They did not string out in single file, but kept bunched together.
+Indeed, this came through no accident, but there was a method in
+their madness; because, you see, no fellow would want to be the
+hindmost in the file.
+
+Hugh showed a wonderful amount of knowledge of the place, considering
+that he had never before in his life placed a foot upon the ground
+and had to depend entirely on his former observations. But he kept
+on as straight as could be expected, and presently Owen managed to
+muster up courage enough to say in a low and most carefully guarded
+tone:
+
+"Hugh, did you take note of the _exact_ spot where the light showed
+up? I'm asking because you seem to be heading direct for somewhere."
+
+"I believe I know where it was," Hugh told him simply. "You see, I
+noted several things about the face of the quarry that day we stopped
+to look it over; and when I saw that dancing trail of fire I figured
+out that it must be at just such a place, which spot I'm heading for
+right now. And just as you spoke I had ample proof that I was right
+in my guess."
+
+"Why, what happened, Hugh?" demanded Horatio eagerly.
+
+"I caught a faint glimpse of light up there," Hugh told him. "I
+wonder none of the rest of you happened to notice the same. It made
+me think that some person might be in one of those holes we saw in
+the face of the wall--caves, the natives call them, Horatio says. As
+this was somewhat deep only a tiny bit of illumination escaped, and
+you could just detect that when at a certain angle. Stop short, now,
+and see for yourselves, for there it is again!"
+
+Thrilled to the bone they stood and gaped. Hugh was pointing with
+his disengaged hand, half holding the lantern back of him so that its
+glow might not further interfere with their view.
+
+"You're right, Hugh; that's surely what it is," agreed Thad, almost
+immediately; and each of the other three went on record with a
+corresponding affirmative.
+
+"Then the next thing for us to do is to find some way of climbing up
+to that same fissure," the leader explained, showing that he meant to
+lose no time in trying to open negotiations with the unknown denizens
+of the quarry, whose actions were becoming more and more mysterious
+as time passed.
+
+"Which means that we're going to beard the tiger in his den," quoth
+Owen, gripping his gun more firmly as he edged a little closer to
+Hugh; for since he was the only member of the expedition who could be
+said to possess a weapon it was proper that he should be found in the
+van at such a crisis.
+
+They walked on, not hastily, and showing no outward sign of the
+tumult that must have raged in each boyish heart. Now it was no
+longer possible for them to discern that faint glow; but such a
+little thing did not daunt them. Hugh had marked well the exact
+location of their objective point, and Hugh seldom made mistakes,
+those other confident fellows were telling themselves as they
+cheerfully trudged along.
+
+The foot of the cliff was at hand. Rains and winds and snow
+avalanches had, during the years that had passed since the hands of
+men worked those diggings, served to cut loose great quantities of
+debris from the face of the height, so that here and there at the
+foot irregular pyramids of earth and rocks could be seen. Hugh now
+seemed to have turned his attention from above and was bending half
+over, as though examining the ground. Owen knew what this meant.
+The other anticipated finding a track leading directly to the route
+by means of which that cavern halfway up the cliff might be easiest
+attained.
+
+And, as often happens, such reasoning proved to be the wisest thing
+the searchers could have undertaken, for hardly had half a minute
+elapsed than Hugh was heard to give vent to a low ejaculation of
+gratification.
+
+No one spoke, but they understood that he had found the trail he was
+looking for. Indeed, he at once started to move along, still bending
+over, and holding his lighted lantern low, so that its none too good
+illumination would best serve him.
+
+Now they reached a sort of strange little gully, where the silt had
+washed down more heavily during the period of erosion than at any
+other place. Looking up, the boys could see that it afforded a steep
+but accessible avenue by means of which an agile person could ascend
+the otherwise impregnable height towering above their heads.
+
+Hugh halted not, but started up. Owen came close behind him, holding
+that formidable shotgun so that he could thrust it ahead of his
+leader should an occasion arise necessitating action. But Hugh had
+already warned him not to be rash, and under no condition to dream of
+firing until he himself had given the order.
+
+It was a queer little procession that crept up that steep trail in
+the gully formed by Nature during the heavy storms of summer and
+winter. The twin lanterns glimmered and flickered as the night wind
+puffed the tiny blazes; and ahead of all lay the white glow of the
+electric hand-torch, showing them how they were now almost at the end
+of their trail.
+
+Yes, the fissure extended straight into the face of the cliff. Hugh
+was taking them directly to the place where undoubtedly the
+mysterious unknown had stood on a sort of rocky platform, and
+indulged in all those queer telegraphic code motions with a light of
+some sort.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVI
+
+A FRIENDLY GHOST
+
+Hugh led the way straight into the fissure. As they proceeded they
+could see the light ahead growing stronger. Low sounds, as of
+voices, also led them onward; and then, upon turning a bend, they
+came upon a sight that had them all staring with wonder.
+
+It was indeed a cave, and of considerable dimensions. A wild beast
+would have delighted in such a den in which to hide from the rigors
+of winter, but to boys accustomed to the luxuries of home life it
+would doubtless have few attractions, especially after the novelty of
+camping-out had worn off in a week's time.
+
+It was a fire that burned which gave the light. A pile of dry wood,
+mostly broken branches of dead trees, showed that the occupant of the
+cave had laid in a supply against a rainy day.
+
+There, sitting with his back against the wall, was their missing
+comrade K. K. His face looked unusually white, and bore an
+expression of acute pain, which, however, he manfully tried from time
+to time to dismiss by a ghastly grin, altogether assumed, since he
+certainly was in no mood for laughing.
+
+They could see that his left leg was bandaged in some manner, as
+though he might have broken the bones, and someone had tried to bind
+up the limb. Even with that superficial glance Hugh marked the fact
+that this had been done in a fashion indicating considerable previous
+experience along such lines.
+
+And then they turned their attention upon the other party, the
+mysterious one who doubtless had found poor K. K. helpless on the
+ground and borne him to this cavern in the quarry. He was indeed a
+wild-looking party, with long, unkempt hair and a sunburnt face in
+which his glowing eyes were deep-seated. There was that about him to
+convince Hugh instantly he must be deranged, although just then the
+man bent over poor K. K. solicitously, and seemed to be tenderly
+doing something calculated to ease his pain.
+
+Hugh coughed, meaning to draw attention to the fact of their arrival.
+The man immediately stood up and bent a searching look upon the five
+lads. Perhaps he had been hearing K. K. tell how some of his chums
+would certainly be coming to search for him, and, therefore, even
+though he might wish to remain in his hidden retreat undisturbed, he
+manifested no hostility toward them, simply folded his arms and,
+stepping back, watched their approach.
+
+Hugh made gestures to indicate that they were peacefully disposed.
+In doing so he purposely used the signal code and spelled out the one
+word, "friend." He saw the wildman's thin face take on a sudden
+gleam of awakened interest, and he nodded his head in the
+affirmative, as if to reassure Hugh that they were not unwelcome.
+From this the boy knew the stranger must at some time have been in
+the army, and that even while his brain was resting under a cloud he
+could still send and receive messages such as had been at one time
+his daily avocation.
+
+They reached the side of their unfortunate companion. He held out a
+hand to welcome Hugh.
+
+"Oh! I'm mighty glad you've come, fellows, I can tell you," he told
+them, with a tremor in his voice. "I've had a rotten time of it all
+around, and suffered terribly. You see, I made a fool of myself, and
+tripped over a vine, so that I was thrown into a gully, with my left
+leg under me. Snapped both bones, he says, just above the ankle, and
+a fine time I've got ahead of me this winter, with no skating,
+hockey, or anything worth living for. But then it might have been
+worse, because my neck is worth more to me than my ankle. But now I
+do hope you can get me home. I never wanted to see home and mother
+one-half as much as now."
+
+"Yes, we've come in the big car, K. K.," Hugh assured him. "And
+we'll fetch you home right away. You ought to be looked after by
+Doctor Wambold; broken bones are not things to be trifled with, and
+while this party seems to have done the best he could it can only be
+a makeshift."
+
+"Don't you believe it, Hugh," said the injured boy warmly; "why, he's
+a regular jim-dandy about such jobs. I bet you he used to be an army
+surgeon in his younger days, from hints he's let drop. And then he
+knows the Signal Corps work right off the handle to boot, even
+if--well, I won't say what I meant to. He's been so kind and
+considerate to me; my own father couldn't have been more tender.
+I've guessed the secret of the old haunted quarry, Hugh!" which last
+he almost whispered in the other's ear.
+
+"Yes, I can say the same," muttered Hugh, "because, as soon as I saw
+that he was using the regular army code of signals, I remembered
+about hearing how a certain family over near Hackensack had an uncle
+who used to be in the Signal Corps and was also later on an army
+surgeon, but who had suffered a sunstroke, and, well, was said to be
+a bit queer."
+
+"Yes," whispered K. K., "this is the same party. His name, I
+remember, was Dr. Coursens, and there was some talk last summer about
+his having got loose from the house and being drowned, they believed,
+in the river, though his body was never found. Just to think of it,
+he's been hiding here ever since, picking up his living almost like a
+wild animal. Why, right now his clothes are nearly falling off his
+back, and if he tries to hang out here much longer he'll be frozen to
+death. But, Hugh, we must let his folks know where he is so they can
+come after him. I believe, his mind is beginning to get a little
+clear again, for at times he talks quite reasonably."
+
+This was all mighty interesting to Hugh, and he determined that he
+would let no grass grow under his feet until he had seen to it that
+the man with the deranged mind was once more restored to his family.
+But the first thing to be done was to get poor K. K. safely back home.
+
+So he turned to the man and spoke to him, telling him that they
+wished to get their comrade to the car, and at the same time thanking
+him warmly for all he had done. Not a single word in reply did Hugh
+receive. The man listened and nodded his head, as though he could
+dimly understand what the boy was saying. Evidently he was in
+something of a dazed condition, if, as K. K. affirmed, his senses
+were beginning to assume a normal condition after years of darkness.
+
+It was a terrible job getting K. K. down from that elevated place.
+The man showed them how best to manage. He seemed really solicitous,
+and it could be seen that he had taken quite a liking to K. K. during
+their brief intercourse, since the latter had been found groaning on
+the ground.
+
+Eventually the level below the cliff was attained. Poor K. K. had
+groaned many times, hard though he fought to repress the sounds, for
+it was unavoidable that he should receive many jostlings while being
+transferred to the lower level.
+
+Then they made their way across the open space, and finally arrived
+at the waiting car, in which the injured youth was deposited and made
+as comfortable as the conditions allowed. The deranged man watched
+all this with a wistful gleam in his eye. He had fled from his kind
+while still gripped in the darkness of madness, but with the first
+glimmer of reason being seated once more on its throne he commenced
+to yearn after human fellowship again.
+
+Since the boys had all taken such a deep-seated interest in the
+matter it may be proper before the "ghost" of the haunted quarry is
+dropped altogether from the story to state that the very next morning
+Hugh went over to Hackensack and electrified the Coursen family with
+certain remarkable news he brought. It ended in their all starting
+forth and arriving at the quarry. They found the demented man
+awaiting their coming as though he had guessed what Hugh had in his
+mind. More than that he greeted them soberly, and called each member
+of the family by name, something he had not been able to do since
+that dark cloud descended upon his mind years back.
+
+There seemed reason to believe that in due time Doctor Coursen might
+regain his full senses again and spend a few years more with his
+delighted relatives before the end came.
+
+Hugh, of course, learned all about him and how he had served years in
+the army, first as a sergeant in the Signal Corps, and later on
+becoming a surgeon of considerable reputation before the accident in
+the tropics deprived him of his reason. Perhaps it had been the
+utterly helpless condition of poor K. K., when he came accidentally
+upon the injured boy, that had strongly appealed to the surgical
+spirit that still lay dormant in the brain and fingers of the insane
+man and which had been the main cause of the light of reason
+returning--surgery had been his passion, and the familiar work took
+him back to other days, apparently.
+
+And that very night, when Doctor Cadmus, hastily summoned to the home
+of Mrs. Kinkaid, examined the work of the deranged dweller of the
+quarry cave, he had pronounced it simply marvelous the clever way in
+which the other had set those bones and put a splint on the leg, with
+such clumsy means for working at hand. He declared he meant to
+interest himself deeply in the case and see if such a skillful
+surgeon might not be restored to the world so much in need of his
+kind, with the terrible war raging on the other side of the Atlantic.
+
+To conclude with this subject, at last accounts Dr. Coursen had so
+far recovered as to send in his application for a berth in some
+hospital over in France, where his wonderful knowledge of surgery
+might prove useful to the countless wounded men at the front. And
+doubtless ere this reaches the eye of the reader he may be across the
+Atlantic, serving humanity in the great cause.
+
+Long would those five lads remember that strange expedition up to the
+haunted quarry, and what a remarkable discovery they made after
+arriving on the ground. It may be that Horatio, yes, and Julius
+also, would be less apt to clothe anything along a mysterious nature
+with ghostly attributes, after learning how common-sense and
+investigation will, in nearly all cases, turn suspicion into
+ridicule. But while the country folks, of course, also learned how
+the phantom of the quarry had turned out to be just a crazy man who
+had escaped from his confinement at home and gone back to primeval
+ways of living, few of them would ever muster up the courage to visit
+the deserted quarry after nightfall. It had too many thrilling
+associations to please them; and besides, what was the use of going
+out of their way just to feel the "goose-flesh" creep over their
+bodies when an owl hooted, or some little forest animal gave a grunt?
+
+K. K., being young and healthy, and attended carefully by good old
+Doctor Cadmus, was not confined to the house for many weeks. The
+bones did not require resetting, and rapidly knitted, so that after a
+while he could walk to and from school with the aid of a crutch; and
+later this, in turn, gave way to a cane. When February came he even
+threw this aid aside, and by March was seen taking his part in school
+rushes, as though he had never been injured at all. But his skates
+were never once used all winter, nor could he indulge in any
+sledding, both of which were favorite pleasures with K. K.
+
+On the whole, however, he felt that he had much to be thankful for;
+and tried not to be too greatly disappointed. But his chums would
+miss him when the Marathon race was on; because he had been accounted
+one of the best long-distance runners without exception that Scranton
+High could boast.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVII
+
+SCRANTON'S "OPEN-HOUSE" DAY
+
+Saturday opened with a promise of fair weather, and thousands of
+anxious hearts beat high with satisfaction when this important fact
+became manifest.
+
+Before the morning was half over many strangers were noticed in town,
+having taken the day off in order to attend the wonderful meet, of
+which so much had been said. Every boy in Scranton was wild-eyed,
+and on the run most of the time, trying to be here, there, and in
+half a dozen places at once, if such a thing were possible.
+
+Indeed, there was so much going on it reminded some people of the
+famous circus that visited the town two years back, with three
+separate rings, and something taking place in each at the same time;
+so that the spectators hardly knew how to take it all in and keep
+from being cross-eyed.
+
+Out at the athletic grounds there were crowds gathered. Men were
+working at the fence, while another gang, under the orders of Mr.
+Leonard, carefully put in place such paraphernalia as would be needed
+in carrying out the programme. Even the big pole had been well
+greased for the climbing match; while the hurdles for the obstacle
+race were ready to be placed in position at the proper time; and a
+thousand and one other matters engaged the attention of the physical
+director, who was probably the most industrious man in seven counties
+that Saturday A.M.
+
+Nor was that all. Some of the would-be contestants, not wholly
+satisfied with their record for proficiency, and wishing to key
+themselves up to top-notch speed against the now near hour of trial,
+were on the ground, and in their working togs. Here a bunch galloped
+swiftly around the cinder path, with one of their number holding the
+watch on them to ascertain what time they made. Further along
+several other fellows were jumping with might and main, and showing
+either jubilation or deep chagrin as they found themselves able to do
+a shade better than ever before, or else going backward in their
+scoring.
+
+Indeed, that was going to be a red-letter day in the lives of all
+Scranton's young people. They begrudged the passing minutes, because
+their period of enjoyment would be shortened just so much with the
+loss of every sixty seconds.
+
+When Hugh came on the grounds, after his trip to Hackensack, and
+seeing the hermit of the quarry once more safely lodged in the bosom
+of his delighted family, he had only one regret. This was the fact
+that poor K. K., whose heart had been so set on carrying the colors
+of Scranton High to victory in the Marathon race, should be debarred
+from participating in the same by a cruel fate.
+
+As for himself Hugh was not quite so certain as before that he could
+accomplish such a thing as getting over those fifteen miles ahead of
+all competitors. What he had gone through with on the preceding day,
+coupled with his night journey, and only partial rest, after getting
+in bed at a late hour, had sapped some of his energy.
+
+But Hugh's grit and determination were just as strong as ever, and he
+meant to do his level best. If he fell down, why, there were "Just"
+Smith, and Horatio Juggins, as well as two other Scranton fellows,
+any one of whom might be the winner. So long as the prize fell to a
+Scranton High boy, it mattered little who carried off the honors,
+Hugh felt.
+
+Noon came at last.
+
+Everything was now ready for the opening of the athletic tournament.
+Chief Wambold kept watch and ward over the grounds, assisted by his
+entire force of uniformed men. He evidently did not intend that any
+boy, with a mind that turned to practical joking, should have a
+chance to exercise his evil propensities unchecked. Should such a
+thing be attempted the joker would find himself up against a snag
+immediately; and, as those posters announced, he was going to be
+harshly dealt with up to the "extreme penalty of the law."
+
+There were hundreds of people on the grounds at noon, which was a
+pretty good marker for the immense crowds that would soon be heading
+that way from every point of the compass. Most of these "early
+birds" were, of course, out-of-town folks, farmers' families that had
+come in, to market, perhaps, and they stayed over to see the great
+show, because everybody living for many miles around Scranton had
+heard about the meet, and and what a wonderful sight it would be,
+well worth going miles to gaze upon. These thrifty and sensible
+folks had, in many cases, brought their lunch along with them.
+Perhaps they disliked the idea of eating in small restaurants, such
+as Scranton, like most towns, boasted; but, no doubt, the main thing
+was economy in these times of scanty cash and inflated war prices.
+
+It was well worth watching when they started to open their packages,
+and spread out the contents on the ground or, as might be, on the
+benches where they had taken up their positions the better to see
+what went on. And really it would have made any boy's mouth water to
+note the immense quantities of home-made pies, doughnuts, fried
+chicken, and all such good things as were displayed in those farmer's
+wives lunch packets. At least there must be no sign of hard times
+when the family went on a picnic, or any other sort of pleasure jaunt.
+
+By then the crowds began to assemble in earnest. Town people,
+fearing a crush, hastened to leave home with the lunch dishes
+unwashed, and look for places to sit during the long afternoon.
+Along the roads every type of car, wagon, carriage, and other styles
+of equipages began to be seen, all heading toward the center of
+interest, which was the town of Scranton.
+
+Hundreds came from Allandale; indeed, it might be safe to even say
+thousands, for in every direction could be seen the colors of
+Allandale High, just as though each enthusiastic boy and girl had
+rounded up all their relatives and friends, and induced them to make
+it a point to travel to the neighboring borough, there to shout and
+shriek, and in other ways lend encouragement to each Allandale
+aspirant for athletic honors wherever they showed up.
+
+Belleville, too, must look very much like the "Deserted Village" on
+this particular afternoon; and, if the amount of business done
+depended on the few who had remained at home, her merchants would
+have to stay up until midnight in order to equal their customary
+Saturday sales.
+
+At half-past twelve the throng had become so dense that Chief Wambold
+and his men were compelled to enlist the services of a number of
+willing volunteers who, temporarily decorated with a silver shield,
+were vested with the authority of regular officers, in order to keep
+avenues open, and prevent the throng from breaking through the ropes
+upon the limited field where the athletes expected to compete.
+
+So far as attendance was concerned there was no longer the least
+doubt but that the meet would prove an abounding success; the rest
+remained to be proven. But the gathering athletes who began to
+appear in little knots, coming from the dressing rooms of the
+building, seemed full of confidence, and answered the loud salutes of
+a myriad of friends in the crowd with reassuring nods, and gestures
+calculated to buoy up their hopes.
+
+The programme would be varied. First would come several short
+sprints between the best runners of hundred-yard distances in the
+county. These were sure to key up the spectators by their thrilling
+intensity, as is always the case. Following fast upon these there
+would be hammer-throwing, and the toss of the discus. Then the
+programme called for other athletic exhibitions along a line that
+would lend variety, and enhance the interest, as the different
+schools struggled for supremacy in the arena provided, spurred on to
+do their utmost by ringing cheers, and the dearly beloved class songs.
+
+Everybody worth mentioning in Scranton would be there, from Dr.
+Carmack, the supervising head of the county schools, as well as
+principal of Scranton High, down the line to the Directors of the
+Games, the town council, the mayors of the three boroughs, and a
+whole host of notables besides.
+
+And how the fond eyes of father and mother would follow the movements
+of John, or Edward, or Philip, as though he might be the only young
+athlete worth watching in all that animated scene. If he won, they
+had always known he did not have an equal in his specialty; and
+should he be so unlucky as to come in at the heels of the pack, why,
+it was easy to be seen that he had not been given a square deal by
+some of the rival runners, who persisted in getting in his way, and
+were probably leagued together to prevent him from carrying off the
+prize. But no matter, he would always be a hero in the eyes of those
+who loved him, though he might not decorate the family mantel at home
+with the prizes he aspired to win.
+
+Hugh had kept fairly quiet after returning from Hackensack, and
+seeing the hermit once more safe in the charge of his folks. He knew
+that he must conserve his strength for the great undertaking that
+confronted him that afternoon. Those who had entered for the
+long-distance race would not be allowed, of course, to participate in
+any other event; that had been laid down as law by Mr. Leonard when
+they entered their names on the list of candidates. They must
+simply stand around and watch what was going on until the time came
+for staging the Marathon; when they could take their place in the
+long string that would await the pistol shot intended to start them
+on the telling grind.
+
+Horatio and "Just" Smith were on deck, looking fit and eager. Then,
+too, there was Nick Lang, with a grin on his heavy face every time he
+glanced toward the other three fellows. It was getting on, and some
+of the earlier events had already been carried through, amidst great
+roars of applause as the different prizes went, this one to an
+Allandale fellow, another to a boy wearing the Belleville High
+colors; and three in succession to local lads.
+
+"I don't exactly like the way that Nick Lang keeps on laughing to
+himself every time he looks over in this direction," Horatio was
+saying to the other two.
+
+"I've noticed the same thing," spoke up "Just" Smith; "and it makes
+me wonder if the tricky fellow hasn't got some slick game up his
+sleeve, as usual, looking to giving the rest of us trouble. You
+notice, don't you, boys, that, look as you will, you can't see
+anything of either that Tip Slavin, or Leon Disney. Now, when
+fellows who are as fond of outdoor sports as those two have always
+been, keep shy when such a great event as this meet is being pulled
+off, there must be a pretty good reason."
+
+"They may be somewhere in the crowd," Hugh went on to say, "because
+it'd be impossible for any single fellow to identify all that are in
+that solid heaving yelling mass of people. Nick believes he has a
+fair chance of leading the pack, and that makes him feel happy. I
+heard him say only yesterday that the one fellow he was afraid of in
+our whole bunch was K. K.; and now that accident has eliminated him,
+why, naturally, Nick feels more confidence. In imagination he's
+already receiving the grand Marathon prize, and hearing the crowds
+yelling themselves hoarse."
+
+"Well," snorted Horatio, gritting his teeth in a way he had when
+aroused, "if that's what pleases Nick he's got another guess coming;
+for three of us are also in the game; and he's got to do some mighty
+tall sprinting in that last half-mile if he expects to win out. Then
+there are a lot of other fellows in the run who may give him a pain.
+But, according to the programme, our race comes next after this pole
+vaulting contest; so, boys, we'd better be moving around, and getting
+our place in line, according to our several numbers."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVIII
+
+THE GREAT MARATHON RACE
+
+It was plainly noticeable how that vast crowd began to stir, and show
+signs of increased interest when the numerous trim runners entered
+for the big Marathon started to gather for the preliminary stage of
+the race.
+
+Each of the many contestants had a large number fastened upon both
+the front and back of his thin upper garment. By these they might be
+recognized even at a distance; and many persons carried field or
+opera glasses of various types just on purpose to make out who each
+runner was when he came in sight around the bend half a mile away, to
+open on that last stretch that was likely to see the cruelest work of
+all, if the competition chanced to be keen.
+
+The boys, as a rule, looked very much like lithe grayhounds, for your
+natural runner is light of body, and can course along like the wind.
+Still, this applies more to short-distance sprinters than those whose
+specialty is endurance in a fifteen- or twenty-mile race.
+
+Several of the fellows were quite muscular in build, and gave
+evidence of a grim determination such as the bulldog possesses.
+These chaps might be easily distanced in the start, but they would
+keep doggedly on, under the spur of the knowledge contained in that
+old adage that "the race is not always to the swift."
+
+Hugh Morgan was, perhaps, the best built of them all, neither too
+heavy, nor yet betraying a weakness that would crop out after the
+first five miles had been covered, as might be the case with the more
+slender fellows.
+
+They stood in line, listening to the last words of caution delivered
+by Mr. Hitchens, a former Yale man who had umpired the baseball games
+the preceding summer in such an impartial manner that everyone had
+the utmost reliance on his fairness.
+
+He explained to them the simple conditions of the race,--how there
+must be no fouling of any kind; just how often and where the
+contestants must register their names in books kept by judges on the
+course; how each was supposed to give his word of honor not to accept
+any sort of lift for even a dozen feet; and that the great crowd
+assembled would be waiting to acclaim the first-comer as the victor
+in the greatest long-distance race ever attempted by high-school
+boys, at least in that particular county.
+
+They were allowed a certain latitude as to their methods of running.
+If any of them could cut across lots, and still cover the entire
+course, as well as register faithfully wherever required, that was to
+be their option.
+
+Having finished his little fatherly talk, the referee stepped to one
+side, and gave the word for the runners to make ready.
+
+Every eye was glued on this or that contestant, according to the
+humor of the spectator. Each Allandale visitor saw only Allandale in
+that long line, swaying back and forth a trifle, like a reed shaken
+in the wind. They could not believe it possible that any other
+fellow had the slightest chance of coming in ahead of those
+fleet-footed boys upon whose ability they pinned their full trust.
+
+So it was with the Belleville rooters; while, of course, the natives
+were certain the prize was already as good as won by Hugh Morgan; or,
+it might happen to be, Horatio Juggins, "Just" Smith, or possibly
+Nick Lang, the last-named looking ever so confident, as he leaned
+over nearly double in his favorite crouch, his fingertips in contact
+with the ground, and his knees bent.
+
+Then came the sharp report of the pistol.
+
+"They're off!" involuntarily exclaimed a thousand persons in unison,
+as the line of nimble runners was seen to leap into action, and shoot
+away with amazing speed.
+
+There were a few little lively brushes in the start, before the
+runners settled down to real business. Some were immediately left
+behind, but this fact seemed to give them little concern, for they
+kept jogging away as though quite happy.
+
+Doubtless, a number had entered with no idea of covering more than a
+few miles of the long course. They just enjoyed the excitement, and
+the honor of being able to say they had once run in a fifteen-mile
+schoolboy Marathon race.
+
+After a bit these novices would drop out, perhaps even hasten back
+with various clever excuses for giving up; and having gained the
+cheers of their particular coterie of friends they could don a few
+more clothes to keep off the chill, and settle back to watch the rest
+of the entertainment. Their opinion would naturally be much sought
+after, as to the chances of this or that genuine contestant; which
+was one of the things they desired.
+
+As it takes considerable time for even fleet-footed runners to go
+over a fifteen-mile course, the sensible committee, who knew just
+about how long the crowd would have to wait, had provided plenty of
+amusement meanwhile.
+
+Interspersed with a number of minor events, such as further sprinting
+matches for younger entries, and some more pole vaulting, as well as
+Indian club exhibitions of skill, would come the humorous features of
+the meet.
+
+These are always popular with the country people; indeed, nearly
+everybody seems to welcome them as a diversion calculated to raise
+hearty laughter.
+
+There was also keen competition even in the potato race; and the
+crowd yelled itself hoarse to see the antics of those who met with
+all manner of mishaps when engaged in the hurdle, and the obstacle
+affairs.
+
+The boys who had engaged to try for these prizes seemed to "get their
+dander up," as some fellow expressed it, and the way they struggled
+and vied with one another was "equal to a circus with a brass band."
+
+Although mention may not have been made of the fact up to now, the
+Scranton band was giving of its very best from time to time, and the
+air throbbed with martial music suitable to a country just then at
+war with a foreign nation. It was a fair sort of band in the
+bargain, and well worth listening to; so that the music really added
+greatly to the enjoyment of the occasion.
+
+When the three-legged race was pulled off the spectators howled their
+sympathy with this or that pair of contestants as they hopped along,
+now rolling on the ground while bound together, and, at times, even
+trying to creep in desperation, when it seemed as though a difference
+of opinions in the two minds trying to control what was just the same
+as one pair of legs, caused confusion, and a lack of progression.
+
+Later on came the climbing of the greased pole. This is always
+comical enough, and aroused much enthusiasm. Nobody seems to be a
+favorite, and each successful attempt to mount is greeted with
+shrieks of laughter. So long as a valiant fellow is seen to be
+steadily making his way upwards, inch by inch, he may be applauded;
+but let him display the slightest hint of having "shot his bolt," and
+begin to slip back again, howls of derision will greet his ears, so
+that in confusion he finally gives it up, and retires in haste.
+
+All sorts of small means are resorted to in order to allow the
+contestant to get a surer grip on the slippery pole; for, up to a
+certain point, these are allowable. One rubs sand in his hands, and
+for a brief time this seems to enable him to do splendid work; but
+then it soon wears away, and then his troubles begin; until, unable
+to make further progress, he is seen to glance over his shoulder to
+note how far from the ground he has risen. This is a sure sign of
+weakening, and, of course, the watchful crowd again roars at him to
+keep right on, that he's doing nobly, and all that; but John knows
+better, and so down he comes with a rush, and passes out, shaking his
+head in disgust and bitter disappointment; for possibly he had been
+within five feet of the top when his energies failed him.
+
+So the time went on, merrily enough.
+
+Many persons were declaring they had not enjoyed such an afternoon
+for years, and felt weak from so much laughter.
+
+Watches were being consulted more and more frequently now.
+
+"It's getting time we saw something of those chaps," could be heard
+here and there, showing that numbers had figured things out, or else
+received a tip from an authority in the game as to just how long it
+was likely to take a fleet runner to cover fifteen miles of good road.
+
+Anxious eyes were being strained unduly, watching the bend half a
+mile beyond. It could be seen from almost any part of the field,
+fortunately, though once the big board fence was in position, the
+view would be partly cut off.
+
+It had been arranged, as is always done, that when a runner was
+sighted nearing the bend a gun would be fired by the sentry on duty
+there, to attract the attention of the crowd, so that they might have
+the first glimpse of the leading contestants, as they rounded that
+abrupt curve where the view was shut off.
+
+There was now nothing going on in the arena, the entire programme
+having been carried out. Still, few, if any, left their seats,
+although they had been there for several hours, it might be. The
+deepest interest centered upon the completion of the Marathon race.
+In comparison to this exhibition of school-boy endurance and pluck
+the other affairs seemed to sink into insignificance; although at the
+time they occurred doubtless those who had friends entered were
+wildly excited. But then the race that has already been finished is
+never as intensely interesting as the one in process of being run;
+just as the fish landed never seems quite so wonderful as the fellow
+who is still swimming the waters, and eyeing the baited hook as
+though tempted to take a hazard.
+
+Seconds seemed fraught with undue importance, and many impatient
+fellows, upon consulting their watches, were seen to hold the same up
+to their ear, as though to make sure the time-piece had not stopped,
+so leaden-footed did the minutes seem to move along.
+
+Some of the girls had commenced to sing their class songs, but in a
+mild sort of way; for they did not wish to lose the sound that would
+denote that a runner was in sight at the second bend, and could be
+expected shortly to come into view at the head of the last half-mile
+strip of road leading to the goal.
+
+Once an engine on the railroad not far away gave a sharp whistle that
+thrilled everybody, and numberless eyes were glued on the point up
+the road where the first runner must appear. Then a general laugh
+ran around because of the false alarm.
+
+But everything must have an end, and that keen anxiety finally met
+with its reward. Plainly came the heavy boom of the waiting gun.
+Everyone craned his or her neck to see. Hearts beat quicker with
+eager anticipation. Which one of the thirty contestants would be the
+first to appear? There might be several in a bunch, primed for the
+final sprint for goal. The very thought thrilled hearts, and added
+color to cheeks, as well as made eyes sparkle with anticipation.
+Allandale was not cheering now; Belleville rooters were strangely
+quiet; for, so far, the outcome of the great race was still wrapped
+in mystery; but the solution would soon come, they knew.
+
+Another heavy boom told that a second runner was just around the
+bend, and when a third discharge quickly followed the crowd knew
+there was going to be an exciting finish to the Marathon.
+
+Then a plainly audible sigh broke forth as the first runner was seen
+rounding the bend, and starting on the home stretch, but wabbling
+badly as he ran, being almost completely exhausted.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIX
+
+ON THE FINAL MILE OF THE COURSE
+
+Meanwhile, in order to understand certain important events that came
+about, it is necessary that we follow the runners, and devote this
+chapter to what occurred up to the time that first fellow came
+lunging around the final bend, having covered the whole course up to
+the final lap.
+
+For a mile or so along the road there were bunches of schoolboys and
+girls waiting to give some of the contestants a cheering word as they
+flashed past. The enthusiasts, however, would not linger long, for
+they likely enough wished to see the comical part of the programme
+carried out. Besides, once the runners had straggled past their
+posts the only interest remaining for them in the race was its
+conclusion. So they would want to get back to the grounds, and
+secure positions along the line to the first bend, where they could
+greet each contestant as he appeared, and cheer him on; for he would
+probably need encouragement, being near the point of exhaustion.
+
+Hugh had figured things out exactly, and knew what he could do. He
+was not alarmed because several of the visiting runners led the way,
+and even "Just" Smith had quite a little lead over him.
+
+Pegging along, Hugh covered mile after mile with a steadiness that he
+had reduced to machine-like motion. He had timed himself, and the
+whole course was mentally charted for his guidance. If he reached
+the cut-off road at a certain time he would know things were moving
+just as swiftly as necessary. Those boys who strained themselves in
+that first seven miles would be apt to rue their rashness when they
+began to feel their legs quiver with weakness under them, and still
+miles remained to be covered ere the goal came in sight. And,
+besides, they were sure to be in no condition for a hot final sprint,
+in case of keen competition.
+
+So Hugh, having registered as required at two booths on the way, and
+thus learned the order in which the trio ahead of him seemed to be
+running, finally arrived at the sunken quarry road. He recognized
+the landmarks before he reached the spot; and losing not a second of
+time darted among the trees.
+
+"Just" Smith was still leading him, for here and there he could
+distinguish the other's footprints, where the ground chanced to be a
+little moist. Hugh also had reason to believe that Nick Lang was
+coming strong not a great distance behind him. He wondered whether
+Nick meant to take advantage of the old quarry road as well as he and
+"Just" Smith, and Horatio in the bargain. For that matter Hugh did
+not care an iota; if Nick considered it would be to his advantage he
+was at liberty to benefit by this scheme of Hugh's. It was all for
+the glory of Scranton High; and far better that Nick won the prize,
+than that it should be taken by an Allandale, or a Belleville
+contestant--that is, if he won it honestly.
+
+Apparently, on the face of the returns, when half of the fifteen-mile
+course had been run, the victory was likely to be carried off by
+Whipple, the fleet-winged Allandale chap who had played right field
+during the baseball matches; "Just" Smith; himself; or possibly Nick
+Lang. There was always a dim and remote possibility, however, of a
+dark horse forging to the front on the home stretch. This might be
+Horatio Juggins, or McKee, or perhaps that Belleville runner, Conway,
+who had looked so confident when Hugh surveyed the line of eager
+faces at the start.
+
+Hugh remembered every foot of the way along that quarry road. He had
+a faculty for impressing features of the surrounding landscape on his
+mind, so that he could recall it at pleasure, just as though he held
+a photograph in his hand.
+
+Now he was drawing near the quarry itself, the loneliest and most
+gruesome stretch of the entire cut-off; with "Just" Smith still in
+the lead. Hugh felt proud of his chum, and often chuckled as he
+contemplated the other's supreme delight in case a fickle fortune
+allowed him to come in ahead; for honors of this sort were a rare
+thing in the past of the Smith boy; and certainly he had never before
+been so close to reaping such a colossal prize as the winning of the
+Marathon would be reckoned.
+
+Now Hugh glimpsed the quarry on one side of him. How his thoughts
+flew backward to marshal the strange events so recently happening
+there, in which he and some of his comrades had had the good fortune
+to participate.
+
+Just then he heard a plain groan. It gave him a little thrill, but
+not because he fancied there was anything supernatural connected with
+the sound. Looking in the direction from whence the groan came he
+discovered a boy sitting on the ground, and rubbing his lower
+extremities vigorously.
+
+It was "Just" Smith! Evidently something not down on the programme
+had happened to the boy who led the race across the quarry road.
+Hugh suspected treachery immediately. He turned aside, and sprang
+towards his chum.
+
+"Hey! what ails you, 'Just' Smith?" he called out, wasting some of
+his precious breath in the bargain. "This isn't the way to win a
+Marathon, don't you know? What if you have barked your shin?--forget
+all about it, and get moving again!"
+
+The Smith boy looked very sad, as he shook his face dolefully.
+
+"Huh! wish I could, Hugh," he hastened to mumble, still rubbing his
+shin, and making faces as though it hurt him considerably. "I've
+tried to run, but shucks; what's the use when you can hardly limp at
+the best? I'm through, Hugh, sorry to say. You keep on, and bag the
+prize; next to winning it myself I'd love to know _you_ took it away
+from that Whipple chap."
+
+"But--how did the accident happen, 'Just' Smith?" continued Hugh.
+
+"Accident nothing!" snapped the other, between his set teeth. "It
+was all a set-up game to knock one of us out of the race, I tell you.
+If you'd been leading at the time, why, that shower of rocks must
+have met you."
+
+"Rocks, did you say?" exclaimed Hugh, looking dark.
+
+Just then the sound of footsteps was heard. A runner went past them
+on the full tear. It was Nick Lang, and when he turned his face
+toward the two on their knees the wicked look on his grinning face
+told more eloquently than words how his brain had been the one to
+hatch up this miserable trick whereby he hoped to gain an advantage
+over one of his schoolmates who might happen to be leading him in the
+race. He vanished down the road, still running strong. "Just" Smith
+almost howled, he was so furious.
+
+"That's the chap who engineered this rotten game, I tell you, Hugh!"
+he snapped. "And chances are ten to one it was Leon Disney and that
+Tip Slavin who threw all those stones, and then ran away laughing, so
+I couldn't glimpse 'em. Say, I was struck in half a dozen places.
+I've got a lump on my head nearly as big as a hen's egg; and my elbow
+hurts like everything. I was so flustered that I must have got
+twisted in a vine, or else struck a root, for I fell, and barked my
+shin something fierce. I wanted to chase after the cowards, but knew
+it was silly to think of such a thing. Then I tried to keep on, but
+it wasn't any use, and I gave it up as a bad job. But Hugh, I hope
+you don't mean to let that skunk profit by his trickery. Please
+start off, and beat him out, if it takes a leg."
+
+"But I hate to leave you here, 'Just' Smith, much as I'd like to
+chase after Nick, because now he deserves to be beaten."
+
+"Oh! don't bother about me, Hugh. I'll try and get to the main
+road, even if I have to _crawl_. Later on you can come back for me
+in some sort of rig. Whew! but I'm as mad as a hatter because I've
+lost my fine chance, when I was going so strong, with plenty of
+reserve force held back."
+
+Hugh realized that duty called upon him to do as his chum demanded.
+It would be a shame if Nick Lang actually profited through such a
+rank act of treachery toward his fellows of Scranton High. An
+individual should be ready to sacrifice his school or its interests
+to his own personal ambition, and certainly never should it be
+allowed that he gain his ends through such a dastardly trick as the
+waylaying of another on the road, and his being assaulted, as "Just"
+Smith had been.
+
+"All right, I'll do it, then!" Hugh exclaimed, with a look of sudden
+determination. "Expect me back later on, old fellow! Bye-bye!
+Don't try to do too much, and hurt yourself worse!"
+
+With these words he sprang away. "Just" Smith gave him a parting
+cheer, that must have come a bit hard, owing to the pain he suffered,
+and also the bitter disappointment that wrung his boyish and
+ambitious heart.
+
+Hugh had but one thought now, which was to speed along at such a clip
+as to allow him to finally overtake and pass the treacherous Nick,
+and leave him in the lurch. The spur of punishing the other for such
+dastardly conduct was apt to prove an incentive calculated to add
+considerably to Hugh's running.
+
+Nick had the advantage, since he must be well on the way to the main
+thoroughfare by now; and once that was gained there was a clear field
+ahead of him. But one more registering station remained, and that
+was at a certain turn on the way home. Then would come the final
+three miles, with the pace increasing constantly, as those in the
+lead vied with each other to get ahead, or to retain that proud
+position.
+
+Hugh quickly regained the mastery over his aroused feelings. He must
+stay cool and collected so as to do exactly the right thing at the
+right time. A little slip in the way of judgment was likely to lose
+him the race, for he now learned as he gained the main road, that
+there were not only one but two competitors ahead of him.
+
+Yes, the fleet-footed Whipple had somehow managed to spin along over
+the ground, and was now not far behind Nick Lang. Possibly the
+fellow from Allandale had also secretly examined the course and
+discovered a cut-off on his own account, through means of which he
+anticipated gaining a great advantage over all the other runners in
+the Marathon.
+
+Hugh now set out to make steady gains. He must be within a certain
+distance of those two fellows by the time the last stretch was
+reached, or else all his hope of overtaking and passing them would be
+lost.
+
+He found that his powers of endurance and speed had not been
+misjudged, for they responded nobly when called upon for a further
+spurt. Now, he was greatly lessening the distance separating him
+from Whipple; who, in turn, seemed able to hold his own with Nick.
+
+The latter began to show the first signs of distress when they were
+at the beginning of the last two miles. He looked over his shoulder,
+and no runner ever is guilty of such an unwise proceeding unless his
+heart has commenced to be filled with grave doubts as to his being a
+winner.
+
+Again did Hugh notice Nick doing this, and he took fresh courage from
+the circumstance. Yes, and looking more closely he also saw that
+Nick was not running true to form any longer; he had begun to wobble
+more or less, as though unable to continue on in a straight line.
+That was another bad sign, since it causes the runner to cover
+unnecessary ground; and also indicates a weakening heart.
+
+Hugh let out another burst of speed. He was closing the gap rapidly;
+and, apparently, Whipple also seemed to be gaining on the almost
+played-out Nick.
+
+They were now within less than a mile of the finish; the last turn
+would soon be reached, with the gun booming out the fact of their
+arrival. Hugh girded his loins for a Garrison finish, and gloried in
+the conviction that he was in trim to do himself credit.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XX
+
+THE BOY WHO WON--CONCLUSION
+
+"It's Nick Lang, as sure as anything!" shouted a boy who happened to
+possess an excellent pair of field-glasses.
+
+"Nick Lang in the lead!" howled another; "well, what do you think of
+that? Where, oh, where, oh, where is Hugh Morgan about this time;
+and 'Just' Smith in the bargain?"
+
+"But Nick is a Scranton High boy after all, and that's a heap better
+than to see an Allandale fellow come in ahead!" cried another near by.
+
+"Look! a second runner has turned the bend; and see how he is coming
+up on poor wobbly old Nick hand-over-fist!"
+
+"Hello! what's this mean?" whooped a visitor exultantly. "Surely I
+know the second fellow's build. It's certainly our great Whipple!
+He's going to cop the prize, boys! Give Whipple an Allandale yell
+right now to encourage him!"
+
+Even as a score of boyish throats roared in response to this entreaty
+a third runner was discovered rounding the bend. He appeared to be
+tearing along at race-horse speed, as though having a reserve stock
+of power upon which to call in this closing half-mile of the long
+race.
+
+"Hugh Morgan!"
+
+The words seemed to run like wildfire through the vast crowd.
+Everybody repeated them, some with a growing delight, others with a
+sense of impending disaster to the wild hopes they had been so
+ardently cherishing; all according to the viewpoint they held.
+Scranton's register was rising, while Allandale visitors began to
+feel something was on the verge of happening to crush the budding
+paean of victory that was ready to bubble from their lips.
+
+Nick evidently knew that he had shot his bolt. He, doubtless, tried
+frantically to encourage his legs to move faster, but they refused to
+hearken to the call. Whipple was now rapidly closing the short gap
+existing between them. At the same time it could be seen that the
+Allandale runner veered a trifle, as though to give Nick a fairly
+wide berth when passing.
+
+Plenty of fellows noticed this fact, nor did they wonder at it. The
+tricky character of Nick Lang was pretty well known, and they
+believed he would not hesitate about throwing himself sideways, so as
+to collide with Whipple when the other was in the act of passing him;
+although such a vindictive act could, of course, not better the
+position of the local runner a particle.
+
+When Whipple actually took the lead a great roar arose from thousands
+of throats. Doubtless many wild-eyed Allandale enthusiasts already
+counted the victory as won. They could be seen commencing to throw
+their hats and caps into the air, boy-fashion. Others, wiser,
+gripped their hands, and held their breath while waiting to see the
+actual finish of the great race.
+
+Of a truth Whipple was doing splendidly, there was no gainsaying
+that; but coming on back of him was one who appeared to be making
+much better time. Hugh was gaining fast, they could see. The only
+question that remained to be settled was whether Whipple had it in
+him to increase his pace sufficiently to cross the tape first; or, on
+the other hand, if Hugh Morgan was able to speed up still more, and
+close the gap.
+
+How the shouts rang out. Everybody seemed to be cheering madly at
+the same time. Men stood up, and waved their arms; girls embraced
+each other, though not an eye was turned away from that wonderful
+finish of the great Marathon race.
+
+Now, Hugh had apparently released his final effort. He was gaining
+faster and faster. Whipple seemed to know that he was in deadly
+peril. He, too, looked back over his shoulder in alarm, possibly
+meaning in desperation to almost burst a blood vessel if he found
+that his rival was about to overtake him.
+
+That proved his eventual undoing, though the result was no longer in
+doubt. He lost his balance, and, being so exhausted that he could
+not stand longer, pitched headlong to the ground, just as the fleet
+Hugh jumped into the lead, raced twenty steps further, broke the
+extended tape, and thus won the race.
+
+How the heavens seemed to fairly quiver with the roars that broke
+out! It had been a most thrilling finish for the greatest race ever
+run in all the country. Time might come and time might go, but never
+would those who had been so fortunate as to witness the conclusion of
+the Marathon forget the thrilling spectacle.
+
+Hugh bore his honors meekly.
+
+He utterly declined to let some of the Scranton fellows pick him up
+and bear him around on their shoulders, as they threatened to do.
+After the prizes had been duly awarded the assemblage broke up, and
+the roads leading out of Scranton were soon blocked with hundreds of
+vehicles of every description carrying home the visitors.
+
+Even Allandale and Belleville had no reason to be disappointed over
+the general results, for their young athletes had fared very well,
+all things considered. Of course, most of them would rather have
+seen the Marathon won by a representative from their school than to
+"scoop in" all the other prizes grouped together; but since it had to
+go to Scranton, they voiced the opinion of most people when they
+declared they were glad Hugh Morgan had won it, and not Nick Lang.
+
+Even though overwhelmed with congratulations on every hand, Hugh did
+not forget his promise to "Just" Smith. As soon as he could get into
+his street clothes he hunted a fellow who chanced to have his
+father's flivver handy, and easily won his consent to take him along
+the road in the direction of Belleville, in order to find poor "Just"
+Smith, and get him home again.
+
+This they did without any mishap, and it may be easily understood
+that the disappointed boy hailed their coming with great joy. He
+knew all about that gruelling finish of the big race in the bargain,
+some of those Allandale chaps passing by in vehicles having readily
+informed him as to the winner, and what a tremendously thrilling
+sight the finish had been.
+
+Of course, since "Just" Smith had not once glimpsed the figures of
+his assailants, and as conviction can hardly rest upon a burst of
+vindictive boyish laughter, there was no public denunciation of Nick
+Lang and his cronies. Everybody could give a good guess, however, as
+to who was guilty; and after that Nick was destined to feel himself
+more ostracized by his schoolmates than ever before.
+
+The great athletic tournament had proven to be a complete success,
+being marred by no serious accidents, for which many a devoted mother
+in Scranton gave thanks that same night, even though her boy may not
+have won undying fame through gaining a prize. Hugh himself was more
+than satisfied, though he would have been almost as well pleased had
+it been poor "K. K.," "Just" Smith, or Horatio Juggins who had won
+the big race, so long as the honor of Scranton High was upheld.
+
+That was to be the finish of the fall sports, but with winter so near
+at hand, and that vast field being put in order for flooding, it
+might readily be guessed the boys and girls of Scranton were in line
+for considerable more fun while Jack Frost held sway over his frozen
+dominions. That this supposition proved to be a correct one may be
+judged from the title of the fourth and following volume in this
+series, which can be had wherever boys' books are sold, and bearing
+the suggestive title of "The Chums of Scranton High at Ice Hockey;
+or, A Wizard on Steel Runners." Get it, if you have enjoyed reading
+about Hugh Morgan and his loyal comrades in this and previous books;
+you will find it just as deeply interesting as anything that has gone
+before, since the boys of Scranton enter upon a fresh line of healthy
+competition, this time upon the ice.
+
+
+
+
+THE END
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of The Chums of Scranton High on the
+Cinder Path, by Donald Ferguson
+
+*** END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK 13251 ***
diff --git a/LICENSE.txt b/LICENSE.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6312041
--- /dev/null
+++ b/LICENSE.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,11 @@
+This eBook, including all associated images, markup, improvements,
+metadata, and any other content or labor, has been confirmed to be
+in the PUBLIC DOMAIN IN THE UNITED STATES.
+
+Procedures for determining public domain status are described in
+the "Copyright How-To" at https://www.gutenberg.org.
+
+No investigation has been made concerning possible copyrights in
+jurisdictions other than the United States. Anyone seeking to utilize
+this eBook outside of the United States should confirm copyright
+status under the laws that apply to them.
diff --git a/README.md b/README.md
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..df7920c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/README.md
@@ -0,0 +1,2 @@
+Project Gutenberg (https://www.gutenberg.org) public repository for
+eBook #13251 (https://www.gutenberg.org/ebooks/13251)
diff --git a/old/13251.txt b/old/13251.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..98464cc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/old/13251.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,4879 @@
+The Project Gutenberg EBook of The Chums of Scranton High on the Cinder
+Path, by Donald Ferguson
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+
+Title: The Chums of Scranton High on the Cinder Path
+
+Author: Donald Ferguson
+
+Release Date: August 22, 2004 [EBook #13251]
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: ASCII
+
+*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE CHUMS OF SCRANTON HIGH ***
+
+
+
+
+Produced by Al Haines
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+THE CHUMS OF SCRANTON HIGH
+
+On the Cinder Path
+
+
+
+
+BY
+
+
+DONALD FERGUSON
+
+
+
+
+THE WORLD SYNDICATE PUBLISHING CO.
+
+CLEVELAND, O. NEW YORK, N. Y.
+
+
+
+
+Copyright, MCMXIX
+
+by
+
+THE WORLD SYNDICATE PUBLISHING CO.
+
+
+
+
+
+
+Printed in the United States of America
+
+by
+
+THE COMMERCIAL BOOKBINDING CO,
+
+CLEVELAND, O.
+
+
+
+CONTENTS
+
+CHAPTER
+
+ I. THE FIVE NUT FORAGERS
+ II. ON THE OLD QUARRY ROAD
+ III. TALKING OF GHOSTS
+ IV. IN TRAINING FOR THE GREAT TOURNAMENT
+ V. TREACHERY IN THE AIR
+ VI. THE PROWLER
+ VII. CAUGHT IN THE ACT
+ VIII. LEON PROMISES TO REFORM
+ IX. SCRANTON IN GALA ATTIRE
+ X. WHEN MUSCLES COUNTED
+ XI. THE CRISIS IN CLAUDE'S LIFE
+ XII. STARTLING NEWS FROM THE JUGGINS BOY
+ XIII. TO THE RESCUE OF "K. K."
+ XIV. THE SEARCHING PARTY
+ XV. PROWLING AROUND THE QUARRY
+ XVI. A FRIENDLY "GHOST"
+ XVII. SCRANTON'S "OPEN HOUSE" DAY
+ XVIII. THE GREAT MARATHON RACE
+ XIX. ON THE FINAL MILE OF THE COURSE
+ XX. THE BOY WHO WON--CONCLUSION
+
+
+
+
+THE CHUMS OF SCRANTON HIGH
+
+
+CHAPTER I
+
+THE FIVE NUT FORAGERS
+
+The bright October sun was half-way down the western sky one Saturday
+afternoon. Two-thirds of the Fall month had already gone, and the
+air was becoming fairly crisp in the early mornings.
+
+All around the forest trees were painted various shades of bright
+scarlet, burnt umber brown and vivid gold by the practiced fingers of
+that master artist, the Frost-King. Flocks of robins and blackbirds
+were gathering rather late this year, preparatory to taking their
+annual pilgrimage to the warm Southland. They flew overhead at times
+in vast numbers, making a tremendous chatter.
+
+A noisy bunch of crows cawed unceasingly amidst the treetops as a
+large, lumbering old automobile passed along the country road, the
+same filled with lively boys, and also a number of sacks stuffed to
+their utmost capacity with what appeared to be black walnuts,
+shell-bark hickories, butternuts, and even splendid large chestnuts.
+Apparently, the strange and deadly blight that was attacking the
+chestnut groves all through the East had not yet appeared in the
+highly favored region around the town of Scranton, in which place the
+boys in question lived, and attended the famous high school where Dr.
+Carmack, also supervisor of the entire county schools, held forth.
+
+The five tired lads who formed this nutting party we have met before
+in the pages of previous stories in this series; so that to those who
+have been fortunate enough to possess such books they need no lengthy
+introduction.
+
+First, there was Hugh Morgan, looking as genial and determined as
+ever, and just as frequently consulted by his comrades, because his
+opinion always carried considerable weight. Then came his most
+intimate chum, Thad Stevens, who had played the position of backstop
+so successfully during the summer just passed, and helped to win the
+pennant for Scranton against the other two high schools of the
+country, situated in the towns of Allendale and Belleville.
+
+Besides these two, there was included in the party a tall chap who
+seemed to be acting as chauffeur, from which it might be judged that
+he had supplied the means for taking this nutting trip far afield;
+his name was Kenneth Kinkaid, but among his friends he answered to
+the shorter appellation of "K. K." Then came a fourth boy of shorter
+build, and more sturdy physique, Julius Hobson by name; and last, but
+far from least, Horatio Juggins, a rather comical fellow who often
+assumed a dramatic attitude, and quoted excerpts from some school
+declamation, his favorite, of course, being "Horatio at the Bridge."
+
+It was "K. K." who got up the annual foraging expedition on this
+particular year, and promised that they should go in style in the
+antiquated seven-passenger car belonging to his father, who was a
+commercial traveler, which car "K. K." often used, when he could
+raise the cash to provide sufficient gasolene at twenty-five cents
+per gallon. But on this momentous occasion each fellow had chipped
+in his share pro rata; so that the generous provider of the big, open
+car was not compelled to beg or borrow in order to properly equip the
+expedition.
+
+For ten days and more previously some of the boys had industriously
+interviewed the farmers who stood in the market-place during the early
+mornings, selling the products of their acres. Doubtless numerous
+good mothers wondered what caused such an early exodus from warm beds
+those days, since farmers had a habit of getting rid of their produce
+at dawn, and driving off home while most schoolboys were indulging in
+their last nap.
+
+But, by various means, they had learned just where the nuts grew most
+plentifully that season; and quite a list of available places had
+been tabulated: to the Guernsey Woods for blacks; plenty of
+shagbarks, and some shellbarks to be gathered over at the old Morton
+Place, where no one had lived these seven years now; and they said
+the chestnuts away up in that region miles beyond the mill-pond was
+bearing a record crop this season, as if to make amends for lean
+years a-plenty.
+
+Scranton was one of the few places where the boys still yearned after
+a goodly supply of freshly gathered nuts to carry them through a long
+and severe winter. Somehow they vied with one another in the
+gathering of the harvest of the woods, and often these outings
+yielded considerable sport, besides being profitable to the nutters.
+On one momentous occasion the boys had even discovered the hive of a
+colony of wild bees, cut the tree down, fought the enraged denizens
+by means of smoke and fire, and eventually carried home a wonderful
+stock of dearly earned honey that would make the buckwheat cakes
+taste all the sweeter that winter because of the multitude of
+swellings it cost the proud possessors.
+
+Hugh had been coaxed to join the party; not that he did not fully
+enjoy such enterprises, but he had laid out another programme for
+that afternoon. All through the morning these same lads had been
+hard at work on the open field where Scranton played her baseball
+games, and had such other gatherings as high-school fellows are
+addicted. Here a fine new cinder path had been laid around the
+grounds, forming an oval that measured just an eighth of a mile, to a
+fraction.
+
+All through the livelong day on Saturdays, and in the afternoons
+during weekdays, boys in strange-looking running costumes of various
+designs could be seen diligently practicing at all manner of stunts,
+from sprinting, leaping hurdles, engaging in the high jump, with the
+aid of poles; throwing the hammer; and, in fact, every conceivable
+exercise that would be apt to come under the head of a genuine
+athletic tournament.
+
+For, to tell the secret without any evasion, that was just what
+Scranton designed to have inside of another week--a monster affair
+that included entries from all other schools in the county, and which
+already promised to be one of the greatest and most successful meets
+ever held.
+
+Hugh and his chums were every one of them entered for several events;
+indeed, it would have been like looking for a needle in a haystack to
+try and find a single Scranton boy above the age of ten, and sound of
+wind, who had not taken advantage of the generous invitation to place
+his name on the records, and go in for training along a certain line.
+Those who could not sprint, leap the bars, throw hammer or discus, or
+do any other of the ordinary stunts, might, at least, have some
+chance of winning a prize in the climbing of the greased pole, the
+catching of the greased pig, the running of the obstacle race, or
+testing their ability to hop in the three-legged race, where each
+couple of boys would have a right and left leg bound together, and
+then attempt to cross a given line ahead of all like competitors.
+
+So even when they started out after lunch the whole five were a bit
+tired; and a vast store of nuts, like the one they were fetching
+home, cannot be gathered, no matter however plentiful they may be on
+ground and trees, without considerable muscular effort on the part of
+the ambitious collectors.
+
+Consequently, every fellow was feeling pretty stiff and sore about
+the time we overtake them on the way home. Besides, most of them had
+zigzag scratches on face and hands by which to remember the
+wonderfully successful expedition for several days. Then there was
+Julius Hobson with a soiled handkerchief bound around his left thumb,
+which he solicitously examined every little while. He had, somehow,
+managed to catch a frisky little squirrel, which, wishing to take
+home, he had imprisoned in one of his side pockets that had a flap;
+but, desirous of fondling the furry little object, he had
+incautiously inserted his bare hand once too often; for its long
+teeth, so useful for nut-cracking, went almost through his thumb, and
+gave his such an electric shock that in the confusion the frightened
+animal managed to escape once more to its native wilds.
+
+Hugh, as he went along toward home, was really taking mental notes
+concerning the lay of the land, and with an object in view. He was
+entered for the fifteen-mile Marathon race (an unusually long
+distance for boys to run, by the way, and hardly advisable under
+ordinary conditions), and one of the registering places where every
+contestant had to sign his name to a book kept by a judge so as to
+prove that he had actually reached that particular and important
+corner of the rectangular course, had been the quaint little old road
+tavern just half a mile back of them.
+
+"You're wondering just why I'm so curious about the country up here,
+I can see, fellows," Hugh was saying about the time we meet them;
+"and, as we all belong to the same school, and our dearest wish is to
+see Scranton High win the prize that is offered by the committee in
+the Marathon, I don't mind letting you in. I know something about
+this country up here, and have traced on a surveyor's chart the
+ordinary course a fellow would be apt to take in passing from the
+second tally post, that old tavern back of us, along this road to the
+canal, and from there across the old logging road to Hobson's Pond,
+where there's going to be the last registering place before the dash
+for home. Well, I've figured it out that a fellow would save
+considerable ground if he left this same road half a mile below, and
+cut across by way of the Juniper Swamp trail, striking in again along
+about the Halpin Farm."
+
+His remarks created no end of interest, for there were several others
+among the bunch who had also entered for that long-distance race;
+and, naturally, they began to figure on how they might take advantage
+of Hugh's discovery. It was all for the honor and credit of good old
+Scranton High; so that it really mattered little just which fellow
+crossed the line first, so long as he "saved the bacon."
+
+"It sounds pretty fine to me, Hugh," said Julius, "only I don't like
+one thing."
+
+"What's that, Julius?" demanded the Juggins boy.
+
+"By following that Juniper Swamp trail and the old road Hugh
+mentions, we'd have to pass close to that deserted stone quarry; and
+say, the farmers all vow it's sure haunted."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER II
+
+ON THE OLD QUARRY ROAD
+
+When Julius made this assertion, the other fellows looked at each
+other in what might be said to be a queer way. In fact, they had all
+heard certain absurd stories told in connection with the old quarry
+that had not been worked for so many years that the road leading to
+it across country had grown up in grass and weeds. Some adventurous
+boys who went out there once declared it was a most gruesome place,
+with pools of water covered with green scum lying around, and all
+sorts of holes looking like the cave Robinson Crusoe found on his
+island home to be seen where granite building rocks had been
+excavated from the towering cliffs.
+
+It was K. K. who laughed first, actually laughed scornfully, though
+Julius took it all so seriously. Thad Stevens followed with a
+chuckle, after his peculiar fashion.
+
+"You give me a pain, Julius, you certainly do," ventured K. K.
+
+"To think," added Thad, assuming a lofty air of superior knowledge,
+"of a fellow attending Scranton High believing the ridiculous yarns
+these uneducated tillers of the soil and their hired help pass
+around, about there being some sort of a genuine _ghost_ haunting the
+old quarry--why, it's positively silly of you, Julius, and I don't
+mind telling you so to your face."
+
+"Oh, hold on there, fellows!" expostulated the other boy; "I didn't
+say that I really and truly believed any of those awful stories, did
+I? But so many different persons have told me the same thing that,
+somehow, I came to think there _might_ be some fire where there was
+so much smoke. Of course, it can't be a ghost, but, nevertheless,
+there are queer goings-on about that deserted quarry these
+nights--three different people, and one of them a steady-going woman
+in the bargain, assured me they had glimpsed moving lights there, a
+sort of flare that did all sorts of zigzag stunts, like it was
+cutting signals in the air."
+
+"Hugh, do you think that could be what they call wild-fire, or some
+folks give it the name of will-o'-the-wisp, others say
+jack-o'-lantern?" demanded Horatio Juggins, who had been listening
+intently while all this talk was going on.
+
+"I'd hardly like to say," replied Hugh thoughtfully. "As a general
+thing that odd, moving light is seen in low, damp places. Often it
+is noticed in graveyards in the country, and is believed to be
+induced by a condition of the atmosphere, causing something like
+phosphorescence. You know what a firefly or lightning bug is like,
+don't you, Horatio? Yes, and a glow-worm also? Well, they say that
+there are black-looking pools of stagnant water lying around the old
+quarry; and yes, I think the lights seen might come from just such
+conditions."
+
+"That sounds all very well, Hugh," continued Julius, "but what about
+the terrifying cry that sometimes wells up from that same place?"
+
+"A cry, Julius, do you say?" exclaimed Horatio, his eyes growing
+round now with increasing wonder and thrilling interest, "do you
+really and truly mean that, or are you only joshing?"
+
+"Well," the narrator went on to say soberly, "two fellows told me
+they'd heard that same shriek. One was hunting a stray heifer when
+he found himself near the quarry, and then got a shock that sent him
+on the run all the way home, regardless of trees he banged into, for
+it was night-time, with only a quarter-moon up in the western sky.
+The other had laughed at all such silly stories, and to prove his
+bravery concluded to venture out there one night when the moon was as
+round as a cartwheel. He got close to the deserted workings when he
+too had a chill as he heard the most outlandish cry agoing, three
+times repeated, and----well, he grinned when he confessed that it
+took him just about one-fifth the time to get back home that he'd
+spent in the going."
+
+"Whee! perhaps there may be some sort of wild animal in one of the
+caves they tell about up there?" ventured Horatio. "I'm not a
+believer in ghosts, and I don't consider myself a coward, either; but
+all the same it'd have to be something pretty big to induce me to
+walk out there to that same lonely quarry after nightfall. Now laugh
+if you want to, K. K."
+
+"Well," interrupted Hugh, just then, "we're approaching the place
+right now where that old quarry road I spoke of starts in. I'd like
+ever so much to take a look at that same quarry, by daylight, mind
+you. Is there any objection, fellows, to our testing out that road
+right now? It used to be a pretty fair proposition I've been told,
+so far as a road goes, and I think we could navigate the same in this
+car. K. K. how do you stand on that proposition, for one?"
+
+"Count me in on anything that promises an adventure, Hugh," came the
+prompt reply. "There is plenty of gas in the tank, and if we do get
+a puncture on the sharp stones we've got an extra tube along, with
+lots and lots of muscle lying around loose for changing the same.
+That's my answer, Hugh."
+
+"Thad, how about you?" continued the shrewd Hugh, well knowing that
+by making an individual appeal he would be more apt to receive a
+favorable response, because it goes against the average boy's pride
+to be accounted a weakling, or one addicted to believing old wives'
+fairy stories of goblins, and all such trash.
+
+"Oh, count me in, Hugh," responded the other, with an indifference
+that may possibly have been partly assumed; but then Thad Stevens was
+always ready to back his enterprising chum, no matter what the other
+suggested.
+
+"Horatio, it's up to you now!" Hugh went on remorselessly, as K. K.
+stopped the car at a signal from the other, and faint signs of what
+had once been a road were to be distinguished just on the left.
+
+"Majority rules, you know," said the wise Juggins boy, "and already
+three have given their assent; so it's no back-out for little
+Horatio."
+
+"Course I'll agree, Hugh," quickly added Julius, when he saw that the
+other had turned toward him. "I'm just as curious as the next fellow
+to see that old haunted quarry--in the daytime, of course. Besides,
+everybody knows there isn't any such thing as a ghost. All such
+stories, when they're sifted down, turn out to be humbugs. Sometimes
+the moving spectre is a white donkey browsing alongside the road.
+Then again I've heard of how it was a swing that had a white pillow
+left in it by the children, and the night wind caused it to advance
+and retreat in a _terrible_ way. Hugh, let's investigate this silly
+old business while we're on the spot."
+
+And by these wonderfully brave words Julius hoped to dissipate any
+notion concerning his alleged timidity that may have lodged in the
+brains of his chums.
+
+So K. K. started up again, and by another minute the old car had
+passed in among the trees, with the overgrown brush "swiping" against
+the sides every foot of the way. It was necessary that they proceed
+slowly and cautiously, because none of them had ever been over that
+long disused road before, and all sorts of obstacles might confront
+the bold invaders of the wilds.
+
+Hugh was using his eyes to good advantage, and at his advice the
+others did the same. It was a good thing the car was old, and that
+it mattered nothing how those stiff branches scraped against the
+sides during their forward progress. K. K. knew how to manage, all
+right, and, although the trail was quite rough in places where the
+heavy rains had washed the earth away, and left huge stones
+projecting, he was able to navigate around these obstacles
+successfully.
+
+Twice they came to low places where water ran, and there was some
+danger of the heavy car becoming mired. At such times several of the
+boys would jump out, and after investigating the conditions perhaps
+throw a mass of stones and pieces of wood in, to make what Hugh
+called a sort of a "corduroy road" across the swampy section of
+ground.
+
+It was all very interesting in the bargain, and, for the time being,
+the boys even forgot the fact that they were exceedingly tired.
+
+Then they seemed to be gradually ascending a grade, where the road
+turned out to be somewhat better.
+
+"I imagine we're getting close to the quarry now, fellows," Hugh
+informed them; "if what I was told is true. It will lie over here on
+the right; and only for the dense growth of trees with their foliage
+still hanging on, we might see the cliff forming the background of
+the quarry right now."
+
+Julius and Horatio looked around them with increasing interest, and
+perhaps a slight flutter of unusual vigor in the region of their
+hearts. It was about as gloomy a scene as any of them had ever gazed
+upon. Years had elapsed since work in the stone quarry had been
+abandoned, and Nature, as usual, had done her best to hide the cruel
+gashes made in her breast by man; the trees had grown and spread,
+while bushes and weeds extended their sway so as to almost choke
+everything around. The distant cawing of the crows sounded more
+gruesome than ever amidst such surroundings; but there was no sign of
+bird-life to be seen. It was as though the little feathered
+creatures found this region too lonely even for their nest building.
+Not even a red or gray squirrel frisked around a tree, or boldly
+defied the intruders of his wilderness haunt.
+
+"There, I just had a glimpse of the place through an opening!"
+suddenly announced Hugh; "I calculate that we'll soon come in plain
+sight of the whole business, for this road leads straight across the
+dumps, I was told, and then on again in the direction of Hobson's
+Pond."
+
+The sun was passing behind the first cloud of the whole day just
+then. Somehow the added somber conditions had an effect on all the
+boys; for, with the temporary vanishing of the king of day, the
+shadows around them appeared to grow bolder, and issue forth from
+their secret retreats.
+
+"Ugh! this is certainly a fierce place for a fellow to visit, say
+around midnight," K. K. was forced to admit, for he was the essence
+of candor at all times.
+
+"Wild horses couldn't drag me up here at such a time as that," said
+Horatio, as he looked ahead, and shivered, either with the chill of
+the air, or from some other reason, he hardly knew himself.
+
+"Hugh, would you try it if someone dared you to?" demanded Julius
+suddenly, taking the bull by the horns, so to speak.
+
+"I don't think I would, on a dare," replied the other calmly, yet
+deliberately, as he smiled at the speaker; "but if there was any good
+and sufficient reason for my doing the same, I'd agree to come alone,
+and spend a whole night in the deserted quarry. However, I'm not
+particularly _hankering_ after the experience, so please don't try to
+hatch up any wild scheme looking to that end. If you want to come,
+Julius, you're welcome to the job."
+
+Julius shuddered, and looked a bit pale at the very thought.
+
+"Oh! I wasn't even dreaming of it, Hugh," he hastened to declare.
+"I'd much prefer to being asleep in my own comfy bed at home when
+midnight comes around, and the last thing on earth you'd catch me
+doing would be out hunting spooks."
+
+It was just as Julius finished saying this that they received a
+sudden shock. A loud and thrilling sound, not unlike a human shriek,
+came to their ears, filling each and every boy in the car with a
+sense of unmitigated horror. It was so exceedingly dreadful that K.
+K. involuntarily brought the auto to a full stop, and then turned a
+face filled with mingled curiosity and awe upon his comrades.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER III
+
+TALKING OF GHOSTS
+
+"That was no crow cawing, boys, believe me!" ejaculated K. K.
+
+"Crow! Well, I should say not!" added Horatio instantly. "If you
+asked me right to my face I'd mention a donkey braying. Gee! but it
+was fierce!"
+
+"But what would a donkey be doing away up here at the old quarry,
+where there hasn't been a stroke of work done these many years; tell
+me that?" demanded Julius defiantly.
+
+"I don't believe it was a donkey," said Hugh, shaking his head, as
+though he, too, found himself exceedingly puzzled; "but I'm not in a
+position to explain the thing. That was certainly a queer noise, for
+a fact."
+
+"Extraordinary!" assented Thad Stevens.
+
+"Well, I should call it perfectly awful!" Horatio clipped in.
+
+"Horrible would be a better word to describe it," eagerly followed
+Julius, who, it must be confessed, was trembling all over; of course,
+not with fear, or anything like that, but just because of excitement,
+he assured himself.
+
+"And," continued the sensible Hugh, "if that's the sort of noises
+these farmer folks have been hearing right along, I don't wonder some
+of them have been nearly scared out of their wits. It was bad enough
+in broad daylight, with the sun shining; so what must it have seemed
+like in the moonlight, or when it was pitch dark?"
+
+"Wow! excuse me from coming up here after dusk," muttered Julius.
+"I'm no ghost-hunter, let me tell you. I know my weak points, and
+seeing things in the night-time used to be one of the same. They had
+a great time breaking me of it, too. Even now I sometimes dream of
+queer things when I've got the nightmare, after eating too big a
+Thanksgiving dinner; and when I wake up suddenly I'm all in a sweat,
+and a poor old moth fluttering at the window will give me a start,
+thinking it's the tiger getting in my East Indian bungalow."
+
+"Well, what's the program, Hugh?" asked K. K. "Shall I start up
+again, so we can continue our journey along this tough old road; or
+do you want to get out, and take a hunt around the quarry for the
+thing that gave those yawps?"
+
+"Get out?" repeated Julius, in a sudden panic; "not for Joseph.
+Don't count on _me_ for any such silly business. I came up here to get
+walnuts and such; and I'm meaning to stick close to my engagement.
+Side issues can't tempt me to change my mind. Guess I know when I'm
+well off."
+
+"It's been several minutes since we heard that sound," Hugh went on
+to remark; "and, so far, it hasn't been repeated."
+
+"Oh! it came three times, you remember, Hugh," suggested K. K.; "and,
+like in baseball, I reckon it's three times and out. Whatever it was
+let out those screeches it's certainly quieted down. How about going
+on now, Hugh?"
+
+"If I was alone," mused the other, "I really believe I'd be half
+tempted to take a prowl around, and find out if I could what all the
+row meant. I never like to pass anything up, when my curiosity is
+excited."
+
+"Oh, come back again some other time, Hugh, when you're not booked
+for getting home!" sang out Horatio. "If you put it to a vote I
+don't believe anybody in this bunch would seem wild to back you up
+right now. Fact is, I can hear our supper-bell calling me ever so
+loud. Hey! boys, how about that?"
+
+"Let's get a move on!" Julius hastened to reply, so that there could
+be no mistaking his sentiments, at least.
+
+Julius was followed by K. K., although the latter shrugged his
+shoulders as he added:
+
+"Perhaps it looks timid in us doing what we mean to, but really this
+is none of our business, and we might get in some trouble bothering
+around here. I read about a house that was said to be haunted, which
+story a daring reporter said he'd investigate. He spent a night
+there, and actually captured the ghost, who turned out to be just an
+ordinary man, living on a place adjoining the haunted estate. He
+owned up to being the pallid specter that had been giving the house
+such a bad name; and said he wanted to buy the property in for a
+song, as it would find no other purchaser if it had such an evil
+reputation. Now, maybe somebody wants this quarry for thirty cents,
+and this is his way of scaring other would-be purchasers away. We
+don't want to butt in on any such game, you see."
+
+Hugh and the others laughed at such a clever explanation.
+
+"Whatever the truth may be," said Hugh, "I hardly believe it'll turn
+out anything like that, K. K. But you might as well start on. We're
+only losing time here, and it seems as though the _thing_ doesn't
+mean to give as another sample of that swan song."
+
+"For which, thanks!" sighed Julius. "I know music when I hear it,
+and if that's what they call a song of the dying swan excuse me from
+ever listening to another. I can beat that all hollow through a
+megaphone, and then not half try."
+
+So the chauffeur started up, and they were soon moving along the
+rough road that had once, no doubt, been kept in repair, when the
+heavy wagons carried out the building stone quarried from the
+hillside, but which was now in a pretty bad shape.
+
+Two minutes afterwards and the road took them directly alongside the
+quarry dump, where the excavated earth had been thrown. They could
+now see the cliff rising up alongside. It looked strangely bleak,
+for, of all things, there can hardly be a more desolate sight than an
+abandoned stone-quarry, where the weeds and thistles have grown up,
+and puddles of water abound.
+
+Of course, the boys all stared, as they slowly wound along the road
+in full view of the entire panorama that was being unrolled before
+their eyes. They noted how in places there seemed to be deep
+fissures along the abrupt face of the high cliff. These looked like
+caves, and some of them might be of considerable extent, judging from
+their appearance.
+
+"If this great old place chanced to be nearer town," said K. K.,
+managing to get a quick glimpse, although, as a rule, he needed all
+his attention riveted on the rough road he was trying to follow, "I
+reckon some of the fellows would have high times exploring those same
+holes in the hill."
+
+"It's just as well then it's as far distant as happens to be the
+case," Hugh told him; "because the doctors in Scranton would have
+broken arms and legs galore to practice on. That same old quarry
+would make a dangerous playground."
+
+"Oh!"
+
+That was Julius uttering a startled exclamation. He gripped Horatio
+so severely by the arm that he must have pinched the other. At any
+rate, Horatio gave a jump, and turned white; just as though his
+nerves had all been stretched to a high tension, so that anything
+startled him.
+
+"Hey! what did you do that for?" snapped Horatio, drawing away.
+"Think you're a ghost, Julius, and feel like biting, do you? Well,
+try somebody else's arm, if you please."
+
+"But didn't any of the rest of you see it?" gasped the said Julius,
+not deigning to quarrel over such a trivial thing as a pinch.
+
+"See what?" asked Steve, still staring hard at the quarry, which they
+were by now fairly well past.
+
+"Well, I don't know exactly what it was," frankly admitted the
+disturber of the peace. "But it moved, and beckoned to us to come on
+over. You needn't laugh, Steve Mullane, I tell you I saw it plainly
+right over yonder where that big clump of Canada thistles is growing.
+Course I'm not pretending to say it was a man, or yet a wolf, but it
+was something, and it sure did move!"
+
+Hugh was looking with more or less interest. He knew how things
+appear to an excited imagination, and that those who believe in
+uncanny objects seldom have any trouble about conjuring up specters
+to satisfy their own minds.
+
+So all of them, save, perhaps, the driver, kept their eyes focussed
+on the spot mentioned by Julius until the first clump of trees shut
+out their view of the old stone quarry and its gruesome surroundings.
+
+"I looked as hard as I could," said Horatio, "but never a thing did I
+see move. Guess you've got a return of your old malady, Julius, and
+you were seeing things by daylight, just as you say you used to in
+the dark."
+
+"The only explanation I can give," spoke up Hugh, and, of course,
+every one lent a willing ear, because, as a rule, his opinions
+carried much weight with his chums; "is that while Julius may have
+seen something move, it was only a long, feathery plume of grass,
+nodding and bowing in the wind. I've been fooled by the same sort of
+object many a time. But let it pass, boys. We've turned our back on
+the old quarry now, and are headed for the road again, two miles
+above Hobson's mill-pond. I only hope we find it better going on
+this end of the abandoned trail. This jumping is hard on the springs
+of the car, and also on our bones."
+
+"For one," said Julius, "I hope never to set eyes on the place again."
+
+"Oh! that's silly talk, Julius," commented K. K. "Here's Hugh, who
+means to take a run out this way again as soon as he can, so as to
+time himself, and learn just what he can save by cutting across
+country in the big race. And I wouldn't be surprised if he put
+'Just' Smith up to the dodge, in addition to Horatio here and myself,
+all being entered as contestants in the big Marathon race."
+
+"I certainly feel that way, K. K.," admitted Hugh firmly. "It
+strikes me this is going to be worth trying. If one of our crowd can
+save time by taking this route, while the other fellows go all the
+way around by road, that same thing may give Scranton High the
+clinching of the prize. It's all fair and square, too, for the
+conditions only demand that the runners refuse all sorts of lifts
+while on the road, and register at each and every tally place
+designated. If they can cut a corner they are at liberty to do so."
+
+"Oh! well," said Julius; "I'm not entered in the Marathon, luckily
+enough, so you see there's no need of my prowling around this spooky
+place again. I haven't lost any quarry, that I know of; and Scranton
+is a good enough place for me to do my athletic exercises in. But,
+Hugh, if you should happen to find out about the thing that emitted
+all those frightful squawks, I hope you'll promise to let us know the
+particulars."
+
+"I can promise that easily enough, Julius," the other told him;
+"though, just at present, my only concern is to gain time by this
+cut-off, and so win the big event for our school. Now suppose we
+drop this subject, and return to something pleasant."
+
+They continued to bump along the rocky road with its deep ruts. At
+times K. K. had to make little detours in order to navigate around
+some obstacle which could not be surmounted; for time had not dealt
+lightly with the quarry road, and the rains and wintry frosts had
+played havoc with its surface.
+
+But, eventually, they sighted light ahead. Steve was the first to
+glimpse an opening, and announce that the main highway leading down
+to Scranton must be close at hand. His words turned out to be true,
+and soon afterwards they issued forth from the covert and found
+themselves upon the turnpike, headed for home.
+
+Hugh turned around to mark the spot well in his mind, though he knew
+that it was to be the exit, and not the entrance, to the short-cut,
+in case he concluded to utilize the quarry road when the great race
+was on.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IV
+
+IN TRAINING FOR THE GREAT TOURNAMENT
+
+It was an afternoon on the following week, after school hours, and
+the athletic field bordering the outskirts of the town of Scranton
+afforded a pretty lively spectacle. Indeed, it could be readily seen
+that the approaching tournament had taken a great hold upon the young
+people of the town.
+
+Scores of boys were busily engaged in various exercises, under the
+watchful eye of Mr. Leonard, the assistant principal under Dr.
+Carmack. This determined-looking young fellow was a college
+graduate, and had taken considerable interest in all manner of
+athletics; indeed, it was well known that he had played on one or
+more of the college teams during his course, and won quite an
+enviable reputation for good work, though hardly reckoned a brilliant
+star.
+
+Many who did not expect to participate in any of the numerous events
+had gathered to watch what was going on; and, besides, there were
+clusters of pretty high-school girls on the side lines, chattering
+like magpies, and venting their opinions regarding the chances
+certain favorites among their boy friends appeared to have in the way
+of winning a prize.
+
+Scores were busily engaged in running around the cinder-path, taking
+the high jump, trying the hurdles, so as to perfect themselves
+against the coming Saturday when the wonderful event was to come off;
+sprinting for the short races of fifty, or a hundred yards; throwing
+the discus or the hammer, and numerous other lively doings.
+
+Among these participants there were a number whom the reader of
+previous volumes in this series will readily recognize, and possibly
+gladly meet again. There was Alan Tyree, for instance, whose
+masterly pitching had done so much to land the pennant of the Three
+Town High School League that season for Scranton; Owen Dugdale, the
+efficient shortstop of the local nine; "Just" Smith, whose real name
+it happened was Justin, but who seldom heard it outside of school and
+home. He was a fleet runner, and had ably filled the position of
+left fielder when Scranton carried the school colors to victory over
+Allandale in that last heart-breaking game. Besides these, Joe
+Danvers was on deck, doing all sorts of wonderful stunts at throwing
+the hammer and taking the long jump, for Joe delighted in a variety
+of specialties and did not confine himself to any one particular
+thing; also might be seen one Claude Hastings, a chap who was a
+regular monkey in his way, and who always kept the crowd laughing by
+his antics, such as might be expected of a prize clown at the big
+Barnum and Bailey circus.
+
+Yes, and there was Nick Lang, as big as life, running like the wind
+around the cinder-path and looking as though he might have a pretty
+fair chance to carry off some sort of prize. Nick had for a long
+time been the town bully. He was not a rich man's son; in fact,
+Nick's folks were poor, and some people even thought the big,
+overgrown boy should be at work helping to keep the wolf from the
+door, instead of still attending high school and making himself a
+nuisance to decent folks through his delight in practical jokes and
+his bullying propensities.
+
+But even those who detested Nick Lang the most were willing to admit
+that he was a pretty fair athlete and could even have excelled along
+several lines if only he were able to control that nasty temper of
+his and "play fair."
+
+There were two other fellows, who were cronies of Nick's, and who,
+apparently, had entered for some of the events, because both Leon
+Disney and Tip Slavin were in evidence and hard at work practicing.
+
+Nick secretly hated, even as he also feared, Mr. Leonard, because the
+under-teacher had once cowed him and made him "eat humble pie" before
+the whole class; but, being a wise as well as pugnacious boy, Nick
+managed to keep his feelings under control, and when Mr. Leonard was
+around he usually behaved himself.
+
+Later in the afternoon, when most of the boys out for practice had
+become more or less tired from their exertions, they gathered here
+and there in little bunches to exchange "chaff," and express their
+opinions concerning various matters that had a bearing on the coming
+tournament.
+
+So Hugh Morgan found himself in a cluster that contained several of
+his chums, as well as a sprinkling of other fellows. A trio of
+lively highschool girls hovered near, and occasionally joined in the
+conversation. They were Sue Barnes, whom Hugh usually counted on as
+his partner when any dance was given in the country, or at
+singing-school during the winter evenings; Ivy Middleton, Thad's
+choice for company, because she was both jolly and genial; and pretty
+Peggy Noland, whom Owen Dugdale liked, as had also Nick Lang, though
+the latter had of late been badly snubbed by the scornful Peggy
+because she could not stand for his rowdy ways.
+
+"Mr. Leonard says he's fully satisfied with the way most of the
+fellows are showing up," Joe Danvers was saying, about that time.
+
+"Well, we can't afford to loaf, for a fact," remarked Just Smith,
+soberly. "Let me tell you something, fellows. I was down in Paul
+Kramer's sporting emporium just last evening, when who should walk in
+but Big Ed. Patterson, the Allandale pitcher, who came so near to
+downing us last summer. He looks as fine as silk, and told me
+privately he calculates on carrying off that prize offered for hammer
+throwing, because that is his pet hobby, you see. Yes, and more than
+that, he said they were all crazy up at his 'burg' over the big meet,
+boys being out practicing every sort of stunt, even to road-running
+by moonlight."
+
+"That sounds good to me," Hugh observed, not appearing to show any
+sign of alarm over the stirring news. "It means we'll have a
+wonderfully successful affair. Who carries off the prizes is a
+matter for the different schools to take care of, and those of us who
+believe in clean, honest sport only hope the best fellows win."
+
+"Huh!" grunted Owen Dugdale, "it goes to show that Allandale is all
+worked up over losing the baseball pennant to Scranton, and means to
+get even by carrying off the majority of the prizes our committee has
+offered for the dozen or more events to be contested for."
+
+"But he also informed me," continued the bearer of news, "that over
+in Belleville they were just as much excited as in his town, so that
+every fellow who'd entered for any event, even to climbing the
+greased pole or the sack race, was diligently practicing his
+particular stunt. Oh! it's just going to be the greatest athletic
+tournament ever held in this section of the country, believe me."
+
+Some of the more timid among the boys seemed to think that Scranton
+would come out second-best when the great meet was a thing of the
+past; but others only found themselves more determined than ever to
+win, after learning how their rivals had entered into the affair with
+heart and soul.
+
+Hugh's often-expressed motto that the "best man should win" found an
+echo in the majority of their hearts, and they vied with each other
+in promising to give every ounce of ability to doing Scranton High
+credit.
+
+Mr. Leonard came around to have a few words with his boys. He was a
+great favorite with the majority of the scholars under his charge,
+and to his clever method of coaching they attributed considerable of
+their success on the diamond of recent months. If only his rules
+were strictly adhered to it was possible that Allandale and
+Belleville might be due for another rude surprise when they came
+over, bent on carrying off the majority of the high honors.
+
+"It is going to be no easy sledding for anybody,--remember that,
+fellows," the athletic instructor went on to say, after he had been
+told how both adjoining towns entered in the meet were striving with
+might and main to excel in every sort of event. "No matter who wins
+he'll only get there by doing his level best. That's all Scranton
+High asks of her representatives. Let there be no loafing, and if
+some of our good friends from A and B succeed in carrying away a few
+of the prizes, why, we'll know they earned the right, and are welcome
+to their reward. And now, I'd like to see you runners try one more
+ten-minute sprint, every one of you in a bunch, as a sort of wind-up
+for the day."
+
+Accordingly they ran off to the starting-point and lined up, each
+assuming his particular favorite crouching attitude, which he seemed
+to think best fitted for a speedy "get-away" when the signal was
+given.
+
+They ran like colts, and some displayed amazing speed, considering
+that they had been diligently working out on that same cinder-path
+for over two hours, with little intermissions between for resting.
+
+Those who expected to take part in the Marathon did not attempt to
+compete with those fleet sprinters, though if they were pressed
+doubtless they too could give quite an exhibition of fast running.
+
+But Mr. Leonard had taken great pains to inform them that the
+successful long-distance runners always take things moderately easy
+in the beginning of a race, preserving as much vigor as possible for
+the gruelling finish. The chief idea was to keep just behind the
+pace-maker, and be ready to rush to the front when on the
+home-stretch. The fellow best able to preserve his full powers for
+that last half-mile dash would be the one to carry off the honors.
+
+Nick Lang was there with the rest, watching Hugh out of the tail of
+his eye, as if he considered that in the other he would find his
+chief competitor; possibly he hoped to be able to pick up valuable
+points by keeping watch and ward on Hugh. Hugh had even consulted
+Mr. Leonard with regard to making use of his knowledge concerning
+that "cut-off." In fact, he wanted to lay any doubts that may have
+arisen in his own mind concerning its being perfectly legitimate that
+he should profit by such knowledge.
+
+The athletic instructor assured him he was keeping fully within the
+conditions of the race in so doing.
+
+"It is any competitor's privilege to go over the route as often as he
+pleases," was the way Mr. Leonard put it; "and so long as he conforms
+to the rules, such as keeping on his own feet every yard of the way,
+accepting no lift from wagon or car, and registering faithfully at
+the several stations provided, he has done all that is expected of
+him. If by crossing a field he thinks he can cut off fifty feet or
+more he is at liberty to make the attempt, although it may cost him
+dear, through his meeting with some unexpected obstacle in his
+progress, which would not have occurred had he stayed by the road.
+Some fellows might believe they could do better than trying to cross
+by way of that overgrown quarry road. Yes, you are keeping well
+within the letter of the law in choosing your own way of going, Hugh.
+Have no fears on that score, my boy."
+
+Mr. Leonard liked Hugh Morgan exceedingly; though that was not to be
+wondered at, because Hugh was one of those boys who would never stoop
+to do a tricky thing, no matter what allurements it held out; he
+always "played square," and even won the high regard of his rivals in
+many cases.
+
+When the October sun had reached the horizon the multitude of
+contestants and spectators commenced to string back to town, for it
+would soon be getting near supper time; and no fellow likes to be
+late at the table, especially when he feels as hungry as a bear,
+after exercising so violently for hours.
+
+Hugh was starting off alone, when Thad Stevens called out that he'd
+like the other to "hold up a minute," until he could overtake him;
+because it happened he had something to communicate which he thought
+Hugh ought to know.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER V
+
+TREACHERY IN THE AIR
+
+"Hugh, it looks to me like there's a hen on," was what Thad Stevens
+said, as he joined his chum.
+
+"That's a queer remark for you to make, Thad," the other chuckled;
+"after seeing what's been happening here on our athletic field this
+afternoon, I'd be likely to say there were a good many score of hens
+setting, each hoping to hatch out one of our dandy prizes next
+Saturday."
+
+"Oh! you understand that I mean something crooked going on, Hugh,"
+Thad hastened to add.
+
+"That sounds serious enough. What do you know, Thad? The chances
+are ten to one if anything in the way of trickery is contemplated I
+can put my hand on the fellow who's guilty of the same."
+
+"Sure thing, Hugh, and his name is Nicholas in the bargain. They
+call him Young Nick, to distinguish him from his father who's dead
+and gone; but sometimes people say he's a regular Old Nick when it
+comes to playing mean jokes, and getting into trouble of all kinds."
+
+"What's Nick Lang been up to now, Thad?"
+
+"Oh! just spying on you, for one thing!" exclaimed the other angrily.
+
+"He's welcome to chase around after me as often as he pleases," said
+Hugh; "much good will it do him, I'm thinking. But tell me, why
+should he go to all that bother, when my going-out and coming-in
+don't interfere with his happiness a whit?"
+
+"Hugh, Nick is on to your scheme for making use of that short-cut
+across by way of the old deserted quarry!"
+
+"You don't tell me?" Hugh observed. "Well, I came near speaking to
+him about it myself, Thad. You see, Nick is entered for the
+Marathon, just the same as a number of other Scranton High boys are.
+If K. K., Just Smith, and several other fellows are to have the
+benefit of that cut-off, if they choose to avail themselves of it,
+why shouldn't Nick be included, I've been asking myself? Yes, and
+I'd about concluded it was my duty to let him know; but if, as you
+say, he's found out for himself I'll be saved all the bother of
+telling."
+
+"He followed you across yesterday, Hugh. By a mere accident I heard
+him telling Tip Slavin, and he seemed to think it a good joke,
+because you never once suspected he was spying on you from behind
+trees and bushes. Why, he says he followed you clear across to the
+road again."
+
+Hugh shrugged his shoulders.
+
+"Then I give Nick full credit for carrying out a clever piece of
+business. I never once remember suspecting that anybody was around.
+But, Thad, what's worrying you? There isn't anything about that
+discovery to excite you."
+
+"Hugh, that boy means to do something mean, and it's got a connection
+with the short-cut quarry road in the bargain!"
+
+Hugh turned and looked at the speaker a little gravely.
+
+"I suppose now you've got some good reason for making that
+accusation, Thad?" he ventured.
+
+"Yes, I have," came the quick reply. "I heard him say something to
+that other sneak which I couldn't just catch, but it started Tip
+laughing like everything. He slapped a hand down on his knee, and
+went on to say: 'Fine, Nick, finer than silk! I bet you he'll be as
+mad as hops if he finds himself caught in such a trap, and loses the
+race. You can depend on me every time. My affair comes off right in
+the start, and I can easy get out there on my wheel long before the
+first runner heaves in sight. I'll coach Pete Dudley in his part,
+just as you were saying. It's the greatest trick you ever hatched
+up, Nick, the very greatest!' Now, you can judge for yourself, Hugh,
+whether it's safe for you to try to cross by that same quarry road
+when the big Marathon race is on."
+
+Hugh seemed lost in thought for a brief interval. When he spoke
+again there was a settled look of grim determination on his face that
+Thad could easily understand, knowing the other as well as he did.
+
+"It isn't my way to show the white feather when the first cold wind
+starts to blowing, Thad, and no matter what Nick is planning to do
+I'm not going to give him the first chance to profit by my discovery
+of that short-cut route from road to road."
+
+"That means you decline to be shoved off the path, does it, Hugh?"
+
+"If I start in that race, as I expect to," Hugh told him, "I intend
+to make use of that short-cut, no matter if a dozen Tip Slavins, and
+Pete Dudleys are lying in wait to trip me up. But I'm much obliged
+to you all the same, Thad, for your warning. I'll be on my guard
+from this time on, and they're not going to trap me with my eyes
+blinded, I tell you that."
+
+Thad seemed to be lost in thought himself for a minute or so.
+Possibly he was trying to figure out how he could best serve his
+comrade in such an emergency. The gloomy woods surrounding the old
+quarry did not possess any attraction in the eyes of Thad Stevens.
+Though he had not shown the same degree of alarm as Horatio and
+Julius at the time they heard those remarkable sounds, so like human
+shrieks, nevertheless, Thad felt no hankering after another similar
+experience.
+
+Still he would brave much in order to help the chum whose interests
+were so dear to his own heart. He did not say what was in his mind,
+only looked a bit wise, as he once more turned to Hugh, as though his
+mind had been finally made up.
+
+"Just as you think best, Hugh," he went on to say quietly. "It may
+be that one or more of the other fellows will be taking advantage of
+that same old road, and there's safety in numbers, you know, they say.
+Nick is likely to get his fingers burned if he attempts any of his
+silly tricks. What do you suppose now he could plan to have those
+chaps do? They wouldn't want to really hurt you, because that might
+get them in bad with Captain Wambold, our police head. Can you think
+of any fool play he'd be apt to conjure up, such as might make Tip
+say it was the best and slickest scheme he'd ever heard about?"
+
+"Nick has so many wild ideas that he's likely to attempt nearly
+anything," said Hugh. "If he could find a good place where a runner
+would have to keep to the road I even believe he'd try to dig a deep
+pit, and cover the same over, just as the wild-animal catchers do in
+Africa, when they go out after big game for the menageries and zoos."
+
+"Why, would that work, do you think, Hugh?" cried the startled Thad,
+mentally picturing his chum crashing through a false roadbed, and
+dropping down into a deep hole from which, alone and unaided, he
+could not hope to escape until much time had elapsed, and all hope of
+winning the big Marathon was lost.
+
+"It might have done so if I hadn't chanced to possess a wide-awake
+chum, who gave me due warning, and caused me to keep a sharp lookout.
+As it is, if I glimpse a suspicious spot in my path I'll fight mighty
+shy of the same; or by a big leap give it the go-by. Of course,
+there might be other ways in which they could hope to detain me, such
+as dropping down on my shoulders from a tree, and with their faces
+covered so I couldn't recognize them."
+
+Thad looked grave.
+
+"Yes, they could do that, for a fact," he admitted. "Seems to me
+you'll have to keep one eye aloft all the while, Hugh, while the
+other is watching the ground for treachery. I must say this is a
+fine state of affairs. Not only does Scranton High have to go smack
+up against all the best runners of Allandale and Belleville, but be
+on the lookout for treachery at home besides. I'd give something to
+be one of a bunch of indignant fellows to take Nick Lang and his two
+pals out to the woods some fine night, and give the same a coat of
+tar and feathers, or else ride them on a rail. They're a disgrace to
+the community, and Scranton ought to take them in hand right away.
+That boy will set the town on fire yet I'm thinking, with his
+desperate tricks."
+
+"He will, unless he soon sees a light, and turns over a new leaf,"
+admitted Hugh, who, it seems, had an idea of his own in connection
+with the said Nick, which, perhaps, he might find an opportunity to
+work out one of these days; but which he did not care to confide to
+his chum, because he knew Thad would be apt to consider it
+impossible, perhaps foolish.
+
+"There they go now, Hugh," suddenly remarked Thad in an undertone.
+"You see, he has both Tip and Leon along with him, and they're
+grinning as they look over this way. I warrant you Nick has been
+elaborating on that fine scheme of his; and, in anticipation, they
+can already see you held up in that lonely place, kicking your toes
+at the bottom of a miserable pit, or else tied to a tree."
+
+"Don't scowl so savagely, Thad," warned Hugh. "There's no need of
+letting them understand we're on to their game. The advantage always
+lies in catching the other fellow off his guard. Let's laugh while
+we walk past, as if we'd been figuring out how a certain prize was
+already dangling close to our fingertips."
+
+So Thad managed to "take a brace," profiting by the sage advice of
+his comrade; and, as they passed Nick and his two cronies, Hugh
+remarked as pleasantly as he could:
+
+"I've been watching you run to-day, Nick, and I honestly believe you
+are right up with the top-notchers in the game. There may be some
+surprises next Saturday for those who think they've got it all
+figured out who's going to win the prizes. And Nick, as far as I'm
+concerned, I'd like to see you take the long-distance prize, honestly
+and cleanly, if I can't get it myself. You're a representative of
+Scranton High, Nick, and we're all out to see the old school do
+herself proud."
+
+Nick seemed taken aback by these hearty words on the part of the
+fellow whom he had so long sought an opportunity to injure. He shot
+a hasty glance, accompanied by the uplifting of his heavy eyebrows,
+toward his companions, who, thereupon, catching a sly wink, perhaps,
+both chuckled audibly as though amused.
+
+"Oh! I've already as good as copped that Marathon prize," Nick went
+on to say, at the same time thrusting out his chin in his customary
+aggressive and boastful fashion. "I calculate to give the folks some
+surprise by the ease with which I'll come in away ahead of the next
+competitor. There'll be a wheen of those who also ran, bringing up
+the tail of the procession. Long-distance is my best suit, and I've
+waited a while to show up certain chaps in this town who think they
+are just the thing. Don't worry about me, Morgan; Nick Lang
+generally gets there when he throws his hat into the ring."
+
+At that the other two laughed uproariously, as though they thought
+the joke too good for anything. Possibly they took Nick's reference
+to "those who also ran" to mean Hugh Morgan particularly; and in
+their minds they could see him desperately trying to break his bonds;
+or climb up out of the deep pit into which he had gone crashing when
+the covered mattress, formed of slender twigs and dead leaves, had
+given way under his weight.
+
+Hugh and Thad walked on, the latter fairly boiling with
+illy-suppressed anger.
+
+"That fellow always gives me a pain, Hugh," he was saying, as they
+increased the distance separating them from the still merry trio in
+the rear. "He is really the meanest boy you could find in all the
+towns of this country. But fellows like him sometimes catch a
+Tartar; so, perhaps, it might happen in this case," and Thad, who
+evidently had something on his mind, would not commit himself
+further, as they walked on in company.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VI
+
+THE PROWLER
+
+There had been considerable of a change in connection with the big
+open field where the boys of Scranton were allowed by the town
+council and mayor to play baseball, and also football, since summer
+waned. Somehow the success that attended the work of Scranton High
+in the battles of the Three Town League, as narrated in an earlier
+volume of this series, seemed to have stirred up many of the leading
+citizens. Besides, Mr. Leonard, the efficient under-principal of the
+high school, with a genuine love and sympathy for all boys in his
+heart, had kept things at boiling pitch.
+
+Consequently there was, first of all, a move made to lease that
+splendid field for a long term of years, from the owner, so that the
+young people of Scranton might have some central place to gather for
+all sorts of outdoor games and sports.
+
+So subscriptions were started looking to collect a fund with which
+not only to erect some sort of decent grandstand, but a building that
+would contain a number of conveniences such as most athletic grounds
+and similar institutions can boast.
+
+This building had now been completed, and the boys were in full
+possession. It contained, among other things, a score and more of
+lockers, where the one who paid a small fee could keep his "fighting
+togs," as Thad Stevens was wont to term his baseball clothes, or it
+might be the scanty raiment he wore when exercising on the athletic
+field, running, or boxing, or wrestling.
+
+Each boy who hired such a locker, of course, carried the key to the
+same; and when engaged in practice work rested easy in the belief
+that his street garments were securely taken care of.
+
+There was also a shower-bath and a pool in the building, as well as
+several other conveniences that could be used in the summer time
+during the hot weather. The boys arranged to take turns in shifts
+with regard to keeping the building clean, and thus far the scheme
+had worked very well; for the town did not care to go to the extra
+expense of hiring a custodian.
+
+Besides this, a high fence was ordered to be built around the entire
+grounds, for most other towns had their athletic fields enclosed. It
+would keep the rowdy element from disturbing the players when any
+game was in progress; and, as a small admission fee might often be
+asked, having one or two gates through which admission to the grounds
+could be obtained would facilitate matters greatly.
+
+But this was not all. Scranton had awakened to the fact that Nature
+had been rather unkind to her young people, in that there was no
+large lake, or even so much as a small river close by her borders.
+When the boys and girls of the town felt inclined to skate after a
+sharp freeze along about New Year's Day, they had to walk all the way
+out to Hobson's mill-pond, situated between half and two-thirds of a
+mile away. This was not so bad for some of the sturdy chaps, but
+there were others who disliked taking such long tramps, especially
+after violent exercising for hours, it might be, on the ice.
+
+So, after mature deliberation, and receiving valuable suggestions
+from Mr. Leonard, as well as others who had seen similar things
+successfully carried out in various places, it had been arranged to
+flood the field after winter had fully set in. Then, during the time
+of severe weather, the young folks would have a splendid sheet of ice
+right at their doors, a comfortable retreat into which they could go
+to warm up, or to put on and remove their skates.
+
+Here various games were expected to be indulged in, as the weather
+permitted; and already a fine hockey Seven had been organized, under
+the leadership of Hugh Morgan, with a promise of many exciting games
+against rival teams.
+
+The high board fence was being erected, but would hardly be completed
+before Spring; still, it gave an air of business to the grounds, and
+the boys had already begun to congratulate themselves over the great
+stride forward Scranton had taken in the way of catering to her
+rising population.
+
+Of course, there were those in the town--you can always find a few in
+every community--who seriously objected to so much "good money being
+wasted," as they termed it, on such trivial things, when Scranton
+really needed an up-to-date library building in place of the poor
+apology for one that had to serve.
+
+These people, doubtless from worthy motives, though they were
+short-sighted in their opposition, lost no opportunity for running
+down the entire enterprise. The person who, perhaps, had more
+influence than any of the others, and was more vehement in deriding
+the "foolish expenditure of funds along such silly lines, instead of
+trying to elevate the standard of reading among Scranton's young
+people," was the rich widow, Mrs. Jardine.
+
+She had a son named Claude, whose life was rendered miserable by the
+lofty ambition of his mother to make him a genius. She never ceased
+talking upon all sorts of elevating subjects; and where other boys
+were allowed to lead normal lives, and have lots of innocent if
+strenuous fun during vacations, and holidays, poor Claude led a life
+of bondage.
+
+He was rather an effeminate-looking boy, tall and slender, with a
+face entirely destitute of color such as would indicate abounding
+spirits and good health; but it was no wonder, everyone knew how he
+was being made such a "sissy" of by his doting "mamma."
+
+Despite all this there seemed to be a spark of ordinary boyish
+spirits concealed under Claude's superior airs. He sometimes stood
+and watched the other fellows engaged in playing prisoner's base, or
+some such rough-and-tumble game, with envy. Once upon a time his
+mother, chancing to pass along the street in her fine car, was
+horrified to discover her darling Claude actually taking part in some
+"rowdy game," in which he scrambled with the rest just as vehemently,
+and was, moreover, even worse off than the other boys with regard to
+soiled garments and disheveled hair. Evidently the long suppressed
+spirit of the lad had broken bounds, and for once he allowed himself
+to be natural.
+
+The other fellows never tired of telling how she had called to him
+almost frantically, as though she believed he had become inoculated
+with some deadly germ, and must be contaminated, bundling the boy
+into the car, and actually crying with dismay when she found that he
+actually had a scratch upon his nose, which had been bleeding. But
+it was also noticed that Claude grinned at his late fellow wrestlers
+as he was borne triumphantly away, as though to emphasize the fact
+that he had, at least, enjoyed one real period of excitement in his
+life, to remain as a bright spot for many days.
+
+Hugh had often wondered whether there might not be some way through
+which this deluded mother might be shown what a terrible error she
+was making in bringing up her boy to be so inane and useless. He
+needed physical development more than any other fellow in Scranton
+High. Constant feeding upon lofty ideas, and never given a chance to
+develop his muscles, was wrecking his health. Mr. Leonard had even
+gone to Mrs. Jardine and entreated her to let him undertake a
+moderate programme of athletic exercises with Claude; but he might as
+well have tried to lift the high-school building as to make her
+change her set ideas.
+
+Hugh and Thad had been out on a particular night after supper,
+visiting another boy who chanced to live on the outskirts of town.
+He had received a wonderful collection of curios from an uncle living
+out in India, after whom he had been named; and upon being especially
+invited over to view these things, which included a wonderful
+assortment of rare postage stamps, the two chums had made it a point
+to accept, being greatly interested in all boyish "hobbies."
+
+That was how they happened to be passing along the road close to the
+athletic grounds about half-past nine o'clock that same night.
+
+There was a fair moon shining, but objects appeared more or less
+misty, as often occurs under such conditions. The boys had about
+exhausted their vocabulary of words that express delight, in
+examining the many things of interest shown by "Limpy" Wallace, who
+was a cripple, and had to use a crutch, he being also a great admirer
+of Hugh Morgan, whom he considered in the light of a hero.
+
+Besides this, both boys were unusually tired after the exertions of
+the day, and Thad frequently yawned in a most terrific fashion, as he
+walked homeward. Probably these were the main reasons for their
+unnatural silence, as they stalked along side by side; since it is
+seldom that two lads will refrain from exchanging opinions on some
+subject or other, when in company.
+
+Afterwards, in the light of what happened, they were inclined to
+believe that it was exceedingly fortunate they had lapsed into this
+queer condition of silence, for, otherwise, they would have missed
+something that proved unusually interesting, as well as afforded them
+more or less excitement.
+
+It was Thad who discovered it first. Perhaps he chanced to be
+looking that way while Hugh was star-gazing. At any rate he gripped
+his chum suddenly by the arm.
+
+"Sh! Hugh, what's that yonder, a skulking dog, or a fellow half bent
+over?" was what Thad whispered in the ear of his chum.
+
+Both of them had come to a full stop, under the impulse of the
+moment; and Thad was pointing a little to the right, which was where
+the building erected on the athletic grounds stood, dimly seen in the
+mysterious moonlight.
+
+So Hugh, staring quickly, made out the object indicated by his
+companion. Really, he could hardly blame Thad for asking such a
+question, because at first it was next to impossible to determine
+whether it was a four-footed creature, or a human being who, for some
+good reason, was trying to make himself appear as small as possible.
+
+But as Hugh continued to look he saw the other raise himself to his
+full height, as though to take a cautious survey of his surroundings.
+Then he knew that it was no canine prowling around to discover scraps
+thrown aside by the carpenters working on the board fence, as they
+ate their noon lunch.
+
+"It's a human being all right, Thad," Hugh whispered, in such a low
+tone that even the sharpest pair of ears going could never have
+caught the sound ten feet away.
+
+"Man, or boy, Hugh?" asked Thad, copying the example set by the
+other, and even bending his head so that his lips might come closer
+to Hugh's right ear.
+
+"Can't make that out," he was told.
+
+"But what in the wide world is he trying to do?" pursued Thad, his
+curiosity now fully aroused, as the unknown again started to move
+forward, pursuing the same strange cautious tactics as before.
+
+"That's what we ought to find out," Hugh told him. "I don't like the
+way he's sneaking around here. It looks as if he might be up to some
+game."
+
+"Oh! perhaps it's a tramp," suggested Thad, as the idea dawned upon
+his brain.
+
+"He may be meaning to break into the building, to sleep there
+to-night. I wouldn't put it past a hobo to steal anything he could
+find left in the lockers. Hugh, it's up to us to put a kink in his
+rope. Let's chase after him before he disappears."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VII
+
+CAUGHT IN THE ACT
+
+"Hold on, Thad," continued Hugh, as he put a restraining hand on the
+shoulder of his more impulsive chum, "we've got to be careful, or
+else he'll learn how we're meaning to spy on him. Bend over, and do
+the grand sneak act."
+
+"He's headed straight for the building, Hugh!" breathed the other, as
+he complied with the directions given by the one whom he was
+accustomed to look upon in the light of a leader.
+
+"That's right, and I guess he's meaning to crawl inside, if only he
+can find a window that's been left unfastened. Steady now, Thad;
+he's stopped under one right now!"
+
+They continued to crouch there and watch what went on, their eyes
+glued upon the dimly seen figure of the unknown. Greatly to the
+surprise of Thad, the party stepped to one side, and seemed to be
+dragging back a heavy plank, not of any vast length, but sufficiently
+long to reach the window when placed on a slant.
+
+"Say, did you notice how he seemed to know just where that plank was
+lying, Hugh?" asked Thad deliriously. "Seems like he must have been
+spying out the land by daylight beforehand."
+
+"You're right there," whispered Hugh; "and he acts as if he felt
+pretty certain that particular window would be unfastened, in the
+bargain."
+
+"Hugh, that settles it," added the other sturdily, as though now
+fully convinced.
+
+"Yes, settles what, Thad?"
+
+"Why, it's a _boy_, don't you see, and he must have left that
+window unlatched on purpose this afternoon when some of the
+fellows were shutting up."
+
+"Wait and see," advised Hugh, although almost convinced of the same
+thing himself.
+
+The test was not long in coming. They could see the other "shinning"
+up the sloping plank, as any athletic boy would be apt to do, without
+any particular trouble. Now he had reached the window, and Thad held
+his breath in suspense. He sighed as he heard a slight squeaking
+sound. Evidently the sash which was supposed to be fastened every
+night through ordinary prudence, had given way to his hand, when he
+exerted some pressure.
+
+"He's going in, Hugh!" Thad observed, again laying a quivering hand
+on the arm of his comrade, and then following these words with a low
+exclamation of startled wonder: "Oh! look there, what's that queer
+glow mean?"
+
+Hugh understood readily enough.
+
+"Why, he's got one of those little handy electric torches, you see,
+and is using it so as to get his bearings inside the building."
+
+"Guess you're right, Hugh," admitted the other; "and there, he's
+crawling over the sill now, as sure as anything. Oh! the skunk, what
+can he be up to?"
+
+"We'll try and find out," said Hugh, with his usual promptness. "Now
+he's gone further from the window let's be moving along. That plank
+ought to make it easy sledding for fellows like us."
+
+Indeed, it would be hard to find a couple of more athletic boys than
+Hugh and his chum. Their intense love for every type of outdoor
+sport had kept them in splendid physical condition, so that their
+muscles were as firm as those of an athlete in training. To make
+their way up that sloping board and reaching the open window was
+likely to prove a mere bit of child's play with such fellows.
+
+Hugh was the first to ascend. When he had raised himself so that he
+could peep over the window ledge and see within the building he
+apparently found the coast clear; for Thad, coming along just behind,
+received a gentle prod with a toe, twice repeated, which he knew to
+be a signal that all was well.
+
+By the time Thad arrived the other was already well within the room,
+having slipped across the window-sill without making the slightest
+sound. All was dark around them, but further on they could see that
+weird shaft of light moving this way and that, indicating the spot
+where the unknown intruder just then happened to be located.
+
+"He's making for the locker room, don't you see, Hugh?" Thad
+ventured, with a perceptible quiver to his low voice.
+
+"Sure thing, and he knows where he's going, in the bargain," the
+other went on.
+
+"Of course, it's no hobo, then," continued Thad. "That scamp knows
+every foot of ground under this roof. You can see it by the way he
+keeps straight on. Hugh, do you think it might be Nick Lang?"
+
+After all, it was only natural for Thad to jump to this conclusion,
+because of the evil reputation enjoyed by the boy he mentioned. Nick
+Lang had been the bully and the terror of Scranton for years. There
+was seldom a prank played (from stealing fruit from neighboring
+farmers, to painting old Dobbin, a stray nag accustomed to feeding on
+the open lots, so that the ordinarily white horse resembled the
+National flag, and created no end of astonishment as he stalked
+around, prancing at a lively rate when the hot sun began to start the
+turpentine to burning), but that everybody at once suspected Nick of
+being the conspirator.
+
+Possibly he may not have always been the chief offender; but give Dog
+Tray a bad name and he gets the blame of everything that happens
+calculated to outrage the respectability of the law-abiding community.
+
+"I thought of him at first," replied Hugh, "but it strikes me that
+chap isn't of Nick's build. You see his light leaves his figure
+pretty much in the dark; for he's using it principally to show him
+the way, so he won't stumble over any chair, and make no end of a
+row."
+
+The two had been stealthily creeping forward all this while, and
+were, therefore, gradually diminishing the distance separating them
+from the bearer of the electric hand-torch. Thad had evidently been
+consulting his memory concerning something, for presently he again
+whispered in his chum's ear:
+
+"Then mebbe it might be Leon Disney, Hugh. Seems to me that sneak
+would be just the one to try some mean trick like this. And,
+besides, I happen to know he bought one of those little vest-pocket
+lights down at Paul Kramer's store only three nights ago, because I
+saw him testing them and heard him say he'd take it."
+
+"Yes, that looks significant, I must say, Thad. But I'm trying to
+make out what he's done with his head. Don't you notice he's got it
+bundled up with a sort of woollen comforter or something like that?"
+
+"Why, so he has," replied the other; "I tell you what, Hugh, he's
+hoping to hide his face, so if he's discovered prowling around in
+here no one can say positively that they recognized him. Leon is up
+to all those sly tricks. He gets ideas like that out of the stories
+he's so fond of soaking in."
+
+"Keep still now, Thad, and we'll creep closer," warned the other.
+
+They really had their hands full endeavoring to advance upon the
+prowler without making any sort of sound that would arouse his
+suspicions. Hugh realized that if anything of this sort occurred the
+other would instantly throw the full glow of his little electric
+torch in their direction, and, of course, immediately discover their
+presence. If such a thing happened it might interfere with their
+suddenly arranged plan of campaign, and prevent the capture they
+contemplated, which would be a grievous disappointment to both boys.
+
+The unknown party had come to a standstill. He stood there in front
+of the long row of new lockers in which the boys who meant to take
+part in the principal events of the great athletic tournament kept
+their possessions, without which they would be more or less
+handicapped in their practice work.
+
+Thad had made another important discovery; indeed, it struck him as
+so significant that he could not forbear dragging Hugh down so that
+he could place his lips against the other's ear and whisper:
+
+"It's _your_ locker he's trying to open, Hugh, don't you see?"
+
+Hugh, of course, had already noted this circumstance, and felt duly
+thrilled, for really it struck him as something more than an
+accident, and along the lines of a deep design. Doubtless, his
+active brain started to wrestle with the problem as to why any one
+should wish to open his locker, since the only things he kept there
+consisted of his running jersey and trunks and shoes.
+
+Could it be possible that this was only some small piece of
+spite-work engineered by his old and inveterate enemy, Nick Lang, and
+ordered carried out by one of the bully's cronies; while Nick himself
+made certain to be in good company, so he could easily prove an alibi
+if accused of the mean trick.
+
+It seemed almost too contemptible to be true, since Hugh could easily
+purchase other garments down at the sporting-goods store in Scranton.
+Still, some mean natures are small enough to love to give "stabs"
+that might annoy the recipient; and boys sometimes grow so accustomed
+to certain articles of wearing apparel that being compelled to "break
+in" a new pair of running shoes might lose Hugh the great race!
+
+He gritted his teeth as a wave of indignation swept over him. Really
+it was high time this contemptible spirit of annoying those he chose
+to look upon in the light of enemies was crushed in Nick Lang. He
+had carried on with a "high horse" too long already, and, for one,
+Hugh felt as though combined action should be taken against him by
+the respectable fellows of Scranton High.
+
+But it was far from Hugh's intention to stand there and see his
+locker robbed by such an unprincipled fellow as Leon Disney, if,
+indeed, the skulker proved to be the party they suspected. Possibly
+Hugh moved too soon, for it would have been much wiser had he waited
+until the sneak thief actually had the locker open, and disclosed his
+full intention.
+
+Urged on to action by his indignation, Hugh started forward. Thad,
+realizing that it was his chum's intention to do something radical,
+skipped off a little to the right. He fancied that should the
+skulker take the alarm and try to flee, making for the open window in
+the rear, he was apt to turn aside and try to pass by; so his move
+was intended to block this little game.
+
+It turned out to be needless, for so interested was the fellow with
+the flash-light in his work of inserting a key in the lock, and
+trying to turn it, that he did not appear to notice anything wrong
+until Hugh was close at his elbow. Then, as Thad slipped around to
+one side to cover all lines of retreat, Hugh reached out a hand and
+caught hold of the fellow by the shoulder. At the same time he
+exclaimed in a severe voice:
+
+"Well, what are you doing here, I want to know, trying to break into
+my locker?"
+
+The other gave a tremendous start, and a low, bubbling cry, half of
+fright, and also of disgust, came from his lips. The woollen muffler
+fell from about his face, and, although he snapped off the light just
+then by a movement of his thumb, the others had glimpsed his features.
+
+Thad had evidently hit the target in the bull's-eye when he mentioned
+his suspicions concerning the probable identity of the skulker. It
+was Leon Disney!
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VIII
+
+LEON PROMISES TO REFORM
+
+The startled boy struggled to get free, but Hugh had taken a firmer
+grip upon his person, and saw to it that he could not squirm loose.
+
+"Quit your kicking!" cried Thad, indignantly, when one of the
+fellow's shoes came in rough contact with his own shins; "or we'll
+start something along the same lines! We know you, Leon Disney, so
+there's no use trying to hide your face."
+
+Leaning over, Thad groped around until he managed to find the hand
+that held the little electric torch. This latter article he tore
+from the grasp of Leon, and immediately pressed the button that
+caused the battery to work. The intense darkness around them was
+dissipated to some degree. Thad threw the glow directly into the
+face of the fellow Hugh was holding.
+
+Leon stopped his desperate struggles. He realized that the game was
+up so far as trying to keep his identity a secret; and, being a most
+resourceful sort of chap, he now resorted to another little scheme
+which he had undoubtedly thought out, to be used in case he was
+discovered, and cornered, while on his night mission.
+
+"Oh! is that you, Hugh?" he burst out, in a shaky voice. "Say, you
+gave me an _aw_ful scare! I thought it must be some old tramp that
+grabbed me, sure I did. It's all right now, Hugh, and I'm not
+wanting to clear out, since I know who you are. That's Thad, too, I
+reckon, holding my little flash-light. How you did startle me,
+though. I never dreamed anybody was around here when I started to
+come back after my watch."
+
+"What's that you say?" gasped Thad; "your watch? Tell that to the
+marines, Leon Disney!"
+
+"But it's so, I tell you. Thad, it sure is," persisted the other
+tenaciously, as though he had laid all his plans for just such an
+"accident," whereby his attempt to rob Hugh's locker would be held
+up. "I believe I must have forgotten to take it out of my locker
+this evening when I was dressing, after hard work on the field,
+running, and practising throwing the hammer. I never noticed it till
+long after supper, and I was afraid of what my dad would say when he
+asked me for it in the morning, to take back to the store where he
+got it, to exchange for another. So, Hugh, don't you see, the idea
+came to me that mebbe I might be able to get in the building out here
+if a window happened to be unfastened; which turned out to be the
+case, you know."
+
+"Yes, the very _first_ window you tackled in the bargain, Leon; how
+fortunate for you!" sneered the unbelieving Thad. "And say, you
+ought to know that this isn't your locker, because the numbers are
+painted big enough on the door for anybody with only one eye to see."
+
+Even this did not appear to disconcert the other boy. He was a
+slippery sort of customer, who always seemed able to find some sort
+of ready excuse, or a way to "climb down a tree" when caught in the
+act.
+
+He turned, and stared at the number 16 plainly on the door. Then he
+grinned at Thad as he hurriedly went on to explain further; for his
+inventive faculties seemed without end when they were exercised in
+order to get him out of any bad scrape:
+
+"Well, that shows my first guess was the right one after all. You
+see, Hugh, I knew my number was either 16 or 19, and, for the life of
+me, I couldn't tell which. Of course, if the first belongs to you
+when my number is 19, I was foolish to change my mind; though, of
+course, even if the key opened your locker I'd have known my mistake
+right away. No harm done, I hope, Hugh?"
+
+Thad made a low, growling sound, as though he put not the slightest
+faith in the story Leon was telling. He knew the other to be utterly
+unprincipled, and a willing tool in the hands of Nick Lang; indeed,
+there were some things about the sneaky Leon that blunt, honest Thad
+hated worse than the bullying propensities of the other boy.
+
+"So you really and truly left your watch in your locker, did you?" he
+demanded, with a perceptible sneer in his tones.
+
+"I think I did; in fact, I'm certainly hoping so," Leon hastily
+replied; "because if it doesn't happen to be there I don't know where
+I could have lost it; and I'll get a fine turning over from dad in
+the morning when he asks me for the same to take back, and exchange
+for one that keeps decent time."
+
+"Oh!" continued the still skeptical Thad, thinking to corner Leon,
+"then, perhaps, you'll prove your words by showing us the inside of
+your locker right now? Number 19 it would be, you said; well, here
+it is, on a direct line with Hugh's locker. Get busy with your key,
+Leon, and open up!"
+
+Possibly Thad was confident that the other would not venture to do as
+he demanded. He may have expected him to invent some handy excuse
+for not complying; but then the other had already laid the foundation
+for a reasonable sense of disappointment in case no watch was
+forthcoming when the locker was opened; since he said he _hoped_ he
+might have forgotten it when dressing, and not lost it on the way
+home that evening at dusk.
+
+Leon started to obey with alacrity, as though he had no fears. His
+key immediately opened the door, and this, upon being swung aside,
+revealed a bundle of old athletic garments hastily thrown in without
+regard to neatness.
+
+These Leon commenced to eagerly take out, one at a time. He was
+careful how he handled them, as though fearful lest he might toss the
+silver watch out, to land on the floor with disastrous results.
+
+As he picked up such various articles of wearing apparel as used by
+an athlete in training, Leon continued to air his grievances, as
+though he meant Hugh to understand how utterly impossible it was for
+him to have intended any mean thing by breaking open a locker other
+than his own:
+
+"It was silly of me getting those numbers mixed in my head, of
+course; but then a figure nine is only a six turned upside down, you
+see. I was so worked up over missing my clock that I just couldn't
+think straight at all. Well, it isn't under that jersey, anyhow; nor
+yet covered by those trunks. I remember now I pushed it away back,
+so I couldn't drag it out. There's an old sweater I use when I'm
+overheated, and afraid of taking cold; mebbe now it's under that."
+
+Reaching further in, Leon caught hold of the article in question, and
+carefully drew it toward him. Then he as cautiously lifted the torn
+sweater; and, as Thad turned the glow of the flash-light directly
+into the box they all saw the watch reposing in the corner, just as
+the boy had left it.
+
+Leon made a clutch for his property. He over-did the matter, Hugh
+thought, acting in an exuberant fashion.
+
+"Oh! mebbe I'm not joyful over getting my hands on you again, you
+poor old time-keeper!" he exclaimed, as he snatched the silver watch
+up and shook it, as though any fault could be attached to the article
+in question. "A fine chase you've given me to-night; and playing the
+part of sneak-thief in the bargain; but then, of course, you believe
+what I told you, now, Hugh, since you've seen that the watch was in
+my locker?"
+
+Hugh did not care to fully commit himself, it seemed, judging from
+the way in which he went on to say:
+
+"We've seen you recover your watch all right, Leon; and it was in
+your locker just as you said; but whether you forgot it, or left it
+there on purpose, is a question I'm not prepared to settle."
+
+Of course there was no further excuse for Hugh keeping that grip on
+Leon's shoulder, so he released his hold, and the other gave a sigh
+as of relief at this evidence of a change in policy on the part of
+his captor.
+
+"Say, I wish you'd do me a great favor, Hugh," Leon went on to say,
+as though he believed in the old maxim that it is wise to "strike
+while the iron is hot."
+
+"As to what?" demanded the one addressed in this whining way.
+
+"What's the use of saying anything about this business?" Leon went on
+eagerly. "It certainly wouldn't do any good, and I proved to you
+that I did enter here just to recover my watch, didn't I? But mebbe
+it might get to my dad's ears, how I'd gone and been so careless
+about looking after my property. You see, he told me that if I lost
+this birthday present he'd not get me another watch till I graduated
+from high school; and say, I'm beginning to lose all hope of that
+ever happening in my case. But you will keep mum about it, won't
+you, Hugh; just to save me from getting up against it rough with my
+strict dad?"
+
+It sounded like a reasonable request, Hugh must have thought.
+Besides, no matter what the intentions of Leon may have been, there
+had really been no harm done, owing to the fact of their being drawn
+to the spot by discovering his skulking figure dimly outlined in the
+moonlight.
+
+Hugh considered before committing himself to making any reply. He
+did not believe most of what the other so glibly declared, partly
+because he knew very well that Mr. Disney was not a strict parent at
+all, but a most indifferent one, or he would never have allowed his
+young hopeful to go in the company of Nick Lang, and take part in
+many of the other's practical jokes. Some of these had bordered on a
+serious nature, like the time the electric current was shut off
+abruptly when the graduation exercises were going on at night-time in
+the big auditorium in the high-school building; and the ensuing utter
+darkness almost created a panic among the audience, composed
+principally of women and young people, the wires having been severed,
+it was later discovered, at a point where they entered the building.
+
+"I'll say this, Leon," he finally told the waiting boy; "I'll keep
+quiet about this little thing for three days, and then feel free to
+mention it, if the necessity arises. I'll make a further bargain
+with you to this effect; you fight shy of the company of Nick Lang
+after this, and I'll hold my tongue as long as I understand that
+you've cut his acquaintance; otherwise, I'll feel free to speak; and
+there are lots of people in this town who'll believe you had some
+dark motive back of your breaking into this building to-night. Your
+reputation is against you, Leon, you understand. Another fellow
+might enter here, and everybody would believe what he said; but
+you've long ago lost the confidence of everybody worth while in
+Scranton. Is it a bargain, then?"
+
+Leon replied with alacrity; but then that was no sign that he meant
+to keep his word. He had been caught in a downright lie on many
+another occasion; so Hugh did not place much reliance on his promise
+to reform.
+
+"Oh! as to that, Hugh," said the crafty Leon, "I've been figuring on
+cutting away from Nick for a long time now, and I guess I'll do it.
+He's got me in lots of nasty scrapes, you understand, and then just
+laughs at me. I'd have given him the shake long since, only he
+threatened to whip me black and blue if I ever did. But this would
+be a good chance to try it out. Yes, I'll promise you to try and
+break away from Nick; and I hope you'll keep mum about my coming here
+to-night. If you don't mind, Thad, I'd like to have my flashlight
+now. And I ought to be going back home in the bargain, because dad
+doesn't like me to be out nights unless he knows where I'm at."
+
+Thad chuckled as though he considered this last remark in the light
+of a joke; for Leon roamed the streets until a late hour every night
+he chose; but, as there was no need of their staying longer, they
+passed out of the window, and headed toward their respective homes.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IX
+
+SCRANTON IN GALA ATTIRE
+
+That was, indeed, a busy Friday with the students of Scranton High.
+Lessons had been tabooed entirely, for what was the use of trying to
+hold the attention of the scholars upon dry subjects when their
+thoughts continually roamed afield, and seemed concerned only with
+what great things were scheduled for the next afternoon? Still, they
+gathered at school, which was a sort of general headquarters where
+the various committees appointed could consult, and go forth to the
+work assigned to their particular charge.
+
+The girls were just as enthusiastic as the boys, and demanded equal
+representation upon a number of the said committees, especially the
+ones designed for the welcome and entertainment of the vast crowds
+expected to be present from neighboring towns and villages.
+
+It was going to be an event long to be remembered in Scranton, and
+the town dressed in gala attire in honor of the occasion. Flags and
+banners were being displayed as though a great wave of patriotism had
+overwhelmed the place. If a stranger had suddenly dropped down on
+the town just then he must have believed American soldiers were on
+the fighting line across in France, and that news had been cabled
+over to the effect that they had met the enemy in their first
+engagement, and won a decisive victory.
+
+The fairly good town brass band had promised to be on hand, and play
+during the best part of the afternoon. Then there would be a host of
+refreshment booths at which Scranton's fairest daughters would
+preside, accompanied in each instance by a matron of mature years, to
+lend dignity to the occasion. Here the good folks from Allandale,
+Belleville and other places, who honored the town with their presence
+would always be warmly welcomed, and given a cup of delicious tea,
+coffee or chocolate, as they preferred, accompanied with sandwiches
+galore, and even cake.
+
+Meanwhile it was planned that those who meant to take part in any of
+the events on the long programme should have a last "workout" that
+Friday afternoon. Saturday morning it was intended they should rest
+up, so as to be in the pink of condition when the meet opened at one
+o'clock.
+
+That might seem to be an early hour, as some had argued, but the
+programme was so extended that there was a possibility of darkness
+creeping up on them before the fifteen-mile Marathon, the greatest
+event of the day, had been fully completed.
+
+During that energetic morning at school, when boys and girls were
+hustling to carry out the part of the work entrusted to them, Hugh
+had managed to keep an eye on Leon Disney from time to time. He felt
+pretty certain that the tricky boy had no intention of fulfilling the
+promise he had made under duress, and while a threat of exposure hung
+over his head, like the famous sword of Damocles, suspended by but a
+single hair.
+
+Leon watched Hugh also, and tried to act in a manner calculated not
+to arouse suspicion; but Hugh understood from his actions how matters
+probably stood. Leon had, of course, managed to see Nick Lang before
+coming to school, and explain to him what a bad fix he had managed to
+get himself in when caught in the act of breaking into Hugh Morgan's
+locker at the athletic grounds building.
+
+No doubt it had been artfully arranged between the precious pair that
+Leon was to seem to keep his distance away from Nick; and if at any
+other time the latter joined a group amidst whom Leon chanced to be
+standing the other was to immediately move away in an ostentatious
+fashion that would cause Hugh to believe he meant to keep his given
+word.
+
+But several times Hugh felt certain he detected sly winks exchanged
+between Nick and his apparently estranged pal; which could only mean
+that Leon was playing a double game. Still Hugh did not bother
+telling anyone about the affair of the preceding night. No harm had
+really been done, fortunately, and Leon might hold his evil
+propensities in check for a while if he had reason to fear disclosure.
+
+The committees were wearing their badges proudly, and every member
+seemed desirous of doing everything in his or her power to render the
+athletic tournament a wonderful success. Nothing like it had ever
+been attempted in the county, and for that reason they were compelled
+to look up all manner of accounts in papers and magazines, in order
+to do things properly.
+
+Mr. Leonard was a great help, for he, being a Princeton graduate, and
+interested in all manner of athletics for years, had kept in touch
+with such things. Then from various other unexpected sources
+assistance cropped up. Why, even old Doctor Cadmus, the leading
+physician of Scranton, proved to be a walking encyclopedia of
+knowledge concerning the management of such an event; and it turned
+out that several times long years before, in another community
+entirely, he had had full charge of just such a tournament; also that
+he had many articles laid away telling of the modern innovations that
+had displaced the older method of doing things.
+
+After lunch the young people began to gather on the field by squads
+and battalions, and it was soon quite an animated sight, with the
+girls circulating around in gaily dressed bunches, and the various
+candidates going through their various stunts under the personal
+supervision of Mr. Leonard.
+
+There had been more or less talk concerning the advisability of
+allowing school boys to undertake such a long Marathon race. Fifteen
+miles, many thought, was far too strenuous an undertaking for lads as
+yet in their teens. Full-fledged athletes only run twenty miles in
+all the famous long-distance races, and even at that numbers of them
+do not finish, the task being too much for them.
+
+But Mr. Leonard was of a different opinion, and he had his way. One
+thing, however, he did insist on. This was that each and every
+candidate entering for the Marathon fetch along with him a paper from
+his family physician, stating that he had undergone a rigid
+examination to ascertain whether he was in the pink of condition, and
+without the slightest heart trouble.
+
+Doctor Cadmus gladly examined all the Scranton fellows free of
+charge, and it was given out to the neighboring towns, from whence
+aspiring runners hailed, that the lack of such a physician's
+certificate would debar any candidate from the race.
+
+Hugh, along with several other fellows, intended to take a run of
+from seven to ten miles over the course that Friday afternoon. They
+did not wish to follow out the entire course, as that might injure
+their prospects for the next day, so Mr. Leonard convinced them. But
+half the distance would be apt to keep their muscles in good trim.
+
+Before making a start, however, Hugh wished to hang around, and watch
+what the other fellows were doing. He was deeply interested in the
+hammer throwing, as well as the sprinting, and, after seeing how well
+the boys acquitted themselves, felt more than ever assured that
+Scranton High would pull down quite a number of the fine prizes
+offered to successful competitors.
+
+It was while things were thus booming that a car rolled past on the
+main road leading out of town. Hugh noticed it particularly, for he
+chanced to be over at that side of the extensive field.
+
+There was a chauffeur at the wheel, and in the tonneau a lady and a
+boy sat, in whom Hugh quickly recognized Claude Jardine and his
+mother. She held her face deliberately away from the bright scene,
+as though appalled to know that so many parents in Scranton were so
+unwise, almost foolish, as to allow their sons to participate in such
+antics; and their daughters to attend the same.
+
+But Hugh chuckled when he saw Claude give a quick look up at his
+mother, as if to make certain she was not looking; after which he
+leaned forward and stared hard and eagerly at the wonderful picture
+that athletic field presented. Hugh had good eyesight, and he could
+detect the longing expression in the effeminate features of the boy
+whose mother seemed bent on making him a weakling and a "sissy."
+
+"Poor Claude, I certainly do pity you," Hugh was telling himself as
+the big car rolled on amidst a cloud of dust. "Deep down in your
+heart you are yearning to be as other natural boys are, who have red
+blood in their veins. If your dad had lived I warrant there'd be a
+different story to tell, because they say he liked all kinds of
+healthy sport; but, somehow, Mrs. Jardine has taken a dislike to such
+things that seems to keep growing stronger all the time, until it's
+become a regular mania with her. But unless she changes her mind
+there'll be a day coming when she'll bitterly regret it all. I
+suppose now, if she had a daughter she'd prevent her from associating
+with Sue, and Ivy, and Peggy, as well as all the other high-school
+girls whose mothers actually allow them to go to dances with us boys,
+and even cheer the Scranton players in a rattling good baseball game."
+
+There was an air of feverish expectation rampant throughout the whole
+town, and wherever young people got together the talk was of nothing
+else save the great event on the programme for the next day. Even
+many older persons seemed to have become infected with the sporting
+virus, because memories of other days were being recalled; and it was
+remarkable how many elderly men had once been deeply interested in
+just such things, though, of course, along somewhat less modern lines.
+
+Then again there was an undercurrent of talk that carried a thrill
+along with it. Stories that could not be confirmed, but were
+believed more or less, began to be circulated to the effect that some
+irresponsible parties meant to start something during the tournament
+that was calculated to bring disrepute upon the town of Scranton. It
+was even darkly hinted that the partly built, new, wooden fence had
+been set on fire as a lark; and squads of curious boys and girls even
+circulated along its entire length, bent upon ascertaining if such a
+thing could really be true.
+
+When they failed to find any evidence of a fire, they were still
+unconvinced; for, of course, it would be policy on the part of the
+management to conceal all traces, so as to save the good name of the
+town.
+
+These rumors could not be traced to any particular source, but there
+are always a certain number of persons who delight to circulate such
+stories, and, perhaps, unconsciously, add a little to the same with
+each and every additional telling, until a trivial happening becomes
+a colossal thing.
+
+That the committee in general charge of the great undertaking
+cherished some sort of fear that some daring outrage might be
+attempted by boys who were not connected with the high school was
+evident from the fact that they had had warning notices printed at
+the office of the _Weekly Courier_, notifying all boys who might
+contemplate playing any sort of practical joke during the holding of
+the carnival that Chief Adolph Wambold, the head of the local police,
+would have his entire force on the grounds, and such offenders would
+be harshly treated, if detected.
+
+The afternoon was well along when Hugh was approached by "Just"
+Smith, one of the candidates who meant to try for the Marathon prize.
+
+"Several of the boys are meaning to start off on that seven-mile
+spin, Hugh," the other announced as he came up; "and they want you to
+come along. We can start together, and then separate, as we feel
+disposed;" and, as this suited Hugh, he agreed.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER X
+
+WHEN MUSCLES COUNTED
+
+There were four of them who made the start, Hugh, "Just" Smith,
+Horatio Juggins, and "K. K.," the Kinkaid boy. Three of the bunch
+had been fielders in the baseball nine that carried off the
+championship pennant of the three-town high-school league the
+preceding summer; and, having been known as great runners, it was
+only natural that they had felt impelled to enter for the
+long-distance race.
+
+An equal number could be expected from both Allandale and Belleville,
+so that with others who would feel disposed to, at least, be in at
+the start, though calculating to fall out after a few miles had been
+run, possibly a full score would toe the string at the time the great
+Marathon was called.
+
+In an event of this nature a big "field" adds to the excitement of
+the occasion; and it is often noticed that those who have no
+intention of finishing usually look the most confident during the
+preparations for making the grand start. Well, they have no hope of
+getting any fun out of the race after losing sight of the crowd, and
+so they mean to take what they can beforehand.
+
+Talking is almost tabooed during such a race, since every breath lost
+in useless conversation saps so much energy. Even on a trial run Mr.
+Leonard had advised the boys to separate as soon as possible, and
+keep some distance apart, mostly to obviate this temptation to
+exchange views; so that each candidate could conserve every atom of
+his powers.
+
+So it came about that by the time two miles had been run Hugh found
+himself absolutely alone. Hugh had left the main thoroughfare, and
+was passing along a byroad that would take him around through the
+hilly country, until the Scranton turnpike was again reached.
+
+The other fellows had the option of doing as Hugh did, or they could
+continue on further, and, perhaps, get a lift back home on some
+farmer's wagon, or possibly a car bound for Scranton. Hugh had an
+idea, however, that one of them was coming along the same road a mile
+or more behind, and that it would turn out to be "Just" Smith. Some
+words the other chap had uttered when they were together before
+starting forth on the run gave Hugh this impression, though he could
+not be positive about it.
+
+At the time, it gave him little concern; but then he could not look
+into the immediate future, and see what it held for him. The coming
+of "Just" Smith would yet turn out to be an event of the first
+magnitude in Hugh's humble opinion; as the reader will soon learn.
+
+Hugh was jogging along nicely, and had long ago caught his second
+wind. He kept "tabs" upon himself, in order to know just how his
+energy held out, and if he was likely to be in condition for the
+gruelling finish that might become necessary, over the last half mile
+of the long course, should a visiting runner threaten to head the
+list with the goal in sight, and the thousands of eager spectators
+bursting out with cheers calculated to thrill the heart, and give
+fresh impetus to wearied limbs.
+
+On the whole, Hugh felt fairly well satisfied with himself. He knew
+he had gone about as fast as ordinary runners would care to travel,
+who wished to conserve their strength toward the close of the race;
+and that he was holding back a good reserve stock of energy. Yes, he
+believed he was at his best, and if he failed to land the prize it
+was because some fellow was a better runner than he could ever hope
+to be.
+
+Just then he heard a sound that gave him a sudden thrill. It was
+like a faint human cry for help, uttered in a weak voice, and seemed
+to come from his right.
+
+Hugh stopped short.
+
+His first inclination was to instantly dash from the road and
+endeavor to discover what caused that cry. Then he had a wave of
+suspicion dart over him. Could this be a sly trick on the part of
+some enemy, meant to lure him into the brush and rocks, where he
+could, perhaps, be overpowered? But Nick, as well as his two
+satellites, Leon Disney and Tip Slavin, had been on the grounds at
+the time Hugh started his run, for he had taken particular notice of
+this fact; consequently, it was hardly likely that they could be
+concerned in any practical joke; and certainly no other fellow would
+be guilty of such a thing.
+
+That decided Hugh. He left the road, and started toward the spot
+where he judged that strange sound had welled forth. The country was
+exceedingly rough just there, and he fancied that some sort of deep
+gully, possibly a precipice, might lie off on his right, judging from
+the aspect of the land.
+
+Not hearing the sound again, Hugh uttered a loud hello. Then, as he
+continued to press hastily forward, he once more caught the
+beseeching cry. It had an agonizing strain to it, and Hugh could
+plainly make out the words:
+
+"Help! Oh! help! help!"
+
+Someone was evidently in trouble, Hugh decided, accelerating his pace
+as well as the conditions of the rough surface of the ground
+permitted. He had taken pains to locate the cry this time, and was,
+therefore, altering his course just a little.
+
+Again he called, and once more received a reply, more fearful than
+before:
+
+"Hurry! Oh! hurry, before it gives way, and I'm lost!"
+
+It sounded more like the voice of a girl than anything else. Hugh
+was thrilled at the bare thought of one of the opposite sex being
+caught in a trap whereby life itself was imperiled.
+
+He had been ascending all this time. From a single look, which he
+cast over his shoulder, he could see the road he had lately come
+along, trace its course, in fact, until it was lost at a bend half a
+mile away.
+
+He noted that a runner had just turned that same bend, and was
+jogging along in a rhythmic, contented fashion, as though satisfied
+with the progress he was making; although "Just" Smith would have to
+speed up considerable on the morrow if he wished to be anywhere near
+the head of the procession when the race neared its close. Hugh,
+somehow, fixed the fact of his comrade's presence on his mind. He
+even mentally figured just how long it was likely to take the other
+to reach the spot where he himself had left the road; for, perhaps,
+that circumstance might loom up large in his calculations.
+
+Then he arrived at the brink of what seemed to be a precipice. The
+presence of this told Hugh plainly the nature of the task that
+awaited him. Someone had undoubtedly fallen over the brink, and was,
+even then, hanging on desperately to some jutting rock or bush that
+represented the only hope of safety from a serious fall. He threw
+himself down and thrust his head out over the edge. What Hugh saw
+was enough to give any boy a thrill of horror. Some ten feet below
+the top a human figure sprawled, kicking with his legs in the
+endeavor to find a brace for his feet. He was clinging to a bush
+that seemed to be growing from the face of the precipice, and which
+Hugh could see was slowly but surely giving way, one root after
+another losing its grip in the soil and rocky crevices.
+
+Hugh recognized the imperiled boy instantly, though utterly amazed at
+his discovery; he could not understand for the life of him how Claude
+Jardine, of all fellows in Scranton, could be placed in such a
+dreadful predicament.
+
+But Hugh did not waste a single precious second in trying to solve
+that puzzle; it could be all made plain after he had managed to save
+the poor chap.
+
+"Stop kicking, and keep perfectly still, Claude!" he instantly called.
+
+"But it's going to give way, and let me drop!" wailed the terrified
+boy.
+
+"It'll do that all the sooner if you keep moving as you are," Hugh
+told him sharply, with the tone of authority that one accustomed to
+command might use. "I'm coming down after you, so don't be afraid.
+Can you hold on just ten seconds more?"
+
+"I'll try to, but, oh! hurry, please!" came the trembling answer.
+
+Already Hugh was passing over the edge. He took care not to make a
+false movement, for the precipice was all of forty feet in depth, and
+a fall on the rocks below was bound to be a serious matter.
+
+To lower himself to where the imperiled boy clung he had to take
+advantage of numerous projecting points of rock that offered him a
+foothold, or a place where he could hang on with his hands. Hugh was
+as nimble as any boy in Scranton, which fact proved of great
+advantage to him just then. Had it been otherwise, he might have
+himself fallen, and there would then have been a double tragedy.
+
+Somehow, through Hugh's mind flashed the memory of how Claude's
+doting mother had always, on every occasion, condemned all athletic
+exercises that were intended to build up the muscles, and give new
+power to the body. It seemed the irony of fate that the life of her
+precious boy was now going to hang upon the ability of Hugh Morgan to
+sustain himself, and the weight of another, there upon the face of
+that rocky precipice! Perhaps in times to come Mrs. Jardine would
+discover how false her ideas were, and experience a radical change of
+heart. The opportunity which Hugh had once sighed for had come to
+him in a most wonderful way.
+
+He succeeded in making his way down in safety, though once he
+slipped, and had a thrill of alarm pass over him. Now he found
+himself alongside Claude. The boy's face was the color of ashes;
+Hugh had never looked upon a corpse in all his life, but he could not
+help comparing Claude's pallid countenance to one.
+
+He was glancing around with the eye of a general who lets nothing, no
+matter how trivial, escape him. Just a foot below Claude's dangling
+toes there was a narrow ledge. If only both of them could find
+lodgment upon this; and have some hold above for their hands, they
+might maintain their position until Hugh's shouts attracted "Just"
+Smith to the spot, and he could do something to aid them.
+
+"Listen, Claude," he said earnestly. "There's a way to save you, if
+only you keep your head about you. 'Just' Smith is coming along the
+road, and I'll shout out to guide him here so he can help us."
+
+"But--the bush is going to give way right off!" gasped the terrified
+boy.
+
+"Well, below us there's a ledge where we must plant our feet, and
+hold on," continued Hugh, convincingly. "I'm going to drop down to
+it now. Then you must try to lower yourself along the bush, inch by
+inch, until you feel the ledge under you. Don't be afraid, because I
+mean to grab hold of you; but when you feel me touching you, above
+all things don't let go above, or you'll throw us both down. Now, be
+ready, Claude; and, remember, it's going to be all right. Keep cool!"
+
+Of course, Hugh only said that last to reassure the poor chap.
+Claude was already cold with fear, as cold as an icicle, in fact; and
+quaking with fear in the bargain.
+
+It was easy enough for Hugh to drop down another foot or so, until he
+felt the solid little ledge under him. Indeed, had it been
+necessary, such an agile fellow very likely might have continued all
+the way down to the base of the precipice.
+
+His next move was to find a firm hold for his left hand, to which he
+could continue to cling while he sustained much of the weight of the
+other boy, after the weakened roots of the bush gave way entirely.
+
+Claude was trying to do what he had been told, though in rather a
+bungling fashion. Inch by inch he allowed the bush to slip through
+his hands, looking down as well as he was able at the same time, in
+order to ascertain just how near he might be to that same ledge Hugh
+had told him of.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XI
+
+THE CRISIS IN CLAUDE'S LIFE
+
+Hugh kept a watchful eye on that bush. He knew it was going to give
+way presently, when, unless Claude had managed to secure a fresh grip
+on some object with his poor scratched hands, he was likely to be
+dashed downward.
+
+Fortune was, however, kind in that respect, for there chanced to be a
+nice projection of rock, somewhat in the shape of a horn, just in the
+right place for Claude to seize upon, and which would help sustain
+his weight. Hugh knew very well, though, that most of the burden
+would fall upon him; and he, therefore, prepared to accept it.
+
+"Here, reach out with your left hand, Claude, and take hold of this
+rock. Your feet are both safely anchored on the ledge. Keep up your
+grit, and everything will be all right yet. Do you understand what
+I'm telling you, Claude?"
+
+"Yes, I do, Hugh," chattered the other, for his teeth were rattling
+together in a way that reminded Hugh of the "Bones" at the end of a
+minstrel line; if he had ever seen a Spanish stage performance he
+would have said they made a sound like castanets in the hands of the
+senorita who gave the national Castilian dance.
+
+Claude really managed to carry out that part of the task with a fair
+amount of success. His other hand still gripped the bush, which
+continued to gradually give way under the long and severe strain.
+
+Hugh braced himself. He had taken as firm a hold as was possible,
+and had his other arm thrown around Claude.
+
+"Steady, now, Claude, it's almost gone. When you feel it give way,
+try and make use of your right hand to find some other rocky point
+where you can hold on. I think there's one such on the other side of
+you. Above all, don't struggle, or you may throw me off my balance,
+and then it's good-bye to both of us. Now, be ready!"
+
+Hugh's calculations proved to be correct, for the bush gave way, and
+fell with a clatter of small stones and loosened earth, down toward
+the bottom of the steep declivity. Claude uttered a cry of dismay
+when he felt his support gone; but luckily he gripped the rocky knob
+with his left hand more convulsively than ever, while Hugh sustained
+him to the best of his ability.
+
+"That was well done, Claude," Hugh now told him, his main object
+being to put a little more confidence in the other boy, and thus
+lighten his own load. "We'll manage to cling here for a bit longer.
+When I think 'Just' Smith is getting near by I'll let out a whoop
+that is bound to fetch him to our assistance."
+
+One, two, three minutes passed. It was very trying to Hugh, and
+already his muscles began to feel the undue strain keenly. But he
+gritted his teeth, and waited, as it would be only a waste of breath
+and energy to shout before the next runner was close enough up to
+locate the sound.
+
+Claude was shivering as though he would shake to pieces. He had
+received a dreadful fright, for a fact, and it was having its due
+effect upon his never strong frame. What would his doting mamma
+think, and say, Hugh told himself, almost with a chuckle of
+amusement, could she see her darling then and there, and realize how
+his very life depended upon the strong muscles and will to do things
+that Hugh Morgan had developed in himself?
+
+How slowly the seconds passed! Hugh was trying to count, so as to
+judge when the Marathon runner would be likely to have covered that
+half-mile, and be at the spot where he, Hugh, had left the road.
+
+When, finally, the time had expired he again spoke to Claude.
+
+"Don't be startled, Claude, because I'm going to shout out. Hang
+tight, now!"
+
+With that he sent out a whoop, and coupled it with the name of "Just"
+Smith. There was no immediate response, but then Hugh had already
+discounted this in his mind, remembering how he also had come to a
+sudden stop, and listened as though unable to believe his ears.
+
+Again he shouted, and once more uttered the name of the other boy.
+This time there came a speedy reply.
+
+"Hello! that you, Hugh?"
+
+"Yes, and I want help right away!" answered the boy who clung there
+with a burden on his hands. "Turn out of the road to the left, and
+hurry here. I'm down a precipice, Just. Keep coming, and I'll guide
+you all right."
+
+So Hugh continued to utter loud shouts every dozen seconds or so. He
+could catch the calls of the advancing runner, and knew from their
+increasing loudness that he was gradually getting closer.
+
+Then, looking up, he saw a head projected over the brink above. He
+could easily understand how "Just" Smith's eyes must have almost
+started from their sockets when discovering the dreadful position of
+the pair below; and especially after he had recognized Claude
+Jardine, the last fellow in the wide world whom he would have
+expected to see in such a fix.
+
+"H-h-how in the wide world did you get down there, Hugh?" gasped the
+boy who leaned over the brink.
+
+"I came down after Claude here, who'd fallen over, and was hanging to
+a bush that was giving way," explained Hugh. "And now it's up to you
+to get us both out of this scrape, Just."
+
+"Oh, if only I had a rope!" cried the other, apparently nonplussed.
+
+"Well, wishes won't make one," said the practical Hugh; "and so we'll
+have to do without. But if you look around sharply I think you'll
+find a long pole there, for I remember noticing something of the
+kind."
+
+The boy above vanished for a brief period, which seemed ages to the
+anxious Claude; and even Hugh counted the seconds, for the strain was
+something serious. Then again that friendly head appeared in view.
+
+"You were right, Hugh!" called the Smith boy; "there was such a pole
+handy, and I've got the same right here now. It's plenty long enough
+to reach down to you; but I'm wondering however I'll be able to draw
+two of you up."
+
+"I don't expect you to, all by yourself, Just," Huge told him. "Poke
+the end of it down here, and keep a good stiff grip on the butt.
+Then we'll hold on, and find places to set our feet. Inch by inch,
+and foot by foot, we'll manage to climb up. You can help a little by
+keeping the stick coming, you know."
+
+"I get you, Hugh!" snapped the other eagerly; "and it's sure a right
+good scheme. But be mighty careful you don't slip, either of you.
+That fall'd break bones, even if it didn't kill you outright."
+
+"Don't worry about us, Just Smith; pay attention to your part of the
+contract, and things are bound to work out first-class. Lower away,
+and don't poke us off our perch, please. We've only got a risky hold
+below here."
+
+So saying, Hugh encouraged the other two to do their part manfully.
+Even Claude was shivering less than before, as though a breath of
+renewed confidence might have been installed in his heart by this
+close contact with such a stalwart chap as Hugh Morgan. It was going
+to be the turning point in Claude's career, of that Hugh felt
+positive. After this thrilling experience he was bound to awaken to
+the fact that he was not like other boys of his age; and demand of
+his mother that she permit him to participate in the life-giving
+outdoor sports that are a part and parcel of boy nature.
+
+They began to climb. It was slow work, but Hugh would not be
+hurried. Better that they waste time in gaining each foot than by an
+unwise step ruin all. What matter if that arm of his was almost numb
+with pain, and he had to press his teeth firmly together in order to
+continue to hold up Claude? If only the other had been a normal boy
+he could have helped himself wonderfully; but, as it was, he seemed
+as weak and helpless as a kitten that had never opened its eyes as
+yet.
+
+Well, half of the distance separating them from the top had been
+safely navigated, and so far no accident had occurred. Hugh kept
+encouraging his charge from time to time; and then speaking words
+also to the laboring, anxious boy above, directing him just how to
+proceed.
+
+Finally they reached the top. Hugh still ordered "Just" Smith to
+hold the pole as he had been doing. Then he managed to push Claude
+up so that he could crawl over the edge, which the other did in a
+speedy manner, bordering on the ludicrous.
+
+Then, to the surprise, as well as delight of Hugh, what did Claude do
+but turn and stretch out a helping hand, as though his first thought
+was to assist his rescuer to top the rise; indeed, Hugh's one arm was
+so utterly gone that he could hardly count on it for a single thing.
+Hugh would not be apt to forget this action on the part of the
+"sissy"; it proved what he had all along more than half suspected,
+that Claude really did have the making of a genuine boy in him, given
+half a chance for it to show itself, and the seed to germinate. And
+Hugh determined that he would make it his particular business to see
+that there came a change in Claude's dreary life. His mother could
+hardly refuse anything asked by the one to whom she owed the life of
+her son.
+
+Soon the trio lay upon the ground, breathing hard, and trying to talk
+at the same time. Both Hugh and "Just" Smith were consumed with
+curiosity to know how Claude happened to get into such a strange
+predicament, and he hastened to explain.
+
+After all, there was nothing so very singular about it. His mother
+had stopped in to see an old nurse, who had been in the family many
+years but was at the time lying sick at her sister's place.
+Something influenced Claude to get out of the big car to take a
+little stroll. Perhaps the sight of all those happy lads running and
+jumping and throwing weights had made him feel more than ever his own
+narrow, confined life, kept out of the society of all the other boys
+after school hours, and made to play the part of a "mollycoddle," as
+Roosevelt called all such fellows who have never learned how to take
+care of themselves when a bully threatens.
+
+Unused to the woods and hills, of course the first thing Claude did
+was to lose all sense of direction. He became alarmed, and that made
+matters worse than ever. So he had roamed about for almost a full
+hour, dreadfully tiring his poor feet and limbs, since he had never
+before in all his life walked so far and done such vigorous climbing.
+
+Then he had come to that precipice, and, thinking he might glimpse
+the cottage where the old nurse lived, somewhere down in the valley,
+he had incautiously crept too close to the brink, when his weight
+caused a portion of the soil to give way. Finding himself falling,
+Claude had clutched desperately around him, and, as it happened, his
+fingers gripped a friendly bush, to which he continued to cling even
+as he struggled to better his condition and shouted as best he was
+able.
+
+Hugh finished the story, to the edification of "Just" Smith, who
+admitted that if it had not been for the courage and muscular ability
+of Hugh the other boy must long ago have fallen to the bottom of the
+awful precipice. And Claude, shivering as he afterwards looked up at
+the forty feet and more of rocky wall, vowed he would never rest
+satisfied until he too had learned how to develop his muscles so that
+if ever again caught in a similar scrape he might have a fighting
+chance for his life.
+
+The two boys eventually found the cottage, although Mrs. Jardine and
+the car had gone down the road hoping to overtake Claude, though they
+were expected back again later; so, leaving Claude there, Hugh and
+"Just" Smith continued their seven-mile run.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XII
+
+STARTLING NEWS FROM THE JUGGINS BOY
+
+"Burr-r-r-r!"
+
+That was the telephone bell ringing.
+
+"Hugh, will you answer it, since the chances are the call is from
+some one of your numerous boy chums?" the voice of Mrs. Morgan came
+from the dining-room, where she was looking after the silver and
+china, after washing up the supper dishes, for they temporarily
+chanced to be without a hired-girl.
+
+Hugh guessed as much himself. He had already been called to the
+phone several times since arriving home after his seven-mile spin.
+Once it had been Claude's mother, begging him to be sure and call at
+her house early in the morning, because she wanted to have a good,
+long, earnest talk with him about Claude's future; and also to let
+him know how brimful of gratitude a mother's heart could be toward
+the brave boy who, at the risk of his own life, had saved her only
+child for her.
+
+Hugh had promised he would see her, although he expected to be very
+busy on the morning of the athletic tournament and then expressed the
+hope that Claude and herself would honor the tournament with their
+presence. This she hastily assured him she meant to do, because it
+was now borne in on her heart that she had been making a terrible
+mistake in reference to the way she was bringing up her darling
+Claude.
+
+Needless to say, Hugh had chuckled joyously after that little talk.
+He guessed he would have little trouble now in removing the scales
+Mrs. Jardine had allowed to cover her eyes with regard to the
+benefits to be derived by any boy, no matter how weak he might be,
+through a judicious system of athletic exercises, the same to be
+lengthened as he gradually grew more capable of standing fatigue.
+
+"Hello!" Hugh called.
+
+A voice he immediately recognized as that of Horatio Juggins greeted
+him. "That you, Hugh?"
+
+"Just who it is; what's the matter, Horatio? Feeling the effects of
+your little jog this afternoon? I hope not, for your sake,
+to-morrow."
+
+"Oh! come off, Hugh," the other quickly replied. "I'd be a fine
+candidate for a fifteen-mile Marathon race, wouldn't I, if seven
+miles knocked me out? I'm as fit right now as a fiddle. But Hugh,
+can you come right over here now? Something dreadful has happened."
+
+Hugh had a chilly feeling pass over him. It seemed as though some
+sort of bad news was coming. Had the great meet been called off, for
+some unknown reason or other? Somehow that struck him first as a
+dire possibility, since it would grievously disappoint thousands of
+eager boys and girls, not to mention many older folks with young
+hearts.
+
+Now Hugh had intended to take that evening quietly, resting after his
+strenuous afternoon, and absolutely refuse to allow Thad, or any
+other fellow, to coax him outside the door. But already this resolve
+began to weaken. That dim mention of some possible tragedy happening
+started him going.
+
+"Of course I can come over, Horatio," he told the boy at the other
+end of the wire; "and I'll do so right away on condition that it's no
+joke. Tell me what's up first."
+
+"Oh! I meant to do that, Hugh," his friend hastened to say, and Hugh
+could detect a tremor to the boyish voice that told of excitement.
+"You see, it's K. K."
+
+"What's happened to him?" demanded Hugh, his mind instantly
+suggesting all manner of terrible possibilities, from a sudden attack
+of sickness to an accident whereby his life might be in danger; for
+with boys these things sometimes happen as unexpectedly as a flash of
+lightning from a clear sky.
+
+"Why, he never came back again from that run this afternoon, Hugh!"
+Horatio was saying, in an awed tone now.
+
+"What's that you're telling me?" exclaimed the astonished Hugh. "I
+thought I saw K. K. with some of the other fellows when I was
+starting home just before dusk came on, though, of course, I may have
+been mistaken about it."
+
+"You were, Hugh, you certainly were," Horatio assured him in a
+softened tone. "His own mother ought to know, hadn't she? Well,
+she's over here at our house right now, crying her eyes out, and
+imagining all sorts of terrible things. You remember the Kinkaids
+live close by us; and she knew her boy was going to take the run this
+afternoon along with me, so she thought I could tell her if anything
+had happened to detain him. Why, she says K. K. never missed his
+supper before in all his life. It'd have to be something _fierce_ to
+keep him away from his best meal of the whole day."
+
+Hugh was thinking swiftly. He realized that this was no little
+matter to be dismissed as unimportant. Something certainly must have
+happened to detain K. K. for all this time. Several hours had
+elapsed since the other fellows reached the terminus of the long run
+at the athletic grounds. Why then had not K. K. shown up?
+
+"Keep the rest till I get there, Horatio!" he told the other.
+
+"Then you're sure coming, are you, Hugh?"
+
+"Right away," Hugh added.
+
+"Well, I'm glad, because you'll know what to do about it. And
+there's something else!"
+
+"Yes?"
+
+"I've got something to tell you that, say, I didn't have the heart to
+explain to K. K.'s mother, because she's bad enough frightened as it
+is; but it's looking particularly ugly to me, now that he hasn't come
+back. Oh! perhaps there is more'n a grain of truth in all those
+terrible stories those hayseeds tell about that place!"
+
+Hugh put up the receiver with a bang, made a dash for his cap,
+slipped on his sweater, for he knew the night air was cold, and then
+shot out of doors. Somehow those last few words of Horatio,
+breathing of mystery as they did, had excited his curiosity until it
+now reached fever-pitch.
+
+As he knew of several short-cuts across lots it took him but a few
+minutes to arrive at the Juggins home. Horatio was waiting at the
+door, and must have heard him running up the steps, for he instantly
+opened it to admit him.
+
+"Gee, but I'm glad you've come, Hugh!" was his greeting. "She's in
+there with mother, and taking on awful about it. It's a dreadful
+thing to see a woman cry, Hugh. And I'm afraid there may be a good
+reason for expecting the worst."
+
+"Tell me what you've got up your sleeve, Horatio," snapped Hugh, "and
+quit giving all these dark hints. You know something connected with
+K. K. that perhaps no one else does."
+
+"Guess I do, Hugh; for he confided in me, and told me not to say
+anything to the rest. Oh, how foolish it was for K. K. to think he
+could do that big job two days in succession; but he said he was
+feeling equal to nearly anything; and just had to make the try, since
+the notion had gripped him. But come on over to my den, Hugh, and
+I'll tell you all about it. Then you must decide what's best to be
+done; and say, I hope you can soothe Mrs. Kinkaid a bit in the
+bargain."
+
+Ten seconds later and the two boys found themselves ensconced in the
+room Horatio called his "den," although it was also his sleeping
+apartment. But he had fixed it as near like a boy's ideal of a
+lounging-place could be, the walls carrying the customary college
+pennants and a great variety of other things besides that gave them a
+rather crowded appearance. Evidently Horatio believed it added to
+the charm, for he never entered that "sanctum" without an involuntary
+smile of appreciation.
+
+Horatio closed the door softly after him. Hugh had also noticed how
+he did this just as carefully when admitting him to the front hall;
+and as though he expected that this must have aroused a certain
+amount of curiosity, Horatio hastened to explain.
+
+"You see, the poor woman is so excited, and in such a nervous
+condition, that she jumps up at the sound of a door closing, and
+starts to rush out into the hall, believing that Justin has got back
+home and hurried over to acquaint her with the joyous fact. Each
+time her disappointment leaves her worse than before. She will be
+needing Doctor Cadmus if this keeps on, as sure as anything."
+
+"Well, what is it you want to tell me, Horatio?" demanded Hugh, not
+even taking the trouble to drop down into the chair the owner of the
+"den" shoved toward him; for it seemed as though he must soon be on
+the jump--there was evidently something hanging over their heads,
+which would be needing prompt attention.
+
+"Why, it's just this, Hugh," began the other. "K. K. took a foolish
+notion he'd like to say he'd gone over the full course just for
+practice. And, Hugh. he told me he meant to make use of the
+short-cut that crosses the old haunted quarry!"
+
+Hugh started, and looked serious.
+
+"Then, if anything has happened to K. K., it must have been while he
+was crossing that mile tract between the two main roads," he went on
+to say, without hesitation. Horatio nodded his head eagerly.
+
+"I jumped to that same conclusion, Hugh, only I didn't dare mention
+it to Mrs. Kinkaid. I thought you ought to know first of all, and
+decide on the program. It's terrible just to think of it; and K. K.
+actually pretended to make light, too, of all those stories the
+farmers have been telling about that awful place."
+
+"Hold your horses, Horatio!" Hugh exclaimed. "When I said that I
+wasn't thinking of ghosts, or anything else unnatural. I meant that
+in all probability poor K. K. met with some ordinary accident while
+on that stretch, and has been unable to continue his run. He may
+have tripped on a vine he failed to see, and either broken his leg,
+or else sprained his ankle so badly that he can't even limp along.
+I've known such a thing to happen--in fact, once I got myself in the
+same pickle, and had to _crawl_ two miles to a house, every foot of
+the way on hands and knees, because the pain was frightful whenever I
+tried to stand up. Well, the chances are K. K. has had such a thing
+befall him."
+
+Horatio heaved a tremendous sigh, as though quite a weighty load had
+been taken off his chest.
+
+"You make me feel a heap better, Hugh, when you're so positive," he
+hastened to admit. "I was afraid it might be something even worse
+than a sprain; but never mind what I thought. The question now is,
+what ought we do about it?"
+
+"There's only one thing that can be done," Hugh told him in his
+customary straight-from-the-shoulder fashion, "which is for some of
+his chums to organize a searching party, get the old Kinkaid car out,
+and go up there to look over that abandoned road from one end to the
+other. We'll find K. K., or know the reason why."
+
+"That sounds good to me, Hugh!" declared Horatio, always ready to
+follow where a bold leader showed the way; "and perhaps we may have
+an opportunity to discover whether there _is_ any truth about those
+queer happenings the farmers keep telling of whenever the old quarry
+is mentioned in their presence."
+
+"We'll not bother our minds about fairy stories," Hugh assured him.
+"What we're meaning to do is to look for a practical explanation of
+K. K.'s holding out. And, mark my words, the chances are ten to one
+we'll find the poor chap groaning alongside that road somewhere. But
+let's get busy now, Horatio!"
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIII
+
+TO THE RESCUE OF K. K.
+
+Hugh would really have been better satisfied if he could have hurried
+away without seeing K. K.'s mother. He feared that she might delay
+progress more or less, and at such a time every minute counted.
+
+But at the same time he realized that the poor lady was in a dreadful
+state of mind. It was necessary then that he try and soothe her
+anxiety, for, as Horatio knew very well, Hugh Morgan had a way of
+making other people feel the utmost confidence in him.
+
+"Well, let's see K. K.'s mother, Horatio; but we mustn't waste much
+time. We'll have to get her permission to run the car. I only hope
+there's a decent supply of gas aboard, or in the garage."
+
+Accordingly, Horatio led him into another room, where they found Mrs.
+Kinkaid in a dreadfully nervous condition. She jumped to her feet on
+discovering that Horatio had another boy with him, and then upon
+seeing that it was not the one her heart was yearning after she
+uttered a pitiful wail, and fell back into her chair again.
+
+Hugh wasted no time, but commenced telling her something of what he
+had heard from Horatio, connected with K. K.'s foolish determination
+to take in the entire course as though in the race.
+
+"Of a certainty he's fallen and sprained an ankle somewhere along
+that cross-country road, Mrs. Kinkaid," he ended with. "We mean to
+gather a few of the fellows, and if you'll give us permission to use
+your big car we intend to run up there and look that road over from
+end to end. There is no doubt but what we'll find K. K. and fetch
+him back with us. So please try and feel that things will turn out
+all right. Make up your mind we won't come back without him, that's
+all there is to it."
+
+Somehow the very confidence shown in Hugh's words seemed to pass
+along to the almost distracted lady. Her eyes lighted up with
+renewed courage, and she even smiled, though wanly, it must be
+confessed. But then Hugh was pretty much of a magician in regard to
+arousing a feeling of hope in the most depressed mind.
+
+"You are a thousand times welcome to the car," she hurriedly assured
+him; "and anything else you might want. It is dreadfully unfortunate
+Mr. Kinkaid is away on one of his usual business trips to the west,
+or he would insist on going with you. But I feel certain, Hugh, you
+will manage things splendidly, and a mother's prayers will go after
+you, that you may not only find my boy, but that he may not have been
+seriously injured."
+
+"Then we'll not linger any longer, ma'am," said Hugh, eager to be on
+the move.
+
+Horatio wrapped himself up warmly, and the two of them shot out of
+the door.
+
+"Now, what first, Hugh?"
+
+Hugh seemed to have mapped out a plan of campaign in his mind, for he
+answered without hesitation.
+
+"We must pick up several of the fellows--Thad for one, then Owen
+Dugdale would be another good hand at hunting for a lost party; and,
+well, Julius Hobson for the third. That will make five in
+all,--enough to search the quarry road from end to end. Besides, we
+ought to carry several lanterns, because, while there is a moon, I
+reckon we'll find it far from light along that overgrown trail."
+
+"You just think of everything, Hugh," remarked Horatio, wonderingly.
+
+"Let's get the car, first of all," Hugh continued shrewdly, "because
+it can save us many steps in picking up the other fellows."
+
+By this time they were at the Kinkaid home. Horatio was well
+acquainted with the premises, as he had played with K. K. since they
+were small boys together. Hugh had been told where the key of the
+garage was hidden, and quickly discovered it hanging on a concealed
+nail.
+
+"Wait till I throw the switch, and light up," said Horatio, for they
+had electricity at the Kinkaid place, and, of course, a bulb lighted
+in the garage was considered much safer than a lantern.
+
+As soon as the illumination came both boys set about examining the
+big touring car that occupied the garage.
+
+"Bully!" ejaculated Horatio, after making the rounds with suspended
+breath; "all the tires are as hard as anything. How about the supply
+of gas, Hugh?" for his companion had occupied himself with making an
+examination of the tank.
+
+"Plenty to carry us up and back twice over!" cried the delighted
+Hugh. "This is what I call great luck. I was afraid there would be
+a tire that needed changing; or else no gasolene at all. K. K.
+didn't realize how kind he was to himself when he fitted up the old
+car so handsomely, for some purpose."
+
+"Oh!" chuckled Horatio, "mebbe I know why. You see, there's going to
+be another barn dance next Tuesday night up at Bailey's, and I think
+K. K. asked a girl to go with him and Peggy Noland and Owen Dugdale.
+Yes, he even told me there was still room for two more, if I could
+coax somebody to keep me company."
+
+Hugh busied himself in starting the car going. He knew considerable
+about mechanics, as most boys of the present generation do, since
+automobiles have become so very common. Running it out of the garage
+Hugh bade Horatio "hop aboard," which that worthy did without a
+second invitation.
+
+"Better get Thad first of all, I reckon," suggested Hugh, as though
+he might even have figured out how best to save themselves from any
+unnecessary delay; "then we can clip around to Julius Hobson's place,
+and pick up Owen last on our way out of town."
+
+The program suited Horatio first class. Indeed, he had such perfect
+confidence in Hugh that anything the other said carried conviction
+along with it. It is a fine thing for any boy to have aroused such a
+spirit of trust in the minds of his comrades that they look up to him
+as a sort of natural leader, and obey his slightest wish without
+hesitation. But Hugh bore his honors with humility, and never
+attempted to display the attributes of a czar.
+
+Great was the astonishment of Thad Stevens when he found two excited
+fellows demanding that he bundle up and go with them for a night ride
+up to the abandoned quarry that had gained such a bad reputation
+among the country folks residing roundabout.
+
+The story was partly told in rapid-fire style, enough of it, at
+least, to cause Thad to bounce into his heavy coat, and provide
+himself with a lantern. He expected to become better informed from
+time to time as they pushed along the road.
+
+Next came Julius Hobson. They found him at home also, and, of
+course, he was duly worked up on hearing how poor K. K. had never
+returned home from his run over the long course of fifteen miles.
+When he heard that they needed lanterns Julius produced a new
+electric flashlight which he had received for a birthday present, and
+Hugh said it would do very well as an additional means of
+illumination.
+
+Last of all they stopped at the home of Owen Dugdale, the dark-faced
+lad who lived with his grandfather in a big house, and about whom
+there had at one time been quite a little halo of mystery hanging.
+["The Chums of Scranton High on Deck."]
+
+Again was the main fact mentioned concerning the necessity for a
+searching party starting forth to find poor K. K. Owen did not have
+to be urged to join the bunch; indeed, he showed himself eager to
+accompany them.
+
+"I can fetch a lantern, if you want me to, Hugh," he observed; "and
+say, do you know I'm of a mind to carry my new shotgun that I had
+given to me just last month, when Grandfather concluded I was old
+enough to want to go hunting. If we have to chase all around through
+that place there's so many queer stories told about we might as well
+be fixed so as to protect ourselves."
+
+"Huh!" snorted Horatio Juggins, skeptically, "I've always heard that
+ghosts don't mind ordinary birdshot any more'n an alligator would.
+But then fetch it along, Owen; it'll no doubt make us feel a little
+better when we find ourselves up in that terribly lonely tract of
+country. And who knows but what there might be a stray wildcat
+abroad in those woods. Such things have been heard of, and I even
+saw the skin of a whopper shown in the market."
+
+So Owen carried out his design, and when he got aboard the big car he
+took with him not only a lantern, well filled with oil, but also his
+brand new twelve-gauge shotgun.
+
+At last they were off. Every fellow felt a peculiar sense of
+exhilaration that possibly even bordered on anticipation, take
+possession of him; for the future was there before them all unknown.
+Who could say what strange adventures might befall them before this
+undertaking was finished?
+
+Of course they had the headlights turned on at full force, and Hugh
+at the wheel found no difficulty in keeping the middle of the road.
+He did not mean to pursue a reckless pace, because, if they met with
+an accident it would spoil all their plans. Better to go at an
+ordinary rate of speed, and make haste slowly, so to speak.
+
+Meanwhile there was a clatter of tongues aboard the big car. Julius,
+Thad and Owen had dozens of pertinent questions ready to fire at
+Horatio, who was kept busy making illuminating replies. Thus the
+trio learned how K. K. had unwisely determined to cover the entire
+course and only whispered his intention to his chum, Horatio, at the
+same time binding him to silence, for fear lest Mr. Leonard put a
+damper on his plans by vetoing the scheme in the start.
+
+Then suggestions began to flow like water after a storm. All sorts
+of possibilities covering such a strange disappearance were advanced.
+Owen believed that Horatio was not far amiss when he declared there
+might be something in that ghost business, after all; and that poor
+K. K. had found it out to his cost; though, beyond this broad
+statement, Owen declined to commit himself, because he, of course,
+could not imagine what a genuine ghost would look like, in the
+daytime at that; or what such an apparition would be likely to do to
+a boy who had had the ill-luck to fall into its clutches.
+
+A dozen additional ideas were advanced, some of them bordering on the
+absurd and others really plausible. The unlimited resources of a
+boy's fertile mind in conjuring up remarkable explanations in a
+mysterious case like the one now engaging their attention had not yet
+been reached at the time Hugh suddenly announced they were close to
+the place where the abandoned quarry road started in from the
+thoroughfare they were then following.
+
+"We just passed the twin oaks I remember stood alongside the road on
+the left," he explained, at the same time slowing up considerably;
+"and they are close to the turning-in place. I noticed them in
+particular, you see, because I didn't want to lose even three seconds
+when on the run, in searching for some sign of the spot; though, of
+course, I could have looked for the marks of our tires left there at
+the time we came back from our nutting excursion, and went through to
+the other road. Yes, here we are right now, and I'm going to turn
+in, boys."
+
+He negotiated the turn without accident, though the branches of the
+trees did scrape against the sides of the car in a way that made some
+of the occupants shudder; for already they were beginning to feel a
+trace of the uneasiness that their gruesome surroundings were apt to
+arouse within their boyish hearts.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIV
+
+THE SEARCHING PARTY
+
+"Hugh, it looks like we mightn't need those lanterns after all,"
+remarked Horatio, after they had gotten well started along the dimly
+seen quarry road.
+
+Indeed, the brilliant headlights of the big car illuminated a radius
+of considerable size ahead of them and around. Every tiny twig was
+thrown out into bold relief, as though a powerful sun had found a way
+of forcing ingress through the canopy of leafless branches overhead.
+
+"Not just at present, perhaps," replied the driver at the wheel; "but
+they may come in handy yet. We'll wait and see."
+
+Owen sat beside Hugh, the other three occupying the tonneau of the
+car. There was abundance of room for all, and some to spare. Owen
+held his new shotgun in his hands and he kept a close watch upon the
+road ahead, just as though that idea connected with a ferocious
+wildcat might have taken hold on his mind, and he believed there was
+a possibility of such a thing coming to pass.
+
+Hugh drove with exceedingly great care, and made no attempt at speed.
+Indeed, such a thing was utterly out of the question, with that rough
+road to follow and the necessity of keeping a constant vigilant
+outlook, lest they collide with some tree. When the quarry was in
+full operation automobiles were an unknown luxury; and certainly no
+provision had ever been made for such a contraption passing along
+that crooked trail, with its numerous sharp curves intended to avoid
+natural obstacles. Three separate times already had Hugh brought the
+car to a full stop, and even caused the engine to cease its
+throbbing. This was done in order that all of them might strain
+their hearing, in hopes of catching some faint sound to tell that the
+missing boy whom they sought was close at hand.
+
+But only disappointment succeeded each attempt to pick up
+information. They caught the dismal hooting of an owl in some dead
+tree not far away, but certainly such a doleful sound did not raise
+their spirits materially. Several times while they were moving along
+Owen had seen a movement amidst the brush that gave him a little
+thrill; but the glimpses he obtained of the disappearing animal
+convinced him in one instance that it was a red fox that scurried off
+in alarm; while on the second occasion he rather imagined it was only
+a ring-tailed raccoon scuttling away and badly frightened by the
+intense white glow that had suddenly penetrated his dark quarters.
+
+If there was a wildcat within twenty miles the spot they certainly
+never knew of it, because no such beast of prey disclosed its
+presence to them while they continued on their way.
+
+But then there were plenty of thrills for the boys. Not only did the
+weird hooting of that horned owl come to make their flesh creep, but
+now and again they detected strange sounds that may have been caused
+by limbs of the trees rubbing together in the night breeze, but which
+had a wonderful resemblance to human groans.
+
+They had been pursuing their way along for some little time without
+much attempt at conversation; but it is pretty hard for a parcel of
+boys to remain long silent, no matter what the provocation. And
+Horatio, for one, felt urged to free his mind of certain fancies that
+had taken lodging there.
+
+"I say, fellows, doesn't this beat everything you ever saw all
+hollow?" he went on to say, for there was really no need of their
+keeping quiet, since they had not started out to steal a march upon
+any enemy,--only to find poor lost K. K. "Just listen to that awful
+groaning sound, will you? If I didn't know it was caused by the
+limbs of trees sawing across each other in the wind I'd think
+somebody was almost dying."
+
+"At another time I guess we wouldn't bother our heads about such a
+silly thing," observed Julius Hobson; "but, of course, our minds are
+full up with what may have happened to our comrade, and all that
+noise makes us shiver a heap; it's so suggestive, so to speak."
+
+"Oh! what did you think you saw then, Owen?" gasped Horatio, as,
+chancing to fix his gaze on the other, he noticed him suddenly
+elevate his gun, as though tempted to shoot the same.
+
+Owen chuckled.
+
+"It was only a frisky rabbit, after all," he announced calmly enough.
+"I was just covering him to find out how easy I could nail the
+rascal, if only I was out hunting game instead of a lost boy. And
+we'd have had rabbit stew at the Dugdale home to-morrow, let me tell
+you, Horatio, if I'd cared to let fly, for I had him covered
+handsomely."
+
+"Well, please don't do it in a hurry again, Owen," asked Horatio,
+settling back once more, and hoping his throbbing heart might not
+beat so loudly that any of his comrades could hear it pounding
+against his ribs. "Remember this is no ordinary patch of woods we're
+in right now. All sorts of stories have been told concerning the
+country up here; and in passing through after nightfall we're doing
+what a big bribe couldn't tempt any farmer's help to try. But, Hugh,
+don't you think we must be getting pretty near that place by this
+time?"
+
+"Just about two-thirds of the way, Horatio," he was informed. "That
+leaning tree we passed is exactly three hundred and thirty-seven
+paces from the place we left the road."
+
+"Well, what do you think of that for looking ahead, fellows!"
+ejaculated Horatio. "Hugh here took all the trouble to count the
+steps while passing through, the day he came up to examine the
+ground. That's what I call preparedness, and I guess it counts in a
+race, just as much as in getting ready for war."
+
+Hugh laughed as though momentarily amused.
+
+"Well, they're both in the same category, Horatio, if you look at
+things from the right point of view; rival armies and rival athletes
+contending for the prize which in both cases would mean victory.
+Looking ahead is a useful hobby, and it's served me handsomely on
+many an occasion. I consider no time wasted that is employed to
+insure success; even if you never need the information you've picked
+up it adds to your stock of knowledge; and no fellow can have too big
+a fund of that."
+
+"Then we ought soon to be getting there, at this rate," continued
+Horatio. "Let's hope nothing happens to our old car. We'd have a
+jolly walk back to town if we broke down here and couldn't fix
+things. I'd prefer making a fire and spending the night in the woods
+to taking such a tramp, which would debar us from all hope of making
+that big run to-morrow."
+
+"With K. K. out of the game the chances for Scranton High begin to
+flicker some," admitted Julius. "He was showing unusual stamina
+right now, and secretly I was backing K. K. to bring home the bacon
+for our school. Of course, with Hugh and Horatio and 'Just' Smith
+still in the ring it isn't hopeless by any means; but they do say
+those Allandale chaps have unearthed several wonders at long-distance
+running, and they are dying to knock Scranton down this time."
+
+Again Hugh stopped the car and bade the others listen.
+
+"It isn't that I thought I heard anything suspicious, fellows," he
+went on to explain, when they manifested a certain amount of
+excitement; "but, on general principles, I think we ought to stop
+oftener, and find out if there's anything doing."
+
+After testing their combined hearing to the limit, and without any
+success, Hugh again started up. It was Thad who spoke next, and
+apparently he had been considering something that he would like to
+have made clear.
+
+"What if we pass all the way through to the other road, without
+learning a single thing, Hugh?" he went on to say; "do you mean to
+give it up, and head for home then and there?"
+
+"Well, I should hope not, Thad!" burst out Horatio; "we're none of us
+built that way. Because a fellow gets a single knock-down in a fight
+ought he to throw up the sponge right away, and own himself beaten?
+Why, we started out to find K. K., and sleep isn't going to visit my
+eyes this night until we succeed. That's the way I look at it, and I
+reckon the rest of you are in the same boat."
+
+"If such a thing should happen, Thad," said Hugh, sturdily, "we'll
+simply turn around and come back again; only, under the new
+conditions, some of you will have to turn out with the lanterns, and
+search alongside the road as we go slowly along."
+
+Horatio gave a gasp that was plainly audible.
+
+"Do you really mean, Hugh," he went on to ask, in a voice that
+trembled more or less despite Horatio's effort to control the same,
+"that you half expect to find K. K. lying alongside the road, either
+dead, or else insensible from the pain of his broken leg?"
+
+"Well, I wasn't just thinking things would be as bad as all that,"
+Hugh hastened to say. "What I had in mind was the chance of coming
+on his footprints, and then trying to follow the same. We could
+easily tell them, for K. K. had on his running shoes, you remember.
+By tracking him, step by step, don't you see, we could tell just
+where he met with his trouble, even find out, perhaps, the nature of
+his accident, and continue to follow him up."
+
+"That would suit me first rate," said Julius, promptly; "and my fine
+electric hand-torch might come into play with a vengeance. There's
+nothing better going for following a trail in the dark, because the
+light is focussed, you see, on a small compass. Why, you can pick up
+night-walkers like everything when the fishing season's on, by using
+a flashlight. I could even find a needle in a haystack, I believe,
+with one of these jim-dandy contraptions."
+
+"All right, Julius, we'll appoint you head tracker, then," chuckled
+Horatio. "But, after all, perhaps we'll run across our comrade yet,
+before we get out of this tangle. We're about to come to the most
+critical point of the entire trip, remember, for the old quarry is
+just ahead of us."
+
+Horatio chanced to be on the side of the car toward the quarry. He
+was not spending nearly so much time now looking ahead, leaving that
+task to his chums; even while talking he kept his eyes fixed upon the
+dark expanse that represented the surrounding woods, anticipating
+catching a glimpse of something, he hardly knew what, at any moment
+now. Doubtless all those silly yarns retailed by the ignorant
+gossiping farm-hands in the market-place in Scranton, while they
+tried to outdo one another in matching fairy stories, must have been
+circulating through Horatio's brain just then. The heavy atmosphere
+of the deserted stone quarry, and its lonely surroundings, added to
+the mysterious disappearance of K. K., combined to make him
+peculiarly susceptible to such influences as see ghosts in every
+white object that moves in the darkness.
+
+This being the case with the Juggins boy it was not to be wondered at
+that there could be traced a vein of actual gratification in his
+voice when he suddenly electrified his companions by exclaiming:
+
+"Hugh! fellows, I tell you I saw it right then, just as that Swanson
+farmhand vowed to me he did once on a time this last summer--it was a
+light, waved up and down, back and forth, and just like they teach
+you when you join the Signal Corps, and learn how to wigwag with a
+flag or a lantern. It came from right over yonder, where we all know
+the old quarry lies! And I'm not fooling, either; cross my heart if
+I am!"
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XV
+
+PROWLING AROUND THE QUARRY
+
+Everybody was staring hard by the time Horatio finished. Hugh, of
+course, had immediately stopped the car on the road, so that they
+were now stationary.
+
+It chanced that the spot was one of few where a glimpse of the quarry
+could be picked up, as the boys had discovered at the time they
+passed along this way, when we overtook them on their nutting trip.
+
+Seconds crept past.
+
+Each boy could measure time by the beating of his wildly accelerated
+heart, and as these were throbbing at the rate of something like a
+hundred pulsations per minute it can be easily understood that
+"things were going some," to quote Horatio, when afterwards telling
+the story.
+
+Then all of them saw what the first discoverer had attempted to
+describe. They stared as though fascinated. Truly Horatio had said
+well when he spoke of the odd movements of the mysterious light; for
+it moved swiftly up and down, then sideways, and in eccentric
+circles, after which it vanished as suddenly as it had come into
+being.
+
+Some of the boys sighed, as though being wakened from a dream.
+Horatio, of course, was full of deepest gratification, since he had
+detected a skeptical air in the actions of Thad and Owen, which
+seemed to place him in the light of one who "saw things where none
+existed."
+
+"There, didn't I tell you?" he exclaimed, triumphantly. "And, say,
+wasn't that--eh, party, whoever he might be, making some sort of
+telegraphic signals with his old lantern or torch?"
+
+"Hugh, what do you think?" demanded Thad. "You're up in all that
+kind of wigwag signal work, and perhaps now you could tell what it
+means."
+
+"I lost some of it, I'm sorry to say, fellows," observed Hugh,
+gravely; "but all the same I caught enough to tell me that waving of
+a light was meant as a signal message, though who sent it, and to
+whom, is all a mystery."
+
+"But could you make out enough of the message, Hugh, to give you any
+idea what it stood for?" persisted Thad.
+
+"Yes, I believe I did," the other admitted, solemnly, so that each of
+his chums bent closer to catch the next words that fell from his
+lips. "I'm certain it spelled out the word 'help,' for one; and I
+thought another was 'quick'!"
+
+"Oh! what do you think of that?" gasped Horatio.
+
+"The mystery deepens," added Owen, dramatically, just as he had
+probably been accustomed to reading in some story of excitement.
+
+"Of course," continued Hugh, immediately, "we've got to take a look
+around that same old quarry, and see what's going on. Somebody's
+holding the fort there, even if it is said to be deserted. Who and
+what he can be, of course, remains to be seen; but I'm not taking a
+bit of stock in those old wives' yarns about a ghost, remember,
+Horatio."
+
+"Then we'll have to leave the car on the road, won't we, Hugh, when
+we tackle this big job?" questioned Owen.
+
+"Of course; and since I marked the best spot where anyone could make
+their way along to the face of the quarry, we must start up again,
+and keep moving till we strike that place."
+
+"But, Hugh, do you think the--er--party making those signals with a
+light could have noticed our illumination, and that message was meant
+for us?" Horatio went on to ask, solicitously.
+
+"I'm not prepared to say," he was told, "though I don't see how
+anybody with eyes could miss discovering us coming along. And,
+besides, the old car makes plenty of noise in the bargain, to attract
+attention. So it looks as if he did know, and was trying to talk to
+us."
+
+All this only added to the thrill that was forever passing through
+each and every member of the night expedition. It would be
+manifestly impossible to describe their mixed feelings as they
+advanced slowly along the rough road so long abandoned to nature. A
+dozen times Horatio believed he heard cries; why, it seemed as though
+the air must be filled with uncanny sounds, for his lively
+imagination was working at race-horse speed just then.
+
+The car stopped short.
+
+"Wow! what's happened now, Hugh?" whispered Horatio.
+
+"We've arrived at the getting-out place, that's all," came the steady
+reply, as the chauffeur caused the engine to cease working and then
+proceeded to leave his seat, after his companion had jumped out.
+
+The lanterns were now lighted and the electric torch made ready for
+use. If hands trembled considerably during this operation, causing
+several matches to be used before the desired results were obtained,
+could anyone blame Owen and the other possessor of a lantern? It was
+a most remarkable thing that no one evinced the slightest disposition
+to stay by the car, and guard it against thieves. It was a case of
+"follow the leader," and where Hugh went they were all bound to go
+also. To be honest, the chances were that Horatio, for one, could
+not have been coaxed to separate himself from the company of his four
+chums; because there was a great deal of truth in that old maxim, "in
+union there is strength."
+
+Hugh now led the way. He had been given one of the lanterns with
+which to light a passage across the heaps of broken stones, earth,
+and rubbish, cast there at the time in the remote past when the
+quarry was in full blast, with workmen delving into the hillside,
+blasting away sections through the use of dynamite or powder, and
+sending out many wagon-loads of building-stone each of the six
+working days of the week.
+
+They did not string out in single file, but kept bunched together.
+Indeed, this came through no accident, but there was a method in
+their madness; because, you see, no fellow would want to be the
+hindmost in the file.
+
+Hugh showed a wonderful amount of knowledge of the place, considering
+that he had never before in his life placed a foot upon the ground
+and had to depend entirely on his former observations. But he kept
+on as straight as could be expected, and presently Owen managed to
+muster up courage enough to say in a low and most carefully guarded
+tone:
+
+"Hugh, did you take note of the _exact_ spot where the light showed
+up? I'm asking because you seem to be heading direct for somewhere."
+
+"I believe I know where it was," Hugh told him simply. "You see, I
+noted several things about the face of the quarry that day we stopped
+to look it over; and when I saw that dancing trail of fire I figured
+out that it must be at just such a place, which spot I'm heading for
+right now. And just as you spoke I had ample proof that I was right
+in my guess."
+
+"Why, what happened, Hugh?" demanded Horatio eagerly.
+
+"I caught a faint glimpse of light up there," Hugh told him. "I
+wonder none of the rest of you happened to notice the same. It made
+me think that some person might be in one of those holes we saw in
+the face of the wall--caves, the natives call them, Horatio says. As
+this was somewhat deep only a tiny bit of illumination escaped, and
+you could just detect that when at a certain angle. Stop short, now,
+and see for yourselves, for there it is again!"
+
+Thrilled to the bone they stood and gaped. Hugh was pointing with
+his disengaged hand, half holding the lantern back of him so that its
+glow might not further interfere with their view.
+
+"You're right, Hugh; that's surely what it is," agreed Thad, almost
+immediately; and each of the other three went on record with a
+corresponding affirmative.
+
+"Then the next thing for us to do is to find some way of climbing up
+to that same fissure," the leader explained, showing that he meant to
+lose no time in trying to open negotiations with the unknown denizens
+of the quarry, whose actions were becoming more and more mysterious
+as time passed.
+
+"Which means that we're going to beard the tiger in his den," quoth
+Owen, gripping his gun more firmly as he edged a little closer to
+Hugh; for since he was the only member of the expedition who could be
+said to possess a weapon it was proper that he should be found in the
+van at such a crisis.
+
+They walked on, not hastily, and showing no outward sign of the
+tumult that must have raged in each boyish heart. Now it was no
+longer possible for them to discern that faint glow; but such a
+little thing did not daunt them. Hugh had marked well the exact
+location of their objective point, and Hugh seldom made mistakes,
+those other confident fellows were telling themselves as they
+cheerfully trudged along.
+
+The foot of the cliff was at hand. Rains and winds and snow
+avalanches had, during the years that had passed since the hands of
+men worked those diggings, served to cut loose great quantities of
+debris from the face of the height, so that here and there at the
+foot irregular pyramids of earth and rocks could be seen. Hugh now
+seemed to have turned his attention from above and was bending half
+over, as though examining the ground. Owen knew what this meant.
+The other anticipated finding a track leading directly to the route
+by means of which that cavern halfway up the cliff might be easiest
+attained.
+
+And, as often happens, such reasoning proved to be the wisest thing
+the searchers could have undertaken, for hardly had half a minute
+elapsed than Hugh was heard to give vent to a low ejaculation of
+gratification.
+
+No one spoke, but they understood that he had found the trail he was
+looking for. Indeed, he at once started to move along, still bending
+over, and holding his lighted lantern low, so that its none too good
+illumination would best serve him.
+
+Now they reached a sort of strange little gully, where the silt had
+washed down more heavily during the period of erosion than at any
+other place. Looking up, the boys could see that it afforded a steep
+but accessible avenue by means of which an agile person could ascend
+the otherwise impregnable height towering above their heads.
+
+Hugh halted not, but started up. Owen came close behind him, holding
+that formidable shotgun so that he could thrust it ahead of his
+leader should an occasion arise necessitating action. But Hugh had
+already warned him not to be rash, and under no condition to dream of
+firing until he himself had given the order.
+
+It was a queer little procession that crept up that steep trail in
+the gully formed by Nature during the heavy storms of summer and
+winter. The twin lanterns glimmered and flickered as the night wind
+puffed the tiny blazes; and ahead of all lay the white glow of the
+electric hand-torch, showing them how they were now almost at the end
+of their trail.
+
+Yes, the fissure extended straight into the face of the cliff. Hugh
+was taking them directly to the place where undoubtedly the
+mysterious unknown had stood on a sort of rocky platform, and
+indulged in all those queer telegraphic code motions with a light of
+some sort.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVI
+
+A FRIENDLY GHOST
+
+Hugh led the way straight into the fissure. As they proceeded they
+could see the light ahead growing stronger. Low sounds, as of
+voices, also led them onward; and then, upon turning a bend, they
+came upon a sight that had them all staring with wonder.
+
+It was indeed a cave, and of considerable dimensions. A wild beast
+would have delighted in such a den in which to hide from the rigors
+of winter, but to boys accustomed to the luxuries of home life it
+would doubtless have few attractions, especially after the novelty of
+camping-out had worn off in a week's time.
+
+It was a fire that burned which gave the light. A pile of dry wood,
+mostly broken branches of dead trees, showed that the occupant of the
+cave had laid in a supply against a rainy day.
+
+There, sitting with his back against the wall, was their missing
+comrade K. K. His face looked unusually white, and bore an
+expression of acute pain, which, however, he manfully tried from time
+to time to dismiss by a ghastly grin, altogether assumed, since he
+certainly was in no mood for laughing.
+
+They could see that his left leg was bandaged in some manner, as
+though he might have broken the bones, and someone had tried to bind
+up the limb. Even with that superficial glance Hugh marked the fact
+that this had been done in a fashion indicating considerable previous
+experience along such lines.
+
+And then they turned their attention upon the other party, the
+mysterious one who doubtless had found poor K. K. helpless on the
+ground and borne him to this cavern in the quarry. He was indeed a
+wild-looking party, with long, unkempt hair and a sunburnt face in
+which his glowing eyes were deep-seated. There was that about him to
+convince Hugh instantly he must be deranged, although just then the
+man bent over poor K. K. solicitously, and seemed to be tenderly
+doing something calculated to ease his pain.
+
+Hugh coughed, meaning to draw attention to the fact of their arrival.
+The man immediately stood up and bent a searching look upon the five
+lads. Perhaps he had been hearing K. K. tell how some of his chums
+would certainly be coming to search for him, and, therefore, even
+though he might wish to remain in his hidden retreat undisturbed, he
+manifested no hostility toward them, simply folded his arms and,
+stepping back, watched their approach.
+
+Hugh made gestures to indicate that they were peacefully disposed.
+In doing so he purposely used the signal code and spelled out the one
+word, "friend." He saw the wildman's thin face take on a sudden
+gleam of awakened interest, and he nodded his head in the
+affirmative, as if to reassure Hugh that they were not unwelcome.
+From this the boy knew the stranger must at some time have been in
+the army, and that even while his brain was resting under a cloud he
+could still send and receive messages such as had been at one time
+his daily avocation.
+
+They reached the side of their unfortunate companion. He held out a
+hand to welcome Hugh.
+
+"Oh! I'm mighty glad you've come, fellows, I can tell you," he told
+them, with a tremor in his voice. "I've had a rotten time of it all
+around, and suffered terribly. You see, I made a fool of myself, and
+tripped over a vine, so that I was thrown into a gully, with my left
+leg under me. Snapped both bones, he says, just above the ankle, and
+a fine time I've got ahead of me this winter, with no skating,
+hockey, or anything worth living for. But then it might have been
+worse, because my neck is worth more to me than my ankle. But now I
+do hope you can get me home. I never wanted to see home and mother
+one-half as much as now."
+
+"Yes, we've come in the big car, K. K.," Hugh assured him. "And
+we'll fetch you home right away. You ought to be looked after by
+Doctor Wambold; broken bones are not things to be trifled with, and
+while this party seems to have done the best he could it can only be
+a makeshift."
+
+"Don't you believe it, Hugh," said the injured boy warmly; "why, he's
+a regular jim-dandy about such jobs. I bet you he used to be an army
+surgeon in his younger days, from hints he's let drop. And then he
+knows the Signal Corps work right off the handle to boot, even
+if--well, I won't say what I meant to. He's been so kind and
+considerate to me; my own father couldn't have been more tender.
+I've guessed the secret of the old haunted quarry, Hugh!" which last
+he almost whispered in the other's ear.
+
+"Yes, I can say the same," muttered Hugh, "because, as soon as I saw
+that he was using the regular army code of signals, I remembered
+about hearing how a certain family over near Hackensack had an uncle
+who used to be in the Signal Corps and was also later on an army
+surgeon, but who had suffered a sunstroke, and, well, was said to be
+a bit queer."
+
+"Yes," whispered K. K., "this is the same party. His name, I
+remember, was Dr. Coursens, and there was some talk last summer about
+his having got loose from the house and being drowned, they believed,
+in the river, though his body was never found. Just to think of it,
+he's been hiding here ever since, picking up his living almost like a
+wild animal. Why, right now his clothes are nearly falling off his
+back, and if he tries to hang out here much longer he'll be frozen to
+death. But, Hugh, we must let his folks know where he is so they can
+come after him. I believe, his mind is beginning to get a little
+clear again, for at times he talks quite reasonably."
+
+This was all mighty interesting to Hugh, and he determined that he
+would let no grass grow under his feet until he had seen to it that
+the man with the deranged mind was once more restored to his family.
+But the first thing to be done was to get poor K. K. safely back home.
+
+So he turned to the man and spoke to him, telling him that they
+wished to get their comrade to the car, and at the same time thanking
+him warmly for all he had done. Not a single word in reply did Hugh
+receive. The man listened and nodded his head, as though he could
+dimly understand what the boy was saying. Evidently he was in
+something of a dazed condition, if, as K. K. affirmed, his senses
+were beginning to assume a normal condition after years of darkness.
+
+It was a terrible job getting K. K. down from that elevated place.
+The man showed them how best to manage. He seemed really solicitous,
+and it could be seen that he had taken quite a liking to K. K. during
+their brief intercourse, since the latter had been found groaning on
+the ground.
+
+Eventually the level below the cliff was attained. Poor K. K. had
+groaned many times, hard though he fought to repress the sounds, for
+it was unavoidable that he should receive many jostlings while being
+transferred to the lower level.
+
+Then they made their way across the open space, and finally arrived
+at the waiting car, in which the injured youth was deposited and made
+as comfortable as the conditions allowed. The deranged man watched
+all this with a wistful gleam in his eye. He had fled from his kind
+while still gripped in the darkness of madness, but with the first
+glimmer of reason being seated once more on its throne he commenced
+to yearn after human fellowship again.
+
+Since the boys had all taken such a deep-seated interest in the
+matter it may be proper before the "ghost" of the haunted quarry is
+dropped altogether from the story to state that the very next morning
+Hugh went over to Hackensack and electrified the Coursen family with
+certain remarkable news he brought. It ended in their all starting
+forth and arriving at the quarry. They found the demented man
+awaiting their coming as though he had guessed what Hugh had in his
+mind. More than that he greeted them soberly, and called each member
+of the family by name, something he had not been able to do since
+that dark cloud descended upon his mind years back.
+
+There seemed reason to believe that in due time Doctor Coursen might
+regain his full senses again and spend a few years more with his
+delighted relatives before the end came.
+
+Hugh, of course, learned all about him and how he had served years in
+the army, first as a sergeant in the Signal Corps, and later on
+becoming a surgeon of considerable reputation before the accident in
+the tropics deprived him of his reason. Perhaps it had been the
+utterly helpless condition of poor K. K., when he came accidentally
+upon the injured boy, that had strongly appealed to the surgical
+spirit that still lay dormant in the brain and fingers of the insane
+man and which had been the main cause of the light of reason
+returning--surgery had been his passion, and the familiar work took
+him back to other days, apparently.
+
+And that very night, when Doctor Cadmus, hastily summoned to the home
+of Mrs. Kinkaid, examined the work of the deranged dweller of the
+quarry cave, he had pronounced it simply marvelous the clever way in
+which the other had set those bones and put a splint on the leg, with
+such clumsy means for working at hand. He declared he meant to
+interest himself deeply in the case and see if such a skillful
+surgeon might not be restored to the world so much in need of his
+kind, with the terrible war raging on the other side of the Atlantic.
+
+To conclude with this subject, at last accounts Dr. Coursen had so
+far recovered as to send in his application for a berth in some
+hospital over in France, where his wonderful knowledge of surgery
+might prove useful to the countless wounded men at the front. And
+doubtless ere this reaches the eye of the reader he may be across the
+Atlantic, serving humanity in the great cause.
+
+Long would those five lads remember that strange expedition up to the
+haunted quarry, and what a remarkable discovery they made after
+arriving on the ground. It may be that Horatio, yes, and Julius
+also, would be less apt to clothe anything along a mysterious nature
+with ghostly attributes, after learning how common-sense and
+investigation will, in nearly all cases, turn suspicion into
+ridicule. But while the country folks, of course, also learned how
+the phantom of the quarry had turned out to be just a crazy man who
+had escaped from his confinement at home and gone back to primeval
+ways of living, few of them would ever muster up the courage to visit
+the deserted quarry after nightfall. It had too many thrilling
+associations to please them; and besides, what was the use of going
+out of their way just to feel the "goose-flesh" creep over their
+bodies when an owl hooted, or some little forest animal gave a grunt?
+
+K. K., being young and healthy, and attended carefully by good old
+Doctor Cadmus, was not confined to the house for many weeks. The
+bones did not require resetting, and rapidly knitted, so that after a
+while he could walk to and from school with the aid of a crutch; and
+later this, in turn, gave way to a cane. When February came he even
+threw this aid aside, and by March was seen taking his part in school
+rushes, as though he had never been injured at all. But his skates
+were never once used all winter, nor could he indulge in any
+sledding, both of which were favorite pleasures with K. K.
+
+On the whole, however, he felt that he had much to be thankful for;
+and tried not to be too greatly disappointed. But his chums would
+miss him when the Marathon race was on; because he had been accounted
+one of the best long-distance runners without exception that Scranton
+High could boast.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVII
+
+SCRANTON'S "OPEN-HOUSE" DAY
+
+Saturday opened with a promise of fair weather, and thousands of
+anxious hearts beat high with satisfaction when this important fact
+became manifest.
+
+Before the morning was half over many strangers were noticed in town,
+having taken the day off in order to attend the wonderful meet, of
+which so much had been said. Every boy in Scranton was wild-eyed,
+and on the run most of the time, trying to be here, there, and in
+half a dozen places at once, if such a thing were possible.
+
+Indeed, there was so much going on it reminded some people of the
+famous circus that visited the town two years back, with three
+separate rings, and something taking place in each at the same time;
+so that the spectators hardly knew how to take it all in and keep
+from being cross-eyed.
+
+Out at the athletic grounds there were crowds gathered. Men were
+working at the fence, while another gang, under the orders of Mr.
+Leonard, carefully put in place such paraphernalia as would be needed
+in carrying out the programme. Even the big pole had been well
+greased for the climbing match; while the hurdles for the obstacle
+race were ready to be placed in position at the proper time; and a
+thousand and one other matters engaged the attention of the physical
+director, who was probably the most industrious man in seven counties
+that Saturday A.M.
+
+Nor was that all. Some of the would-be contestants, not wholly
+satisfied with their record for proficiency, and wishing to key
+themselves up to top-notch speed against the now near hour of trial,
+were on the ground, and in their working togs. Here a bunch galloped
+swiftly around the cinder path, with one of their number holding the
+watch on them to ascertain what time they made. Further along
+several other fellows were jumping with might and main, and showing
+either jubilation or deep chagrin as they found themselves able to do
+a shade better than ever before, or else going backward in their
+scoring.
+
+Indeed, that was going to be a red-letter day in the lives of all
+Scranton's young people. They begrudged the passing minutes, because
+their period of enjoyment would be shortened just so much with the
+loss of every sixty seconds.
+
+When Hugh came on the grounds, after his trip to Hackensack, and
+seeing the hermit of the quarry once more safely lodged in the bosom
+of his delighted family, he had only one regret. This was the fact
+that poor K. K., whose heart had been so set on carrying the colors
+of Scranton High to victory in the Marathon race, should be debarred
+from participating in the same by a cruel fate.
+
+As for himself Hugh was not quite so certain as before that he could
+accomplish such a thing as getting over those fifteen miles ahead of
+all competitors. What he had gone through with on the preceding day,
+coupled with his night journey, and only partial rest, after getting
+in bed at a late hour, had sapped some of his energy.
+
+But Hugh's grit and determination were just as strong as ever, and he
+meant to do his level best. If he fell down, why, there were "Just"
+Smith, and Horatio Juggins, as well as two other Scranton fellows,
+any one of whom might be the winner. So long as the prize fell to a
+Scranton High boy, it mattered little who carried off the honors,
+Hugh felt.
+
+Noon came at last.
+
+Everything was now ready for the opening of the athletic tournament.
+Chief Wambold kept watch and ward over the grounds, assisted by his
+entire force of uniformed men. He evidently did not intend that any
+boy, with a mind that turned to practical joking, should have a
+chance to exercise his evil propensities unchecked. Should such a
+thing be attempted the joker would find himself up against a snag
+immediately; and, as those posters announced, he was going to be
+harshly dealt with up to the "extreme penalty of the law."
+
+There were hundreds of people on the grounds at noon, which was a
+pretty good marker for the immense crowds that would soon be heading
+that way from every point of the compass. Most of these "early
+birds" were, of course, out-of-town folks, farmers' families that had
+come in, to market, perhaps, and they stayed over to see the great
+show, because everybody living for many miles around Scranton had
+heard about the meet, and and what a wonderful sight it would be,
+well worth going miles to gaze upon. These thrifty and sensible
+folks had, in many cases, brought their lunch along with them.
+Perhaps they disliked the idea of eating in small restaurants, such
+as Scranton, like most towns, boasted; but, no doubt, the main thing
+was economy in these times of scanty cash and inflated war prices.
+
+It was well worth watching when they started to open their packages,
+and spread out the contents on the ground or, as might be, on the
+benches where they had taken up their positions the better to see
+what went on. And really it would have made any boy's mouth water to
+note the immense quantities of home-made pies, doughnuts, fried
+chicken, and all such good things as were displayed in those farmer's
+wives lunch packets. At least there must be no sign of hard times
+when the family went on a picnic, or any other sort of pleasure jaunt.
+
+By then the crowds began to assemble in earnest. Town people,
+fearing a crush, hastened to leave home with the lunch dishes
+unwashed, and look for places to sit during the long afternoon.
+Along the roads every type of car, wagon, carriage, and other styles
+of equipages began to be seen, all heading toward the center of
+interest, which was the town of Scranton.
+
+Hundreds came from Allandale; indeed, it might be safe to even say
+thousands, for in every direction could be seen the colors of
+Allandale High, just as though each enthusiastic boy and girl had
+rounded up all their relatives and friends, and induced them to make
+it a point to travel to the neighboring borough, there to shout and
+shriek, and in other ways lend encouragement to each Allandale
+aspirant for athletic honors wherever they showed up.
+
+Belleville, too, must look very much like the "Deserted Village" on
+this particular afternoon; and, if the amount of business done
+depended on the few who had remained at home, her merchants would
+have to stay up until midnight in order to equal their customary
+Saturday sales.
+
+At half-past twelve the throng had become so dense that Chief Wambold
+and his men were compelled to enlist the services of a number of
+willing volunteers who, temporarily decorated with a silver shield,
+were vested with the authority of regular officers, in order to keep
+avenues open, and prevent the throng from breaking through the ropes
+upon the limited field where the athletes expected to compete.
+
+So far as attendance was concerned there was no longer the least
+doubt but that the meet would prove an abounding success; the rest
+remained to be proven. But the gathering athletes who began to
+appear in little knots, coming from the dressing rooms of the
+building, seemed full of confidence, and answered the loud salutes of
+a myriad of friends in the crowd with reassuring nods, and gestures
+calculated to buoy up their hopes.
+
+The programme would be varied. First would come several short
+sprints between the best runners of hundred-yard distances in the
+county. These were sure to key up the spectators by their thrilling
+intensity, as is always the case. Following fast upon these there
+would be hammer-throwing, and the toss of the discus. Then the
+programme called for other athletic exhibitions along a line that
+would lend variety, and enhance the interest, as the different
+schools struggled for supremacy in the arena provided, spurred on to
+do their utmost by ringing cheers, and the dearly beloved class songs.
+
+Everybody worth mentioning in Scranton would be there, from Dr.
+Carmack, the supervising head of the county schools, as well as
+principal of Scranton High, down the line to the Directors of the
+Games, the town council, the mayors of the three boroughs, and a
+whole host of notables besides.
+
+And how the fond eyes of father and mother would follow the movements
+of John, or Edward, or Philip, as though he might be the only young
+athlete worth watching in all that animated scene. If he won, they
+had always known he did not have an equal in his specialty; and
+should he be so unlucky as to come in at the heels of the pack, why,
+it was easy to be seen that he had not been given a square deal by
+some of the rival runners, who persisted in getting in his way, and
+were probably leagued together to prevent him from carrying off the
+prize. But no matter, he would always be a hero in the eyes of those
+who loved him, though he might not decorate the family mantel at home
+with the prizes he aspired to win.
+
+Hugh had kept fairly quiet after returning from Hackensack, and
+seeing the hermit once more safe in the charge of his folks. He knew
+that he must conserve his strength for the great undertaking that
+confronted him that afternoon. Those who had entered for the
+long-distance race would not be allowed, of course, to participate in
+any other event; that had been laid down as law by Mr. Leonard when
+they entered their names on the list of candidates. They must
+simply stand around and watch what was going on until the time came
+for staging the Marathon; when they could take their place in the
+long string that would await the pistol shot intended to start them
+on the telling grind.
+
+Horatio and "Just" Smith were on deck, looking fit and eager. Then,
+too, there was Nick Lang, with a grin on his heavy face every time he
+glanced toward the other three fellows. It was getting on, and some
+of the earlier events had already been carried through, amidst great
+roars of applause as the different prizes went, this one to an
+Allandale fellow, another to a boy wearing the Belleville High
+colors; and three in succession to local lads.
+
+"I don't exactly like the way that Nick Lang keeps on laughing to
+himself every time he looks over in this direction," Horatio was
+saying to the other two.
+
+"I've noticed the same thing," spoke up "Just" Smith; "and it makes
+me wonder if the tricky fellow hasn't got some slick game up his
+sleeve, as usual, looking to giving the rest of us trouble. You
+notice, don't you, boys, that, look as you will, you can't see
+anything of either that Tip Slavin, or Leon Disney. Now, when
+fellows who are as fond of outdoor sports as those two have always
+been, keep shy when such a great event as this meet is being pulled
+off, there must be a pretty good reason."
+
+"They may be somewhere in the crowd," Hugh went on to say, "because
+it'd be impossible for any single fellow to identify all that are in
+that solid heaving yelling mass of people. Nick believes he has a
+fair chance of leading the pack, and that makes him feel happy. I
+heard him say only yesterday that the one fellow he was afraid of in
+our whole bunch was K. K.; and now that accident has eliminated him,
+why, naturally, Nick feels more confidence. In imagination he's
+already receiving the grand Marathon prize, and hearing the crowds
+yelling themselves hoarse."
+
+"Well," snorted Horatio, gritting his teeth in a way he had when
+aroused, "if that's what pleases Nick he's got another guess coming;
+for three of us are also in the game; and he's got to do some mighty
+tall sprinting in that last half-mile if he expects to win out. Then
+there are a lot of other fellows in the run who may give him a pain.
+But, according to the programme, our race comes next after this pole
+vaulting contest; so, boys, we'd better be moving around, and getting
+our place in line, according to our several numbers."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVIII
+
+THE GREAT MARATHON RACE
+
+It was plainly noticeable how that vast crowd began to stir, and show
+signs of increased interest when the numerous trim runners entered
+for the big Marathon started to gather for the preliminary stage of
+the race.
+
+Each of the many contestants had a large number fastened upon both
+the front and back of his thin upper garment. By these they might be
+recognized even at a distance; and many persons carried field or
+opera glasses of various types just on purpose to make out who each
+runner was when he came in sight around the bend half a mile away, to
+open on that last stretch that was likely to see the cruelest work of
+all, if the competition chanced to be keen.
+
+The boys, as a rule, looked very much like lithe grayhounds, for your
+natural runner is light of body, and can course along like the wind.
+Still, this applies more to short-distance sprinters than those whose
+specialty is endurance in a fifteen- or twenty-mile race.
+
+Several of the fellows were quite muscular in build, and gave
+evidence of a grim determination such as the bulldog possesses.
+These chaps might be easily distanced in the start, but they would
+keep doggedly on, under the spur of the knowledge contained in that
+old adage that "the race is not always to the swift."
+
+Hugh Morgan was, perhaps, the best built of them all, neither too
+heavy, nor yet betraying a weakness that would crop out after the
+first five miles had been covered, as might be the case with the more
+slender fellows.
+
+They stood in line, listening to the last words of caution delivered
+by Mr. Hitchens, a former Yale man who had umpired the baseball games
+the preceding summer in such an impartial manner that everyone had
+the utmost reliance on his fairness.
+
+He explained to them the simple conditions of the race,--how there
+must be no fouling of any kind; just how often and where the
+contestants must register their names in books kept by judges on the
+course; how each was supposed to give his word of honor not to accept
+any sort of lift for even a dozen feet; and that the great crowd
+assembled would be waiting to acclaim the first-comer as the victor
+in the greatest long-distance race ever attempted by high-school
+boys, at least in that particular county.
+
+They were allowed a certain latitude as to their methods of running.
+If any of them could cut across lots, and still cover the entire
+course, as well as register faithfully wherever required, that was to
+be their option.
+
+Having finished his little fatherly talk, the referee stepped to one
+side, and gave the word for the runners to make ready.
+
+Every eye was glued on this or that contestant, according to the
+humor of the spectator. Each Allandale visitor saw only Allandale in
+that long line, swaying back and forth a trifle, like a reed shaken
+in the wind. They could not believe it possible that any other
+fellow had the slightest chance of coming in ahead of those
+fleet-footed boys upon whose ability they pinned their full trust.
+
+So it was with the Belleville rooters; while, of course, the natives
+were certain the prize was already as good as won by Hugh Morgan; or,
+it might happen to be, Horatio Juggins, "Just" Smith, or possibly
+Nick Lang, the last-named looking ever so confident, as he leaned
+over nearly double in his favorite crouch, his fingertips in contact
+with the ground, and his knees bent.
+
+Then came the sharp report of the pistol.
+
+"They're off!" involuntarily exclaimed a thousand persons in unison,
+as the line of nimble runners was seen to leap into action, and shoot
+away with amazing speed.
+
+There were a few little lively brushes in the start, before the
+runners settled down to real business. Some were immediately left
+behind, but this fact seemed to give them little concern, for they
+kept jogging away as though quite happy.
+
+Doubtless, a number had entered with no idea of covering more than a
+few miles of the long course. They just enjoyed the excitement, and
+the honor of being able to say they had once run in a fifteen-mile
+schoolboy Marathon race.
+
+After a bit these novices would drop out, perhaps even hasten back
+with various clever excuses for giving up; and having gained the
+cheers of their particular coterie of friends they could don a few
+more clothes to keep off the chill, and settle back to watch the rest
+of the entertainment. Their opinion would naturally be much sought
+after, as to the chances of this or that genuine contestant; which
+was one of the things they desired.
+
+As it takes considerable time for even fleet-footed runners to go
+over a fifteen-mile course, the sensible committee, who knew just
+about how long the crowd would have to wait, had provided plenty of
+amusement meanwhile.
+
+Interspersed with a number of minor events, such as further sprinting
+matches for younger entries, and some more pole vaulting, as well as
+Indian club exhibitions of skill, would come the humorous features of
+the meet.
+
+These are always popular with the country people; indeed, nearly
+everybody seems to welcome them as a diversion calculated to raise
+hearty laughter.
+
+There was also keen competition even in the potato race; and the
+crowd yelled itself hoarse to see the antics of those who met with
+all manner of mishaps when engaged in the hurdle, and the obstacle
+affairs.
+
+The boys who had engaged to try for these prizes seemed to "get their
+dander up," as some fellow expressed it, and the way they struggled
+and vied with one another was "equal to a circus with a brass band."
+
+Although mention may not have been made of the fact up to now, the
+Scranton band was giving of its very best from time to time, and the
+air throbbed with martial music suitable to a country just then at
+war with a foreign nation. It was a fair sort of band in the
+bargain, and well worth listening to; so that the music really added
+greatly to the enjoyment of the occasion.
+
+When the three-legged race was pulled off the spectators howled their
+sympathy with this or that pair of contestants as they hopped along,
+now rolling on the ground while bound together, and, at times, even
+trying to creep in desperation, when it seemed as though a difference
+of opinions in the two minds trying to control what was just the same
+as one pair of legs, caused confusion, and a lack of progression.
+
+Later on came the climbing of the greased pole. This is always
+comical enough, and aroused much enthusiasm. Nobody seems to be a
+favorite, and each successful attempt to mount is greeted with
+shrieks of laughter. So long as a valiant fellow is seen to be
+steadily making his way upwards, inch by inch, he may be applauded;
+but let him display the slightest hint of having "shot his bolt," and
+begin to slip back again, howls of derision will greet his ears, so
+that in confusion he finally gives it up, and retires in haste.
+
+All sorts of small means are resorted to in order to allow the
+contestant to get a surer grip on the slippery pole; for, up to a
+certain point, these are allowable. One rubs sand in his hands, and
+for a brief time this seems to enable him to do splendid work; but
+then it soon wears away, and then his troubles begin; until, unable
+to make further progress, he is seen to glance over his shoulder to
+note how far from the ground he has risen. This is a sure sign of
+weakening, and, of course, the watchful crowd again roars at him to
+keep right on, that he's doing nobly, and all that; but John knows
+better, and so down he comes with a rush, and passes out, shaking his
+head in disgust and bitter disappointment; for possibly he had been
+within five feet of the top when his energies failed him.
+
+So the time went on, merrily enough.
+
+Many persons were declaring they had not enjoyed such an afternoon
+for years, and felt weak from so much laughter.
+
+Watches were being consulted more and more frequently now.
+
+"It's getting time we saw something of those chaps," could be heard
+here and there, showing that numbers had figured things out, or else
+received a tip from an authority in the game as to just how long it
+was likely to take a fleet runner to cover fifteen miles of good road.
+
+Anxious eyes were being strained unduly, watching the bend half a
+mile beyond. It could be seen from almost any part of the field,
+fortunately, though once the big board fence was in position, the
+view would be partly cut off.
+
+It had been arranged, as is always done, that when a runner was
+sighted nearing the bend a gun would be fired by the sentry on duty
+there, to attract the attention of the crowd, so that they might have
+the first glimpse of the leading contestants, as they rounded that
+abrupt curve where the view was shut off.
+
+There was now nothing going on in the arena, the entire programme
+having been carried out. Still, few, if any, left their seats,
+although they had been there for several hours, it might be. The
+deepest interest centered upon the completion of the Marathon race.
+In comparison to this exhibition of school-boy endurance and pluck
+the other affairs seemed to sink into insignificance; although at the
+time they occurred doubtless those who had friends entered were
+wildly excited. But then the race that has already been finished is
+never as intensely interesting as the one in process of being run;
+just as the fish landed never seems quite so wonderful as the fellow
+who is still swimming the waters, and eyeing the baited hook as
+though tempted to take a hazard.
+
+Seconds seemed fraught with undue importance, and many impatient
+fellows, upon consulting their watches, were seen to hold the same up
+to their ear, as though to make sure the time-piece had not stopped,
+so leaden-footed did the minutes seem to move along.
+
+Some of the girls had commenced to sing their class songs, but in a
+mild sort of way; for they did not wish to lose the sound that would
+denote that a runner was in sight at the second bend, and could be
+expected shortly to come into view at the head of the last half-mile
+strip of road leading to the goal.
+
+Once an engine on the railroad not far away gave a sharp whistle that
+thrilled everybody, and numberless eyes were glued on the point up
+the road where the first runner must appear. Then a general laugh
+ran around because of the false alarm.
+
+But everything must have an end, and that keen anxiety finally met
+with its reward. Plainly came the heavy boom of the waiting gun.
+Everyone craned his or her neck to see. Hearts beat quicker with
+eager anticipation. Which one of the thirty contestants would be the
+first to appear? There might be several in a bunch, primed for the
+final sprint for goal. The very thought thrilled hearts, and added
+color to cheeks, as well as made eyes sparkle with anticipation.
+Allandale was not cheering now; Belleville rooters were strangely
+quiet; for, so far, the outcome of the great race was still wrapped
+in mystery; but the solution would soon come, they knew.
+
+Another heavy boom told that a second runner was just around the
+bend, and when a third discharge quickly followed the crowd knew
+there was going to be an exciting finish to the Marathon.
+
+Then a plainly audible sigh broke forth as the first runner was seen
+rounding the bend, and starting on the home stretch, but wabbling
+badly as he ran, being almost completely exhausted.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIX
+
+ON THE FINAL MILE OF THE COURSE
+
+Meanwhile, in order to understand certain important events that came
+about, it is necessary that we follow the runners, and devote this
+chapter to what occurred up to the time that first fellow came
+lunging around the final bend, having covered the whole course up to
+the final lap.
+
+For a mile or so along the road there were bunches of schoolboys and
+girls waiting to give some of the contestants a cheering word as they
+flashed past. The enthusiasts, however, would not linger long, for
+they likely enough wished to see the comical part of the programme
+carried out. Besides, once the runners had straggled past their
+posts the only interest remaining for them in the race was its
+conclusion. So they would want to get back to the grounds, and
+secure positions along the line to the first bend, where they could
+greet each contestant as he appeared, and cheer him on; for he would
+probably need encouragement, being near the point of exhaustion.
+
+Hugh had figured things out exactly, and knew what he could do. He
+was not alarmed because several of the visiting runners led the way,
+and even "Just" Smith had quite a little lead over him.
+
+Pegging along, Hugh covered mile after mile with a steadiness that he
+had reduced to machine-like motion. He had timed himself, and the
+whole course was mentally charted for his guidance. If he reached
+the cut-off road at a certain time he would know things were moving
+just as swiftly as necessary. Those boys who strained themselves in
+that first seven miles would be apt to rue their rashness when they
+began to feel their legs quiver with weakness under them, and still
+miles remained to be covered ere the goal came in sight. And,
+besides, they were sure to be in no condition for a hot final sprint,
+in case of keen competition.
+
+So Hugh, having registered as required at two booths on the way, and
+thus learned the order in which the trio ahead of him seemed to be
+running, finally arrived at the sunken quarry road. He recognized
+the landmarks before he reached the spot; and losing not a second of
+time darted among the trees.
+
+"Just" Smith was still leading him, for here and there he could
+distinguish the other's footprints, where the ground chanced to be a
+little moist. Hugh also had reason to believe that Nick Lang was
+coming strong not a great distance behind him. He wondered whether
+Nick meant to take advantage of the old quarry road as well as he and
+"Just" Smith, and Horatio in the bargain. For that matter Hugh did
+not care an iota; if Nick considered it would be to his advantage he
+was at liberty to benefit by this scheme of Hugh's. It was all for
+the glory of Scranton High; and far better that Nick won the prize,
+than that it should be taken by an Allandale, or a Belleville
+contestant--that is, if he won it honestly.
+
+Apparently, on the face of the returns, when half of the fifteen-mile
+course had been run, the victory was likely to be carried off by
+Whipple, the fleet-winged Allandale chap who had played right field
+during the baseball matches; "Just" Smith; himself; or possibly Nick
+Lang. There was always a dim and remote possibility, however, of a
+dark horse forging to the front on the home stretch. This might be
+Horatio Juggins, or McKee, or perhaps that Belleville runner, Conway,
+who had looked so confident when Hugh surveyed the line of eager
+faces at the start.
+
+Hugh remembered every foot of the way along that quarry road. He had
+a faculty for impressing features of the surrounding landscape on his
+mind, so that he could recall it at pleasure, just as though he held
+a photograph in his hand.
+
+Now he was drawing near the quarry itself, the loneliest and most
+gruesome stretch of the entire cut-off; with "Just" Smith still in
+the lead. Hugh felt proud of his chum, and often chuckled as he
+contemplated the other's supreme delight in case a fickle fortune
+allowed him to come in ahead; for honors of this sort were a rare
+thing in the past of the Smith boy; and certainly he had never before
+been so close to reaping such a colossal prize as the winning of the
+Marathon would be reckoned.
+
+Now Hugh glimpsed the quarry on one side of him. How his thoughts
+flew backward to marshal the strange events so recently happening
+there, in which he and some of his comrades had had the good fortune
+to participate.
+
+Just then he heard a plain groan. It gave him a little thrill, but
+not because he fancied there was anything supernatural connected with
+the sound. Looking in the direction from whence the groan came he
+discovered a boy sitting on the ground, and rubbing his lower
+extremities vigorously.
+
+It was "Just" Smith! Evidently something not down on the programme
+had happened to the boy who led the race across the quarry road.
+Hugh suspected treachery immediately. He turned aside, and sprang
+towards his chum.
+
+"Hey! what ails you, 'Just' Smith?" he called out, wasting some of
+his precious breath in the bargain. "This isn't the way to win a
+Marathon, don't you know? What if you have barked your shin?--forget
+all about it, and get moving again!"
+
+The Smith boy looked very sad, as he shook his face dolefully.
+
+"Huh! wish I could, Hugh," he hastened to mumble, still rubbing his
+shin, and making faces as though it hurt him considerably. "I've
+tried to run, but shucks; what's the use when you can hardly limp at
+the best? I'm through, Hugh, sorry to say. You keep on, and bag the
+prize; next to winning it myself I'd love to know _you_ took it away
+from that Whipple chap."
+
+"But--how did the accident happen, 'Just' Smith?" continued Hugh.
+
+"Accident nothing!" snapped the other, between his set teeth. "It
+was all a set-up game to knock one of us out of the race, I tell you.
+If you'd been leading at the time, why, that shower of rocks must
+have met you."
+
+"Rocks, did you say?" exclaimed Hugh, looking dark.
+
+Just then the sound of footsteps was heard. A runner went past them
+on the full tear. It was Nick Lang, and when he turned his face
+toward the two on their knees the wicked look on his grinning face
+told more eloquently than words how his brain had been the one to
+hatch up this miserable trick whereby he hoped to gain an advantage
+over one of his schoolmates who might happen to be leading him in the
+race. He vanished down the road, still running strong. "Just" Smith
+almost howled, he was so furious.
+
+"That's the chap who engineered this rotten game, I tell you, Hugh!"
+he snapped. "And chances are ten to one it was Leon Disney and that
+Tip Slavin who threw all those stones, and then ran away laughing, so
+I couldn't glimpse 'em. Say, I was struck in half a dozen places.
+I've got a lump on my head nearly as big as a hen's egg; and my elbow
+hurts like everything. I was so flustered that I must have got
+twisted in a vine, or else struck a root, for I fell, and barked my
+shin something fierce. I wanted to chase after the cowards, but knew
+it was silly to think of such a thing. Then I tried to keep on, but
+it wasn't any use, and I gave it up as a bad job. But Hugh, I hope
+you don't mean to let that skunk profit by his trickery. Please
+start off, and beat him out, if it takes a leg."
+
+"But I hate to leave you here, 'Just' Smith, much as I'd like to
+chase after Nick, because now he deserves to be beaten."
+
+"Oh! don't bother about me, Hugh. I'll try and get to the main
+road, even if I have to _crawl_. Later on you can come back for me
+in some sort of rig. Whew! but I'm as mad as a hatter because I've
+lost my fine chance, when I was going so strong, with plenty of
+reserve force held back."
+
+Hugh realized that duty called upon him to do as his chum demanded.
+It would be a shame if Nick Lang actually profited through such a
+rank act of treachery toward his fellows of Scranton High. An
+individual should be ready to sacrifice his school or its interests
+to his own personal ambition, and certainly never should it be
+allowed that he gain his ends through such a dastardly trick as the
+waylaying of another on the road, and his being assaulted, as "Just"
+Smith had been.
+
+"All right, I'll do it, then!" Hugh exclaimed, with a look of sudden
+determination. "Expect me back later on, old fellow! Bye-bye!
+Don't try to do too much, and hurt yourself worse!"
+
+With these words he sprang away. "Just" Smith gave him a parting
+cheer, that must have come a bit hard, owing to the pain he suffered,
+and also the bitter disappointment that wrung his boyish and
+ambitious heart.
+
+Hugh had but one thought now, which was to speed along at such a clip
+as to allow him to finally overtake and pass the treacherous Nick,
+and leave him in the lurch. The spur of punishing the other for such
+dastardly conduct was apt to prove an incentive calculated to add
+considerably to Hugh's running.
+
+Nick had the advantage, since he must be well on the way to the main
+thoroughfare by now; and once that was gained there was a clear field
+ahead of him. But one more registering station remained, and that
+was at a certain turn on the way home. Then would come the final
+three miles, with the pace increasing constantly, as those in the
+lead vied with each other to get ahead, or to retain that proud
+position.
+
+Hugh quickly regained the mastery over his aroused feelings. He must
+stay cool and collected so as to do exactly the right thing at the
+right time. A little slip in the way of judgment was likely to lose
+him the race, for he now learned as he gained the main road, that
+there were not only one but two competitors ahead of him.
+
+Yes, the fleet-footed Whipple had somehow managed to spin along over
+the ground, and was now not far behind Nick Lang. Possibly the
+fellow from Allandale had also secretly examined the course and
+discovered a cut-off on his own account, through means of which he
+anticipated gaining a great advantage over all the other runners in
+the Marathon.
+
+Hugh now set out to make steady gains. He must be within a certain
+distance of those two fellows by the time the last stretch was
+reached, or else all his hope of overtaking and passing them would be
+lost.
+
+He found that his powers of endurance and speed had not been
+misjudged, for they responded nobly when called upon for a further
+spurt. Now, he was greatly lessening the distance separating him
+from Whipple; who, in turn, seemed able to hold his own with Nick.
+
+The latter began to show the first signs of distress when they were
+at the beginning of the last two miles. He looked over his shoulder,
+and no runner ever is guilty of such an unwise proceeding unless his
+heart has commenced to be filled with grave doubts as to his being a
+winner.
+
+Again did Hugh notice Nick doing this, and he took fresh courage from
+the circumstance. Yes, and looking more closely he also saw that
+Nick was not running true to form any longer; he had begun to wobble
+more or less, as though unable to continue on in a straight line.
+That was another bad sign, since it causes the runner to cover
+unnecessary ground; and also indicates a weakening heart.
+
+Hugh let out another burst of speed. He was closing the gap rapidly;
+and, apparently, Whipple also seemed to be gaining on the almost
+played-out Nick.
+
+They were now within less than a mile of the finish; the last turn
+would soon be reached, with the gun booming out the fact of their
+arrival. Hugh girded his loins for a Garrison finish, and gloried in
+the conviction that he was in trim to do himself credit.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XX
+
+THE BOY WHO WON--CONCLUSION
+
+"It's Nick Lang, as sure as anything!" shouted a boy who happened to
+possess an excellent pair of field-glasses.
+
+"Nick Lang in the lead!" howled another; "well, what do you think of
+that? Where, oh, where, oh, where is Hugh Morgan about this time;
+and 'Just' Smith in the bargain?"
+
+"But Nick is a Scranton High boy after all, and that's a heap better
+than to see an Allandale fellow come in ahead!" cried another near by.
+
+"Look! a second runner has turned the bend; and see how he is coming
+up on poor wobbly old Nick hand-over-fist!"
+
+"Hello! what's this mean?" whooped a visitor exultantly. "Surely I
+know the second fellow's build. It's certainly our great Whipple!
+He's going to cop the prize, boys! Give Whipple an Allandale yell
+right now to encourage him!"
+
+Even as a score of boyish throats roared in response to this entreaty
+a third runner was discovered rounding the bend. He appeared to be
+tearing along at race-horse speed, as though having a reserve stock
+of power upon which to call in this closing half-mile of the long
+race.
+
+"Hugh Morgan!"
+
+The words seemed to run like wildfire through the vast crowd.
+Everybody repeated them, some with a growing delight, others with a
+sense of impending disaster to the wild hopes they had been so
+ardently cherishing; all according to the viewpoint they held.
+Scranton's register was rising, while Allandale visitors began to
+feel something was on the verge of happening to crush the budding
+paean of victory that was ready to bubble from their lips.
+
+Nick evidently knew that he had shot his bolt. He, doubtless, tried
+frantically to encourage his legs to move faster, but they refused to
+hearken to the call. Whipple was now rapidly closing the short gap
+existing between them. At the same time it could be seen that the
+Allandale runner veered a trifle, as though to give Nick a fairly
+wide berth when passing.
+
+Plenty of fellows noticed this fact, nor did they wonder at it. The
+tricky character of Nick Lang was pretty well known, and they
+believed he would not hesitate about throwing himself sideways, so as
+to collide with Whipple when the other was in the act of passing him;
+although such a vindictive act could, of course, not better the
+position of the local runner a particle.
+
+When Whipple actually took the lead a great roar arose from thousands
+of throats. Doubtless many wild-eyed Allandale enthusiasts already
+counted the victory as won. They could be seen commencing to throw
+their hats and caps into the air, boy-fashion. Others, wiser,
+gripped their hands, and held their breath while waiting to see the
+actual finish of the great race.
+
+Of a truth Whipple was doing splendidly, there was no gainsaying
+that; but coming on back of him was one who appeared to be making
+much better time. Hugh was gaining fast, they could see. The only
+question that remained to be settled was whether Whipple had it in
+him to increase his pace sufficiently to cross the tape first; or, on
+the other hand, if Hugh Morgan was able to speed up still more, and
+close the gap.
+
+How the shouts rang out. Everybody seemed to be cheering madly at
+the same time. Men stood up, and waved their arms; girls embraced
+each other, though not an eye was turned away from that wonderful
+finish of the great Marathon race.
+
+Now, Hugh had apparently released his final effort. He was gaining
+faster and faster. Whipple seemed to know that he was in deadly
+peril. He, too, looked back over his shoulder in alarm, possibly
+meaning in desperation to almost burst a blood vessel if he found
+that his rival was about to overtake him.
+
+That proved his eventual undoing, though the result was no longer in
+doubt. He lost his balance, and, being so exhausted that he could
+not stand longer, pitched headlong to the ground, just as the fleet
+Hugh jumped into the lead, raced twenty steps further, broke the
+extended tape, and thus won the race.
+
+How the heavens seemed to fairly quiver with the roars that broke
+out! It had been a most thrilling finish for the greatest race ever
+run in all the country. Time might come and time might go, but never
+would those who had been so fortunate as to witness the conclusion of
+the Marathon forget the thrilling spectacle.
+
+Hugh bore his honors meekly.
+
+He utterly declined to let some of the Scranton fellows pick him up
+and bear him around on their shoulders, as they threatened to do.
+After the prizes had been duly awarded the assemblage broke up, and
+the roads leading out of Scranton were soon blocked with hundreds of
+vehicles of every description carrying home the visitors.
+
+Even Allandale and Belleville had no reason to be disappointed over
+the general results, for their young athletes had fared very well,
+all things considered. Of course, most of them would rather have
+seen the Marathon won by a representative from their school than to
+"scoop in" all the other prizes grouped together; but since it had to
+go to Scranton, they voiced the opinion of most people when they
+declared they were glad Hugh Morgan had won it, and not Nick Lang.
+
+Even though overwhelmed with congratulations on every hand, Hugh did
+not forget his promise to "Just" Smith. As soon as he could get into
+his street clothes he hunted a fellow who chanced to have his
+father's flivver handy, and easily won his consent to take him along
+the road in the direction of Belleville, in order to find poor "Just"
+Smith, and get him home again.
+
+This they did without any mishap, and it may be easily understood
+that the disappointed boy hailed their coming with great joy. He
+knew all about that gruelling finish of the big race in the bargain,
+some of those Allandale chaps passing by in vehicles having readily
+informed him as to the winner, and what a tremendously thrilling
+sight the finish had been.
+
+Of course, since "Just" Smith had not once glimpsed the figures of
+his assailants, and as conviction can hardly rest upon a burst of
+vindictive boyish laughter, there was no public denunciation of Nick
+Lang and his cronies. Everybody could give a good guess, however, as
+to who was guilty; and after that Nick was destined to feel himself
+more ostracized by his schoolmates than ever before.
+
+The great athletic tournament had proven to be a complete success,
+being marred by no serious accidents, for which many a devoted mother
+in Scranton gave thanks that same night, even though her boy may not
+have won undying fame through gaining a prize. Hugh himself was more
+than satisfied, though he would have been almost as well pleased had
+it been poor "K. K.," "Just" Smith, or Horatio Juggins who had won
+the big race, so long as the honor of Scranton High was upheld.
+
+That was to be the finish of the fall sports, but with winter so near
+at hand, and that vast field being put in order for flooding, it
+might readily be guessed the boys and girls of Scranton were in line
+for considerable more fun while Jack Frost held sway over his frozen
+dominions. That this supposition proved to be a correct one may be
+judged from the title of the fourth and following volume in this
+series, which can be had wherever boys' books are sold, and bearing
+the suggestive title of "The Chums of Scranton High at Ice Hockey;
+or, A Wizard on Steel Runners." Get it, if you have enjoyed reading
+about Hugh Morgan and his loyal comrades in this and previous books;
+you will find it just as deeply interesting as anything that has gone
+before, since the boys of Scranton enter upon a fresh line of healthy
+competition, this time upon the ice.
+
+
+
+
+THE END
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of The Chums of Scranton High on the
+Cinder Path, by Donald Ferguson
+
+*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE CHUMS OF SCRANTON HIGH ***
+
+***** This file should be named 13251.txt or 13251.zip *****
+This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
+ https://www.gutenberg.org/1/3/2/5/13251/
+
+Produced by Al Haines
+
+Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.
+
+Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.
+
+
+
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
+https://gutenberg.org/license).
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
+or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
+of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH F3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need, is critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation web page at https://www.pglaf.org.
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at
+https://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
+809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
+business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
+information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
+page at https://pglaf.org
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit https://pglaf.org
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including including checks, online payments and credit card
+donations. To donate, please visit: https://pglaf.org/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+ https://www.gutenberg.org
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
+
diff --git a/old/13251.zip b/old/13251.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..87fd9c0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/old/13251.zip
Binary files differ